Document of The World Bank FOR OFFICIAL USE ONLY Report No. 24427-MAI MALAWI POVERTY REDUCTION STRATEGY PAPER AND JOINT IDA-IMF STAFF ASSESSMENT July 19,2002 Prepared by Staffs of the International Development Association and the International Monetary Fund This document has a restricted distribution and may be used by recipients only in the performance of their official duties. Its contents may not otherwise be disclosed without World Bank authorization. FOR OFFICIAL USE ONLY THE INTERNATIONAL DEVELOPMENT ASSOCIATION AND THE INTERNATIONAL MONETARY FUND MALAWI POVERTY REDUCTION STRATEGY PAPER Joint Staff Assessment Prepared by the Staffs of the International Development Association and the International Monetary Fund Approved by Callisto Madavo and Gobind Nankani (IDA) and Jose Fajgenbaum and Masood Ahmed (IMF) I. OVERVIEW 1. The attached Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper (PRSP) of the Government of Malawi builds upon the Interim Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper (I-PRSP) presented to the Boards of the Intemational Monetary Fund (IMF) and International Development Association (IDA) in December 2000. Developed through a highly participatory process, the PRSP presents the available knowledge on poverty and details Malawi's multisectoral approach to reducing poverty. 2. The staffs consider the Malawi PRSP a well-developed and sound strategy. The PRSP's main strengths are (i) a highly participatory process involving government, civil society, the private sector, and donors; (ii) an appropriate macroeconomic framework and financing plan; (iii) a balanced approach to public policy designed to create the necessary conditions to generate growth, improve social sector outcomes, protect the vulnerable, and improve govemance; (iv) a detailed action plan linked to strategic goals; and (v) an adequate institutional structure for monitoring the PRSP. The staffs believe that Malawi's PRSP provides a credible framework for reducing poverty in Malawi and is a sound basis for IDA and Fund concessional assistance. 3. Successful implementation of the PRSP will, however, require further work in specific areas. In particular, the link between the PRSP and the central govemment budget needs to be further strengthened. This will give policymakers greater guidance on how to translate the PRSP priorities into the budget, a task that will need to be undertaken as part of the annual budgetary preparations. In order for the PRSP's growth and poverty reduction objectives to be met, it is also essential that the structural reform agenda does not falter. During implementation of the PRSP, a clear capacity building program needs to be developed to redress the impact of HIV/AIDS, which is rapidly taking its toll on both the This document has a restricted distribution and may be used by recipients only in the performance of their official duties. Its contents may not be otherwise disclosed without World Bank authorization. -2 - private and public sector. In addition, further refinement of the indicators and timeframe for attaining the PRSP targets requires immediate attention. H. THE PARTICIPATORY PROCESS 4. One of the strongest features of the Malawi PRSP is the participatory process, which has helped develop a relatively high degree of national ownership over the strategy. The PRSP also builds on the groundwork for Malawi's poverty reduction policies as formulated in the "Vision 2020" document. The participatory nature of the PRSP process also resulted in the emergence of the Malawi Economic Justice Network (MEJN) as an umbrella organization for civil society groups. This greater involvement of civil society in the public sphere is an important step forward in Malawi's nascent democracy. 5. As described in Annex 6a of the PRSP document, the development of the PRSP involved three stages: mobilization, preparation, and validation. The "mobilization" phase consisted of forming three PRSP committees (ministerial, principal secretaries, and technical) and drafting an issues paper. During the official launch of the PRSP-attended by a wide variety of stakeholders-the rationale and objectives of the exercise were discussed. A media campaign was also launched to disseminate the purpose and road map of the PRSP. 6. The "preparation" phase of the PRSP development consisted of contributions from 19 thematic working groups and extensive "bottom-up" consultations. The working groups were composed of relevant government officials and representatives from the donor community, academics, nongovernmental organizations (NGOs), religious bodies, and the private sector. Several thematic contributions were based on existing sector strategies, such as the Policy and Investment Framework for education. Consultations were held in all 27 districts and included traditional authorities, village headmen, ward councilors, members of parliament, local politicians, local NGOs, and ordinary citizens. Annex 6b in the PRSP summarizes the common themes, such as the importance of law and order and access to credit, that emerged from the district consultations and were fed into the priority-setting at the national level. 7. The final PRSP drafting team comprised members of the government technical committee and civil society representatives. The drafting was carried out through an iterative process in which comments from all stakeholders were solicited at various stages and fed into subsequent drafts. This "validation" phase concluded with the official launch on April 24, 2002, attended by the President of Malawi, members of parliament, government officials, civil society groups and donors. 8. Civil society groups are expected to have an active role in the monitoring and evaluation of the PRSP targets. As described in the PRSP, a monitoring committee will be formed, and the technical committee will include academics, NGO representatives and the media, in addition to government officials and members of parliament. III. POVERTY DIAGNOSIS 9. The PRSP benefited from Malawi's 1997/98 Integrated Household Survey, multiple demographic and health surveys, and qualitative studies on poverty. The new household survey, to be launched in late 2002, will provide a rich Source of data to assess the dynamics and trends in poverty. In general, there is relatively free access to the data, but capacity constraints have limited their extensive use in public policymaking. 10. The PRSP presents a good summary of the profile of poverty, although it focuses primarily on quantitative aspects. The 1997/98 national household survey was used to develop a comprehensive poverty profile disaggregated by gender, household demographics, and physical, financial, and human assets. Howeyer, there is little discussion of environmental degradation as a cause of poverty and only scant use is made of qualitative sources of information to provide a more in-depth analysis of both the profile and determinants of poverty. 11. Further analysis is needed of the government's past policies and programs. The PRSP candidly states that govemment policies have not yet made a significant dent in poverty. The main reasons presented are spells of macroeconomic mismanagement, vulnerability to exogenous shocks, growing population pressure, the high prevalence of HIV/AIDS, and weak institutional capacity. However, while the description of recent reforms is accurate, the analysis of their impact requires further work. The shortcomings of the assessment reinforce the importance of having a strong monitoring and evaluation system for the PRSP. Donor support for capacity building in the area of policy impact analysis can be channeled through the PRSP implementation unit. IV. THE POVERTY REDUCTION STRATEGY 12. The PRSP is a comprehensive and policy-focused framework designed to reduce poverty. The overall approach is to promote growth and diversification of the economy, improve the delivery of social services, create safety nets, improve governance, and integrate policies on HIV/AIDS, gender, environment, and science and technology across the main sectors. The overall goals are translated into broad programs and activities that are costed and presented both in the main text and in Annex 2 of the PRSP. The staffs concur that the strategy presented in the PRSP is an appropriate framework for poverty reduction in Malawi. A. Targets, Indicators, and Monitoring 13. The PRSP targets are generally well specified, although they focus primarily on the medium term (2005-07). The choice of indicators is appropriate for the goals and actions identified by the strategy and the proposed monitoring system would collect the relevant data. Annex 4 of the PRSP lists the main overall targets, as well as the key sector specific indicators. These targets relate primarily to 2005 as the PRSP will be revised after three years following annual reviews of the targets. However, the PRSP monitoring and - 4 - evaluation process should establish the baseline for targets, where they do not exist, as well as targets for 2003-04, where they can be appropriately monitored. 14. While most indicators are in line with the Millennium Development Goals (MDG), the PRSP's targets are less ambitious. Further work is required to develop longer- term targets that relate directly to the 2015 goals. However, extrapolating the targets set in the PRSP for 2005 suggests that Malawi will fall short of meeting the 2015 MDG goals. The staffs believe that these PRSP targets are more realistic and reflect Malawi's current socioeconomic conditions. For instance, the targeted reduction in income poverty from 65 percent in 1998 to 59 percent in 2005 is not at a rate that would halve poverty by 2015 but is realistic given medium term growth projections. Similarly, the 20 percent targeted reduction in the infant mortality rate by 2007 also falls short of the MDG's goal (reduction in infant mortality by two-thirds by 2015). 15. The staffs endorse the new cross-sectoral monitoring and evaluation structure with civil society participation. The institutional arrangements are well designed. At the political level, the cabinet committee on the economy will provide overall guidance to the monitoring and evaluation system. In addition, a committee of principal secretaries will provide leadership in the exercise, supported by a technical committee. Civil society groups, academics, district representatives, the media, and donor representatives will be part of the technical committee along with line ministry and parliamentary representatives. The challenge will be'in implementing this coordinated effort across sectors and different stakeholders. 16. The data collection activities are well sequenced. The National Statistical Office will collect annual socioeconomic data using the Core Welfare Indicator Questionnaire (CWIQ), as well as conduct a full-fledged Integrated Household Survey and a Demographic and Health Survey (DHS) every five years. Moreover, an annual public expenditure review (PER) will also be carried out to strengthen the linkage between the PRSP and the budget. Community-based expenditure tracking and output-monitoring exercises, involving civil society organizations, will complement these efforts. In addition, the PRSP appropriately identifies specific institutions for monitoring of targets. 17. However, significant capacity building is necessary to improve the quality of economic data, to allow for-effective monitoring of progress toward achieving the PRSP targets. Whereas the poverty-related data appear satisfactory, agricultural data have been found to be grossly inaccurate; in fact, flawed crop estimates thwarted a timely response to the recent food crisis. Moreover, national accounts and trade statistics, as well as fiscal data, are weak and hamper economic analyses. B. Macroeconomic Framework 18. The PRSP appropriately places emphasis on implementing sound macroeconomic policies in order to achieve the country's growth and poverty reduction goals. High and volatile inflation has been imposing a considerable burden on the poor and high real interest rates have severely constrained private sector activity and depressed economic growth. The PRSP acknowledges that achieving macroeconomic stability is imperative to accelerating growth. 19. The medium-term macroeconomic framework, developed in consultation with IMF staff in late 2001, is appropriate but will need to be updated to take into account recent developments, including the availability of foreign financing and the response to the food crisis (paragraph 27). The staffs believe that-based'on recent performance and future prospects-the growth projections for 2003-05 in the PRSP are, reasonable. The acceleration of the growth rate to above 5 percent by 2004 is achievable and necessary to attain the poverty reduction target of 59 percent by 2005. The macroeconomic analysis in the PRSP should be expanded to include monetary and external sector developments. 20. The PRSP recognizes that at the heart of Malawi's macroeconomic stabilization problems lie its past failures to control and limit the size of its fiscal deficits. The PRSP correctly points out that achieving fiscal restraint requires effective monitoring and control of public spending and the prevention of budgetary arrears. Continued political commitment will be necessary to ensure that the budget is not undermined by extrabudgetary spending. 21. The emphasis on agriculture as the main source of pro-poor growth is sound, and the staffs fully endorse the PRSP's main focus on promoting small-scale private sector employment in agriculture to achieve both food security and enhance the income of the poor. The strategy correctly places significant emphasis on strengthening access to inputs, improving the relevance of extension and research, promoting small-scale irrigation, improving access to markets, and reducing land degradation. This approach will be important to generating off-farm employment, which the poverty analysis highlights as a critical source of income for the rural poor. These actions gain further urgency in light of the present food crisis and the need to reduce the country's vulnerability to further crisis in the future. 22. While identifying and analyzing certain sectors in terms of their growth potential is useful, the growth strategy has to focus on eliminating obstacles to growth on an economy-wide basis. Furthermore, the strategy could have provided an analytical justification for identifying macroeconomic stability, access to credit, and the development of rural infrastructure and other "enabling infrastructure" as the key factors for creating an enabling environment for pro-poor growth. Issues such as government intervention in the economy, governance, investment in human resources, the legal framework, land policy, and security are discussed in the PRSP, but their links with the overall framework for generating growth could have been strengthened. C. Public Expenditure Program and Financing 23. The PRSP projects a realistic resource envelope for the period 2002-05. It rightly points out that it is essential that the government stay within its financial envelope to avoid further crowding out of the private sector. This will require clear'prioritization of expenditure - 6- in the spirit of the PRSP, imply cuts in nonessential spending, and entail measures to increase revenue. 24. However, while the staffs are encouraged by the proposed re-prioritization of spending allocations reflecting strategic priorities, further prioritization and better linkage to the budget are needed to provide greater guidance to policy makers. In particular, staffs are encouraged by the commitment to reduce statutory and statehood expenditures in favor of PRSP prioritized activities over time. However, as statutory and statehood expenditures have repeatedly diverted funds from priority areas in the past, and since all other non-interest expenditures are defined as PRSP-related spending, the PRSP should have been explicit as to which pro-poor expenditures are protected should shocks require adjustments to the budget. This is a critical issue that should be addressed during implementation of the PRSP and articulated in the annual progress reports. Also, in moving forward it could become necessary to further prioritize spending based on outcomes achieved. The staffs are encouraged that the 2002/03 budget, which was approved by parliament in July 2002, explicitly identifies priority pro-poor expenditure that will be protected. 25. The detailed program classification of the budget and several years of experience in developing medium-term estimates have facilitated the costing of the PRSP. However, the PRSP should have presented the methodology and established the 2001/02 baseline, thus linking proposed pro-poor programs with budget programs. Translating the PRSP's commitments to certain strategic priorities will therefore need to be undertaken as part of the annual budgetary preparations. The staffs are encouraged that the Ministry of Finance will continue its prebudget consultations, which will give stakeholders an opportunity to be involved in incorporating PRSP priorities into the budget (see paragraph 27). 26. Moreover, it will be critical that expenditure programs are subsequently monitored through a transparent expenditure-tracking system. It is absolutely essential that this system become fully operational so that'stakeholders can monitor budget implementation and thus, hold the govemment accountable in implementing the PRSP. 27. The government reports in letters sent to the World Bank and the IMF (and attached as an addendum to the PRSP) the latest revisions to the macroeconomic framework and lays out its approach to adjusting the PRSP accordingly. The 2002/03 budget law broadly reflects the priorities of the PRSP and includes higher expenditure, following upward revisions to external grants and loans from the time the PRSP was finalized. Moreover, after preparing the 2002/03 budget, government decided to provide imported maize to the population at a subsidized price, which the staffs believe is an appropriate response to address the lack of purchasing power of the poor that are not benefiting from food aid under humanitarian programs. The subsidy has increased the fiscal deficit by about I percent of GDP, which it expects to finance through donor support. These revisions of the macroeconomic framework, as shown in tables I and 2 of the authorities' letters, will provide the basis for consultations with stakeholders on updating the PRSP (specifically tables 5.2 and 5.4). Moreover, in their table 3, the authorities identify the priority pro-poor expenditure that were included in the budget. The staffs welcome the authorities' commitment to adjust the macroeconomic framework underlying the PRSP in the forthcoming consultations with stakeholders. D. Governance 28. The open discussion in the PRSP of the lack of good governance undermining development efforts is refreshing. The section on "Good Govemance, Political Will and Mindset" is a very perceptive and frank assessment of obstacles to development and poverty alleviation. The "depoliticization of development" message and the discussion of the links between human rights, democracy, and development are well cast. 29. The PRSP reaffirms the need to improve governance by addressing certain legislative weaknesses for prosecuting corruption cases and the need to strengthen the Anti-Corruption Bureau's (ACB) investigative capacity. It is, therefore, important that the government submit the draft amendments to the Corrupt Practices Act to parliament by end- 2002. Efforts to build capacity by establishing a program to train magistrates in interpreting the revised act, and to increase staffing levels of the ACB substantially, particularly in the investigative branch, are also under way. 30. The staffs fully share the concern that the losses incurred by parastatals are diverting resources meant for priority areas. This highlights the need for improved public expenditure management and adherence to established guidelines on transparency, both of which will require strong political commitment. The ongoing efforts to increase the transparency in parastatal operations will make explicit the trade-off between financing parastatal activity and pro-poor expenditure. It is thus important that the parastatal reform agenda is accelerated as outlined in the PRSP, to prevent further bailouts of parastatals. E. Structural, Sectoral and Cross-Cutting Policies 31. The recent progress on the structural reform agenda needs to be maintained over the medium term in order for growth to rebound. The poverty reduction strategy proposes solutions to key structural constraints inhibiting private sector development such as (i) improving the provision of basic infrastructure; (ii) promoting competition by reducing the domination of the formal sector by large oligopolies; and (iii) deepening financial services to enable widespread access to credit and saving mechanisms. 32. Private sector development is considered critical for achieving the objectives of the PRSP, but the role of the private sector in specific areas is not clearly identified. The activities to be undertaken by the private sector, civil society and the government (central and local) will need to be further clarified during PRSP implementation. The PRSP states that the private sector will be the engine of growth, but there is ambiguity regarding the government's role as a facilitator, financier or implementing agency. 33. The PRSP's focus on the financial sector is narrow. While the overall strategy behind supporting the growth of micro-finance appears sound, it is also critical that capacity- - 8 - building support for microfinance institutions be included. Moreover, it will be important to make the financial sector more competitive and to explore alternative ways of strengthening linkages between the formal, semiformal, and informal financial sector. The PRSP could have linked the discussion on the operational and financial independence of the Reserve Bank of Malawi with the objective of achieving macroeconomic stability. 34. The recommendation in the PRSP to improve disaster management is commendable, but, given the gravity of the present food crisis in Malawi, the strategy should have clearly spelled out improvements to the national food security policy. The PRSP addresses issues of increasing crop production and providing a safety net for the vulnerable, but lacks a coherent discussion on improving crop estimates and on managing the food grain reserve. 35. Considerable efforts have been undertaken to develop an extensive safety net strategy. The four components of the safety net program are conceptually sound and are aimed at different groups of vulnerable households, depending on the extent of their land and physical constraints. However, given the current food crisis, the costing of some aspects of the safety net strategy might have to be reworked. Furthermore, because targeted inputs schemes in Malawi have a mixed record of reaching the intended recipients, the challenge will be to develop mechanisms for targeting, preferably through self-selection. The implementation of the safety net strategy should be closely coordinated with the ongoing decentralization process. 36. The PRSP provides some insights into the challenge of improving the quality of education. The policies in the education sector are based on the existing sector strategy document, and the emphasis on improving the quality of basic education and teacher training while increasing access to higher education is an appropriate strategy. However, policies to ensure effective deployment and management of qualified staff, coupled with improvements in procurement of basic supplies (e.g., teaching materials) are not adequately discussed. It will also be necessary to clarify the respective roles of central and local government in the provision of education services during the ongoing decentralization process. 37. The strategy for fighting HIV/AIDS in the PRSP has to be strengthened and there needs to be a recognition that the scale of the AIDS crisis requires that it be tackled head-on. As the HIV/AIDS pandemic is undermining Malawi's development efforts, the PRSP should have been more explicit on the overarching strategy. The setting of strategic indicators and targets is essential in such a critical area. Furthermore, the importance of a multisectoral approach and the involvement of the civil society, including the private sector and NGOs, need to be highlighted. As noted in the PRSP, HIV/AIDS is not only a health issue; it also erodes growth, as morbidity and mortality of the working-age population increases. 38. The health section of the PRSP appears to be more focused on the delivery of health services, with less emphasis placed on a multi-sectoral approach. The importance of improving nutrition, especially of children, is recognized, but the role of maintaining a -9 - healthy environment is given relatively little attention despite references to providing latrines at schools and use of bed nets against malaria. Moreover, the staffs feel that there should be greater emphasis on service provision by local community groups and other proven delivery agents during implementation. F. Risks to the strategy 39. There are several risks that could derail the poverty reduction strategy laid out in the PRSP. These include: a failure to create a stable macroeconomic environment; a crowding. out in the central government's budget of pro-poor spending by nonessential spending; the impact of HIV/AIDS, and already weak economic databases that do not provide a good basis for sound policy decisions; weak governance and pressures on the budget in the run-up to the presidential elections, scheduled for 2004. 40. The poverty reduction efforts could be derailed if the macroeconomic program is not steadfastly implemented. A lack of spending discipline by govemment could result in the reemergence of excessive government borrowing, and therefore further increase already high real interest rates. Strict adherence to fiscal targets is thus critical to the success of this strategy. Also, exogenous shocks (droughts, floods, and commodity prices) could threaten macroeconomic stability. 41. The PRSP does not clearly specify the pro-poor programs that will be protected should shocks require adjustments to the budget. This shortcoming, together withi capacity constraints and the weaknesses in public expenditure management, pose a major risk. To mitigate this risk, it is important that the authorities develop a specific timetable for the envisaged improvements in public expenditure management, including tracking budget execution. 42. The generally weak implementation and absorption capacity is being exacerbated by the high rate of HIV/AIDS, which is rapidly taking its toll on both the public and private sector. This will remain the main challenge to Malawi's development efforts in the foreseeable future. During implementation of the PRSP, it is thereforelessential that a clear capacity-building program be developed in order for the PRSP's goals to be met. In addition, Malawi's economic databases are weak and significant capacity building is necessary to improve the quality of economic data and the consequent public policy decisions. 43. The election cycle could also jeopardize implementation of the PRSP. In, the run- up to elections in 2004, budgetary pressures could reemerge, efforts to improve transparency and accountability could be hampered, and the structural reform program could easily be derailed. V. CONCLUSIONS 44. The strategy set out in the PRSP is an important step forward in Malawi's poverty reduction efforts. The PRSP is derived from a highly consultative, country-owned - 10- process. The strategy is coherent, comprehensive, and refreshingly frank. The PRSP lays out strategic goals and specific actions to accomplish them. However, as the risk assessment has highlighted, the success of the PRSP process is contingent on sustaining political commitment, establishing macroeconomic stability, protecting pro-poor expenditures, and relieving capacity constraints within the public sector. 45. The staffs of the World Bank and IMF consider that this PRSP provides a credible poverty reduction strategy and is a sound basis for IDA and Fund concessional assistance. The staffs recommend that the Executive Directors of the World Bank and IMF reach the same conclusion. Tdga: Fbmma6 Loew - MNsTER OF FINANCE Thegtoms LOladg73 £99 P.O. BOX 30049 To[=: 44402 LILONGWVI 3 MALAWI Ref. No. ST/4120 17th July 2002 Mr. James Wolfensohn President The World Bank Washington, D.C. 20431 Dear Mr. Wolfensohn I am pleased to inform you that after two years of discussions and consultations with all stakeholders in Malawi, the Government in April 2002 launched the Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper (MPRSP). The participatory MPRSP process has had already many positive benefits for Malawi and it is the government's intention to maintain this close dialogue with stakeholders. We have revised our macroeconomic frarnework since finalizing the MPRSP and, accordingly, will adjust the MPRSP in our forthcoming consultations with key stakeholders. First, our projections for external grants and loans in 2002/03 have been revised upward by 2.5 percent of GDP and, correspondingly, the 2002/03 incorporates higher expenditure. Second, after the budget's submission to parliament, the goverunent decided to import maize and provide this maize during the food crisis at a subsidized price. Incorporating this subsidy into the budget 'will increase the fiscal deficit by about 1 percent of GDP (see attached Tables I and 2) and, by the time of the revision of the MPRSP's macroeconomic framework, we will have identified the sources of financing. I am also pleased to report that 'the 2002/03 budget clearly identifies the priority pro-poor expenditure, the so-called PPEs, that will be protected should shocks require adjustments to the budget (Table 3). Sincerely yours, on Friday Jumbe MINISTER OF FINANCE AND ECONOMIC PLANNING Table 1. Malawi: Gross Resource Envelope 2002/03 PRSP Updated (In millions of kwacha) Total revenue and grants 41,528.4 43,015.1 Domestic revenue 27,370.6 27,144.1 Tax revenue 24,683.9 24,258.6 Non-tax revenue 2,686.7 2,885.5 Grants 14,157.8 15,871.0 Project 3,010.2 3,281.6 BOP 8,423.2 9,179.9 HIPC 2,724.4 3,409.5 Overall financing -196.3 3,920.1 Foreign financing (net) 3,124.4 5,242.6 Borrowing 7,872.9 9,991.1 Project 5,010.9 6,571.1 BOP 2,862.0 3,420.0 Repayment -4,748.5 -4,748.5 Domestic financing (net) -3,320.6 -2,995.5 Unidentified financing (maize) 0.0 1,673.0 Gross resource envelope (including maize subsidy) 41,332.2 46,935.2 Table 2. Malawi: MPRSP Costing Summary by Pillar 2002/03 PRSP Updated Total Salaries ORT Development (In millions of kwacha) Total expenditure (including maize subsidy) 41,332.2 46,935.2 9,349.4 25,040.2 12,546.4 Total voted expenditure 31,347.5 36,938.5 9,348.6 15,043.5 12,546.4 Total MPRSP 28,988.7 24,396.6 5,709.7 9,425.1 9,261.8 Pillar 1 8,013.6 10,185.8 1,070.3 3,178.7 5,936.9 Pillar 2 13,860.4 10,669.3 3,677.4 4,900.4 2,091.5 Pillar 3 1,209.0 522.1 78.2 120.0 323.9 Pillar4 4,040.1 2,676.4 853.8 1,117.2 705.5 Cross-cutting 1,667.4 300.8 30.1 66.6 204.1 Implementation, monitoring and evaluation 198.2 42.3 0.0 42.3 0.0 Maize subsidy 0.0 1,673.0 0.0 1,673.0 0.0 (In percent of voted expenditure) Total MPRSP 92.5 66.0 61.1 62.7 73.8 Pillar 1 25.6 27.6 11.4 21.1 47.3 Pillar 2 44.2 28.9 39.3 32.6 16.7 Pillar 3 3.9 1.4 0.8 0.8 2.6 Pillar 4 12.9 7.2 9.1 7.4 5.6 Cross-cutting 5.3 0.8 0.3 0.4 1.6 Implementation, monitoring and evaluation 0.6 0.1 0.0 0.3 0.0 Table 3. Malawi: Pro-poor Current Expenditure (PPEs), 2000/01-2002/03 1/ 2000/01 2001/02 2002/03 Budget Approved Revised Ministry/Department program Act. budget budget Difference Budget Difference (In millions of kwacha) Total propoor expenditure 3,811.8 8,163.5 6,862.1 -1,301.4 8,930.2 2,068.1 Agriculture 239.7 383.4 364.8 -18.6 555.3 190.5 Agriculturalextension 19:04 59.7 217.3 165.4 -51.9 100.2 -65.2 Small-scale irrigation 6.1 4.4 -1.7 225.1 220.7 Targeted Input Program 180.0 160.0 195.0 35.0 230.0 35.0 Water 223.2 427.2 330.7 -96.5 222.2 -108.5 Rural water supplies 21:03 43.2 77.2 67.8 -9.4 22.2 -45.6 Development projects 180.0 350.0 262.9 -87.1 200.0 -62.9 Education 2,522.2 4,024.1 3,488.0 -536.1 4,719.8 1,231.8 Primary education 25:02 2,023.6 2,844.9 3,126.5 281.6 3,741.6 615.1 - of which. teaching and learning materials 106.8 628.9 678.5 49.6 456.0 -222.5 -ofwhich: teachers'salaries 1,792.7 1,502.6 2,304.2 801.6 2,419.4 115.2 Secondary education 25:03 431.6 831.6 231.5 -600.1 373.7 142.2 Teacher training 25:04 67.0 347.6 130.0 -217.6 494.5 364.5 Teachers'housing 0.0 0.0 0.0 110.0 110.0 Health 689.7 2,198.0 1,539.6 -658.4 1,359.0 -180.6 Primary health care 31:08 358.2 1,068.0 852.8 -215.2 441.0 -411.8 Preventive health care 31:05 5.0 24.3 24.1 -0.2 16.2 -7.9 Secondary curative care 31:09 326.5 1,105.7 662.7 -443.0 901.8 239.1 -of which: drugs 797.6 1,108.5 794.0 -314.5 1,002.0 208.0 -of which: health workers' salaries 614.9 807.4 839.4 32.0 881.4 42.0 Gender, Youth and Community Services 22.8 104.6 77.6 -27.0 75.0 -2.6 Familywelfareservices 21:02:06 1.2 18.8 11.3 -7.5 25.0 13.7 Children services 21:02:07 3.7 11.7 6.6 -5.1 25.0 18.4 Nationaladultliteracyeducationsen 21:03:11 17.9 74.1 59.7 -14.4 25.0 -34.7 Police 3.5 12.3 2.8 -9.5 255.5 252.7 Community policing 34:06 3.5 12.3 2.8 -9.5 163.0 160.2 Training 0.0 0.0 0.0 92.5 92.5 Other 110.7 1,013.9 1,058.6 44.7 1,743.4 684.8 Rural feederroads Proj. 14-26 110.7 471.4 801.0 329.6 1431.7 630.7 Small-scale mining 77.5 44.4 -33.1 54.9 10.5 Small-scale fish farming 12.2 7.6 -4.6 56.5 48.9 Technical andvocational training 219.6 114.1 -105.5 125 10.9 SME promotion 168.9 47.3 -121.6 50.2 2.9 Gender mainstreaming 64.3 44.2 -20.1 25.1 -19.1 Source: Malawian authorities 1/ Based on revised tables from budget provided by the MOF. Final DRAFT Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper April 2002 Acronyms iv List of Tables. vii List of Figures viii Executive Summary x Chapter 1 - Introduction I 1.1 Distinguishing Features I 1.2 The MPRSP Process 2 1.3 The Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy 3 1.4 The Content of the MPRSP 3 Chapter 2: Poverty Analysis and Profile 5 2.1 Poverty Situation 5 2.2 Causes of Poverty 6 2.3 Spatial Distribution of Poverty 6 2.5 Sectoral Analysis of Poverty 7 2.5.1 Demographic Characteristics 7 2.5.2 Educational Characteristics 7 2.5.3 Economic Characteristics 8 2.6 Summary of Poverty Issues 10 Chapter 3 - Structural Adjustment and Poverty 11 3.1 Overview ofStructural Adjustment Policies 11 3.2 Effects of Structural Adjustment on Poverty 12 3.3 Economic Performance during Adjustment 13 3.3.1 Inflation and Money Supply 13 3.3.2 Nominal Exchange Rate 15 3.3.3 Interest Rates 15 3.4 Effects of Agricultural Reform 15 3.5 Fiscal Policy and Expenditure Allocations 15 3.6 New Approach to Poverty Reduction 16 Chapter 4 - The Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy 19 4.1 Sustainable Pro-Poor Growth 21 4.1.1 Sources of Pro-Poor Growth 22 4.1.2 Creating an Enabling Environment for Growth 38 4.2 Human Capital Development 48 4.2.1 Education 48 4.2.2 Technical, Entrepreneunal Vocational Education and Training 56 4.2.3 Health and Population 58 ii 4.2.4 Promotion of Good Nutrition 63 4.3 Improving the Quality of Life of the Most Vulnerable 64 4.3.1 Safety Nets 65 4.3.2 Improving Disaster Management 70 4.4 Good Governance 71 4.4.1 Political Will and Mindset 71 4.4.2 Security and Access to Justice 74 4.4.3 Ensuring Responsive and Effective Public Institutions 77 4.5 Cross Cutting Issues 85 4.5.1 HIV/AIDS 85 4.5.2 Gender and Empowemient 88 4.5.3 Environment 91 4.5.4 Science and Technology 92 Chapter 5 - Macroeconomic and Expenditure Framework 95 5.1 Introduction 95 5.2 Macro-economic Framework 95 5.2.1 Economic Growth and Poverty Reduction 95 5.2.2 Macroeconomic Stability and Poverty 95 5.2.3 Resource Envelope and Macroeconomic Projections 97 5.3 Costings Framework 99 5.3.1 Statutory and Statehood Expenditure 99 5.3.2 MPRS Costings 100 5.4 Large scale Infrastructure Development 102 Chapter 6- MPRS Implementation, Monitoring and Evaluation 105 6.1 The MPRS in Context 106 6.2 MPRS and the Budget 108 6.3 Monitoring and Evaluation 108 6.3.1 Monitoring Inputs and Outputs 109 6.3.2 Monitoring Poverty Outcomes and Impacts 110 6.4 Coordination ofImplementation, Monitoring and Evaluation 111 6.5 Capacity Needsfor Implementation, Monitoring and Evaluation 113 6.6 Review process 114 Iii Acronyms ACB Anti Corruption Bureau ADD Agricultural Development Division ADMARC Agricultural Development and Marketing Corporation AGOA African Growth Opportunities Act AIDS Acquired Immuno-Deficiency Syndrome ARI Acute Respitory Infection ARV Anti-Retroviral BFC Budget and Finance Committee BFHI Baby Fnendly Health Initiative BMP Best Management Practice CBCC Community Based Child Care CBM Commercial Bank of Malawi CBNRM Community Based National Resource Management CBO Community Based Organisation CCA Credit Ceiling Authority CCS Commitment Control System CDSS Community Day Secondary Schools CHAM Christian Health Association of Malawi CIDA Canadian International Development Agency CMS Central Medical Stores COMESA Common Market of Eastern and Southern Africa CONGOMA Council for Non-Governmental Organisations in Malawi CPI Consumer Price Index CRIMP Community Road Improvement and Maintenance Project CSO Civil Society Organisation CVA Current Vulnerability Assessment CWIQ Core Welfare Indicator Questionnaire DANIDA Danish International Development Agency DC District Commissioner DDF District Development Fund DDP District Development Plan DDPRR Department of Disaster Prevention, Relief and Rehabilitation DEMAT Development of Malawian Enterprises Trust DflD Department for International Development DHS Demographic and Health Surveys DPE Direct Poverty Expenditure DPP Director of Public Prosecutions DRIMP District Road Improvement and Maintenance Project DTED Department for Teacher Education EAP Environmental Action Plan EBA Everything But Arms ECD Early Childhood Development EHP Essential Health Care Package EMIS Education Management Information System EPA Extension Planning Area ESAF Enhanced Structural Adjustment Facility ESCOM Electricity Supply Corporation of Malawi EU European Union FEWS Famine Early Warning System FPE Free Primary Education FRDP Fiscal Restructuring and Deregulation Programme iv FTEP Full Time Equivalent Public GAD Gender and Development GBV Gender Based Violence GDI Gender Development Index GDP Gross Domestic Product GER Gross Enrolment Ratio GoM Government of Malawi .GSP Generalised System of Preferences HES Hygiene, Education and Sanitation HIPC Highly Indebted Poor Countries HIV Human Immuno-Deficiency Virus HQ Headquarters HR Human Resources ICT Information and Communication Technology ICWG Industry Cluster Working Groups IEC Information, Education and Communication IFMIS Integrated Financial Management Information System IGA Income Generating Activity IHS Integrated Household Survey IMF International Monetary Fund INSET In Service Education and Training IPRSP Interim Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper JCE Junior Certificate of Education JICA Japan International Cooperation Agency LRR Liquidity Reserve Requirement M&E Monitoring and Evaluation MANEB Malawi National Examinations Board MASAF Malawi Social Action Fund MASIP Malawi Agriculture Sector Investment Programme MASSAJ Malawi Safety, Security and Access to Justice MBC Malawi Broadcasting Corporation MCDE Malawi College of Distance Education MDC Malawi Development Corporation MEPC Malawi Export Promotion Council MFI Micro-Finance Institutions MHRC Malawi Human Rights Commission MIE Malawi Institute of Education MIITEP Malawi Improved Intensive Teacher Education Programme MIPA Malawi Investment Promotion Agency MIRTDC Malawi Industrial Research and Technical Development Centre MIS Market Information System MOAI Ministry of Agriculture and Irrigation MOCI Ministry of Commerce and Industry MOEST Ministry of Education, Science and Technology MOFEP Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning MOGYCS Ministry of Gender, Youth and Comnmunity Services MOHA Ministry of Home Affairs MOHP Ministry of Health and Population MOJCA Ministry of Justice and Constitutional Affairs MPA Malawi Procurement Authority MPRS Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy MRA Malawi Revenue Authority MRFC Malawi Rural Finance Company MSB Malawi Savings Bank MSIS Malawi Social Indicator Survey MSME Micro, Small and Medium Scale Enterprise MSPAP Minister of State Responsible for Poverty Alleviation Programmes MTEF Medium Term Expenditure Framework MTL Malawi Telecommunications Limited NACP National Aids Control Programme NAO National Audit Office NASFAM National Smaliholder Farmers' Association of Malawi NBM National Bank of Malawi NBS New Building Society NEAP National Environmental Action Plan NEC National Economic Council NER Net Enrolment Rate NEWS National Early Warning System NGO Non Government Organisation NHP National Health Plan NRA National Roads Authority NRC Natural Resources College NRCM National Research Council of Malawi NRM Natural Resources Management NRUs Nutrition Rehabilitation Units NSO National Statistical Office NSSA National Sample Survey of Agriculture OECD Organisation of Economic Co-operation and Development OMO Open Market Operations OPD Out-Patients Department OPV Open Pollinated Variety ORT Other Recurrent Transactions PAC Public Accounts Committee PAP Poverty Alleviation Programme PEA Primary Education Advisor PEM Public Expenditure Management PER Public Expenditure Review PERMU Public Enterprise Reform and Monitoring Unit PIF Policy Investment Framework PMS Poverty Monitoring System PPE Priority Poverty Expenditure PRA Participatory Rural Assessment PRISAM Private Schools Association of Malawi PRS Poverty Reduction Strategy PRSP Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper PSLCE Primary School Leaving Certificate of Education PSMR Public Sector Management Reform PTC People's Trading Centre PTR Pupil to Teacher Ratio PWP Public Works Programme QUIM Qualitative Impact Monitoring R&D Research and Development RBM Reserve Bank of Malawi RDP Rural Development Programme RIC Rural Instruction Centre ROMARP Road Maintenance and Rehabilitation Project vi S&T Science and Technology SACCO Savings and Credit Cooperative Organisation SADC Southern Africa Development Community SAPs Structural Adjustment Programmes SEDOM Small Enterprises Development Organisation of Malawi SET Science, Engineering and Technology SIPs Sector Investment Programmes SME Small and Medium-Scale Enterprises SOER State of the Environment Report SPP Starter Pack Programme STIs Sexually Transmitted Infections SWAP Sector Wide Approach TB Tuberculosis TDC Teacher Development Centre TEVET Technical, Entrepreneurial, Vocational Education and Training TIP Targeted Input Programme TRF Textbook Revolving Fund TTC Teacher Training College TVM Television Malawi TWC Technical Working Committee TWG Thematic Working Group UNIMA University of Malawi UR Uruguay Round USAID United States Agency for International Development VAM Vulnerability Assessment and Mapping VCT Voluntary Counselling and Testing VIP Ventilated Improved Pit VSAT Very Small Aperture Terminal WB World Bank WID Women in Development WTO World Trade Organisation vii List of Tables Table 2.1: Indices of Inequality in Consumption ........................................................5 Table 2.2: Major Sources of Income (Percent of Total Per Capita Income) ................9 Table 2.3 Top Five Household Expenditure Categories (Percent of the Value of Total Consumption) ...........................................................9 Table 3.1: Basic Macroeconomic Indicators .......................................................... 14 Table 3.2: Functional Analysis of Total Government Expenditures: Estimates 1995/96-1999/2000(Percent) .......................................................... 16 Table 4.1: Selected Major Impact Targets for the MPRS 2002-2005 ......................... 19 Table 4.1.1: Extension Targets .......................................................... 24 Table 4.1.2: Irrigation Targets .......................................................... 26 Table 4.1.3: Final Smallholder Crop Estimates for Major Crops (Metric Tonnes) .. .. 27 Table 4.1.4: Trends in Livestock Population 1994-2000 .......................................... 27 Table 4.1.5: Livestock Targets .......................................................... 28 Table 4.1.6: Mechan i sation Targets ............................................................ 29 Table 4.1.7: Natural Resources Targets . .......................................................... 32 Table 4.1.8: Structure of Manufacturing Sector, Sub-Sectoral Shares (Percent) in Manufacturing Value Added, 1994 - 2000 ........................................................ 34 Table 4.1.9: Rural Feeder Roads Targets .......................................................... 42 Table 4.1.10: Water and Sanitation Targets .......................................................... 43 Table 4.1.11: Rural Energy Targets .......................................................... 43 Table 4.2.1: Basic Education Quality Targets .......................................................... 51 Table 4.2.2: Primary Education Access Targets ....................................................... 51 Table 4.2.3: Adult Literacy Education Targets .......................................................... 52 Table 4.2.4: Out-Of-School Youth Education Targets ............................................. 52 Table 4.2.5: Pre-School Education/ECD Targets ...................................................... 52 Table 4.2.6: Secondary School Targets .......................................................... 54 Table 4.2.7: Higher Education Targets .......................................................... 56 Table 4.2.8: Vocational Training Targets .......................................................... 57 Table 4.2.9: Comparative Health Indicators .......................................................... 58 Table 4.2.10: Conditions Addressed in the Malawian EHP ....................................... 60 Table 4.2.11: Selected Essential Healthcare Targets ................................................ 62 Table 4.2.12: Health Targets for 2007/8 .......................................................... 62 Table 4.2.13: Nutrition Indicators 1992 - 2000 ........................................................ 63 Table 4.3.1: Safety Nets Targets .......................................................... 70 Table 4.4.1: Security and Access to Justice Targets ................................................. 77 Table 5.1: Macroeconomic Assumptions for Resource Envelope ............................. 97 Table 5.2: Gross Resource Envelope .......................................................... 98 Table 5.3 Statutory and Statehood Expenditure ...................................................... 100 Table 5.4: MPRS Costing Summary by Pillar ........................................................ 101 Table 5.5 Detailed Costings by Goal and Sub-Goal (Millions of Malawi Kwacha) . 102 Table 6.1: Monitoring Indicators .......................................................... 109 Table 6.2 Key Monitoring Indicators ..........................................................111 List of Figures Figure 3.1: Trends in Money Supply (M2) and Inflation 1990-2000 ......................... 14 Figure 4.1: Logical Flow of MPRS .......................................................... 20 Figure 4.4.1: Conceptual Framework for Safety Nets ............................................... 65 viii Figure 6.1: Public Policy and Planning Framework ................................................ 107 Figure 6.2: Institutional Framework for the MPRS Monitoring System ................. 113 ix Executive Summary Poverty Analysis and Profile Poverty in Malawi is widespread, deep and severe. According to the 1998 Integrated Household Survey', 65.3 percent of the population was poor, or roughly 6.3 million people. Within this figure, about 28.7 percent of the population were living in extreme poverty. The level of inequality is well illustrated by the fact that the richest 20 percent of the population consumed 46.3 percent while the poorest 20 percent consumed only 6.3 percent of total goods and services. Consumption was also more unequally distributed within urban areas where the Gini coefficient2 was 0.52 as opposed to 0.37 for rural areas. The key causes of poverty are limited access to land, low education, poor health status, limited off-farm employment and a lack of access to credit. Sectoral analysis of poverty shows that social, human capital and income indicators are very poor. In 1998, about 52 percent of the poor were female and females headed around 25 percent of households. The literacy rate was low at 58 percent where female literacy rate was at 44 percent. Education attainment, defined as completion of Standard 8, was only 11.2 percent for adults aged 25 years and above, and only 6.2 percent for women. The national gross enrolment ratio was estimated at 132 and the pupil to qualified teacher ratio was 114, leading to overcrowding in schools and lower quality of education. In terms of health indicators, life expectancy at birth has dropped from 43 years in 1996 to 39 years in 2000. In 2000, infant and under-five mortality rates were estimated to be 104 and 189 deaths per 1,000 live births, respectively. The matemal mortality rate in 2000 was 1,120 deaths per 100,000 live births3, a rise from 620 in 1990. The 1998 Integrated Household Survey demonstrated that subsistence agriculture remained the main source of income for the rural poor, accounting for 63.7 percent of income. Notably, income from agricultural sales was not the most important source of cash income in rural areas. The major source of cash income for Malawian households was wage income, which contributed about 13.0 percent of income for the rural poor. However, there was limited participation in the cash economy by the poor. Lessons from Past Experience Since 1981, Malawi has implemented a series of policy interventions through World Bank and IMF backed Structural Adjustment Programmes (SAPs) in order to address structural weaknesses and adjust the economy to attain sustainable growth. From 1994, these interventions have been complemented by the Poverty Alleviation ' Government of Malawi (2000) Profile of Poverty in Malawi: Poverty Analysis of the Integrated Household Survey 1998 2 Gini coefficient is a measure of income inequality within a given population. 3Malawi Govemment (2000) Malawi Demographic and Health Survey 2000 x Programme (PAP), which emphasises the need to raise national productivity through sustainable broad-based economic growth and socio-cultural development. Despite these interventions, poverty has remained a reality for the majority of Malawians. Inconsistent implementation of the SAPs led to only short-lived economic recovery and failed to create sustainable broad based growth. Further, many of the high costs of adjustment were borne by the poor. Despite some successes, the PAP suffered from the absence of a well-articulated action plan to ensure a holistic approach to implementation. In particular, there have been inadequate linkages to the Budget, little prioritisation and a lack of target setting. The Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy To achieve meaningful poverty reduction and learn lessons from this past experience, the process to develop the Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper (MPRSP) was initiated. The Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy (MPRS) outlined in the MPRSP is the overarching strategy that will form the basis for all future activities by all stakeholders, including Government. The MPRS is the product of a highly consultative process involving a broad range of stakeholders and represents a consensus about how Malawi can develop and achieve its core objective of poverty reduction. The overall goal of the MPRS is to achieve "sustainable poverty reduction through empowerment of the poor". Rather than regarding the poor as helpless victims of poverty in need of band-outs and passive recipients of trickle-down growth, the MPRS sees them as active participants in economic development. The MPRS also emphasises prioritisation and action. The MPRS is built around four pillars. lThese pillars are the main strategic components grouping the various activities and policies into a coherent framework for poverty reduction. The first pillar promotes rapid sustainable pro-poor economic growth and structural transformation. The second pillar enhances human capital development. The third pillar improves the quality of life of the most vulnerable. The fourth pillar promotes good governance. The MPRS also mainstreams key cross cutting issues such as HIV/AIDS, gender, environment, and science and technology. Sustainable Pro-Poor Growth Pro-poor growth is economic growth that involves and benefits the poor. It is a prerequisite for broadening income distribution and generating employment. The most fundamental challenge for the pillar is to offer the poor an opportunity to generate their own incomes, whilst providing the medium and large-scale private sector an enabling environment for investment. This will be achieved through the promotion of specific sectoral sources of pro-poor growth, and the creation of an enabling environment for pro-poor growth. The key specific sectoral source of growth is agriculture, although efforts will be made to diversify, especially through Micro, Small and Medium Scale Enterprises (MSMEs), into natural resources, manufacturing, tourism and small-scale mining. In xi agriculture, the focus is on the provision of necessary services and conditions to farmers for increased incomes. This involves interventions ranging from availability of inputs through improved production technologies and value addition to marketing. These interventions will, where, possible be targeted at farmers' clubs, associations and co-operatives. In natural resources, community-based management will be promoted in order to ensure conservation and sustainable utilisation of natural resources as an additional off-farm source of income. As regards MSMEs, emphasis is on creating an enabling environment for the development and operation of MSMEs. The MPRS reorients industrial and trade strategies to ensure increased contribution of the manufacturing, tourism and small-scale mining sectors to GDP. Deliberate attempts will be made to develop sector-specific clusters and to attract foreign capital in these sectors. The key factors that will contribute to an environment conducive for pro-poor growth are macroeconomic stability, access to credit, and improved rural infrastructure. Efforts will also be made to improve enabling infrastructure, strengthen trade and investment arrangements and review taxation policy. Macroeconomic stability is a prerequisite for private sector development and economic growth. Access to affordable credit is one of the most important factors affecting production and therefore income of the poor. The goal in micro-finance is therefore to promote the development of a sustainable micro-finance industry. Under rural infrastructure, the key issues are to ensure rehabilitation and maintenance of existing infrastructure, and to increase investment. These issues are common to rural feeder roads, rural water supply and sanitation, rural electrification and rural telecommunications. The MPRS refocuses resources on other enabling infrastructure development by giving priority to maintenance and rehabilitation of facilities, outlining' selective investments in new facilities, promoting greater participation of the private sector, encouraging cost recovery and guaranteeing long term financial support for maintenance and rehabilitation. This applies to the core road network, power, telecommunications and broadcasting. Finally, the MPRS will further widen the tax base to facilitate the lowering of tax burden on the enterprise sector. Tax relief and incentives will be rationalised and corporate tax will also be reviewed. Human Capital Development The MPRS recognises that human capital is key to poverty reduction in Malawi. A healthy and educated population leads to increased productivity, better incomne distribution and a generally improved standard of living. The overall goal of the pillar is to ensure that human capital of the whole population is developed to fully participate in the socio-economic development of the country. This will be achieved through the provision of basic education, technical, entrepreneurial and vocational education and training (TEVET), an Essential Healthcare Package (EHP), and the promotion of good nutrition. In education, efforts will be made to improve quality and relevance, access and equity. Quality will be enhanced through training and adequately compensating and xli supervising teachers, increasing access to teaching and leaming materials and revising the curricula, to incorporate cross-cutting issues, practical skills and entrepreneurial culture. In terms of access and equity, focus will be on increasing the participation of girls and children with special needs. The administration of all levels of education will also be reformed, focussing on decentralisation and focussing resources on core activities. Whilst the focus of Government's efforts and resources will be on basic education (primary education up to Standard 8 and adult literacy programmes) as the minimum requirement for poverty reduction, attention will also be paid to secondary and higher levels of education, which will provide the capacity necessary to implement the MPRS and ensure sustainable national development. However, at these levels, efforts will be made to reduce the fiscal burden by introducing cost recovery and encouraging the involvement of the private sector, together with targeted bursary schemes. Technical, entrepreneurial and vocational education and training (TEVET) is essential in providing the population with practical and usable skills that can be used to increase income. The MPRS focuses on promoting self-employment through skills development initiatives, particularly in rural areas, and on improving the quality and relevance of all TEVET activities. The target population is not just school drop-outs but covers all persons interested in acquiring new skills. The overall objective of the health sector is to improve the health status of Malawians by improving access to, quality and equity of health services. This will be achieved through the design and implementation of an Essential Healthcare Package (EHP). The EHP will address the major causes of morbidity and mortality among the general population and focuses particularly on medical conditions and service gaps that disproportionately affect the rural poor. The key strategies under the EHP are to recruit, train and adequately remunerate nurses and other health workers, to promote the construction of health facilities, especially through the construction of rural health centres and to increase the availability of drugs. These delivery components will be supported by ongoing reforms to health services, focussing resources on preventative and primary healthcare, and decentralising management and administrative responsibilities. Malnutrition is both a cause and a consequence of poverty. In order to improve the nutritional status of Malawians, the MPRS includes strategies aimed at improving infant and young child feeding, promoting community based nutrition interventions, and encouraging people to diversify and modify their diets. Improving the Quality of Life of the Most Vulnerable The proposed broad-based growth in Pillar 1 and the inclusive human capital development in Pillar 2 will go a long way in reducing the numbers of the poor. However, it is recognised that there are still going to be some sections of the population that are not going to benefit and will need direct assistance to improve xiii their living standards. The overall goal of the third pillar is, therefore, to ensure that the quality of life of the most vulnerable is improved and maintained at an acceptable level by providing moderate support to the transient poor and substantial transfers to the chronically poor. To support the overall goal, four types of safety nets have been designed. Firstly, the targeted inputs programme will enhance the productivity of the capital-constrained poor by distributing free agricultural inputs. Secondly, public works programmes will increase the productivity of the labour abundant but land constrained poor by employing them to create and maintain socio-economic infrastructure. Thirdly, targeted nutrition programmes will assist malnourished children as well as lactating and pregnant mothers. In addition, direct welfare transfers will be affected to support the poor who cannot be supported by any of the three programmes. Finally, areas, individuals and households affected by disasters will benefit from any or a combination of the safety net programmes depending on the nature of the disaster. Beneficiary targeting and selection mechanisms will be strengthened through the introduction of community-based methods. Good Governance Even with the best strategies for pro-poor growth, human capital and safety nets, poverty will not be reduced unless there is development-oriented governance, political will and mindset. In particular, the technical design of the MPRS will be irrelevant unless there is the political, bureaucratic and popular will to implement it. The overall objective of Pillar 4 is therefore to ensure that public institutions and systems protect and benefit the poor. Strategies to address problems of govemance will focus on strengthening systems of transparency and accountability across the public sector and ensuring popular participation in decision-making processes. Strong political will must be demonstrated by political leaders from all parties and by other decision-makers through willingness to make and implement hard prioritisation decisions and to avoid politicisation of development. Issues of mindset can be addressed by a concerted effort to change the terms of political discourse away from creating expectations of material gain in return for electoral support. Instead, efforts should be made to disseminate the message that the poor have to solve their own problems and that Govenmment alone cannot do everything. Protection from crime, violence, arbitrary state power and injustice is a fundamental part of welfare. Insecurity makes it too risky for the poor to accumulate assets and wealth, particularly in a rural setting. To address the problem, Government will implement an integrated approach to security and justice, involving the development of increased crime control capacity through increasing police presence, and improved crime prevention through enhanced community involvement in policing and the development of counselling methods at all levels. The judicial system will work to ensure improved access to and delivery of effective and efficient justice, particularly Xiv to the poor and vulnerable. Finally, efforts will be made to ensure that the prison system is focused more on rehabilitation than punishment. Good public expenditure management (PEM) is central to the MPRS as it will ensure that Government's limited resources are channelled to the priority activities with impact on poverty reduction. To ensure effective public expenditure management, MPRS will improve Budget implementation by strengthening the political leadership of the Budget process and ensure accountability by improving financial management and expenditure control mechanisms. Thirdly, the planning of public expenditure will be improved by increasing the comprehensiveness of the budget and strengthening links between the MPRS and the Budget. Finally, Government will promote accountability and transparency by sharing information with civil society and the media. The efficiency and accountability of the public sector is critical to the success of the MPRS since the public sector has the mandate to lead the formulation, implementation, and monitoring of national, sectoral and district policies and actions. The MPRS will therefore involve establishing an effective incentive structure that will improve work ethics and productivity. Government will also review the structure of the civil service so that it focuses on poverty reduction. High levels of corruption and fraud reduce economic growth, discourage legitimate business investment, and reduce the public resources available for the delivery of services to the poor. The MPRS will take further steps to eliminate corruption and fraud by improving prevention measures, especially through the creation of a Malawi Procurement Authority (MPA) and by improving detection and prosecution, by reviewing the legal framework and strengthening the Anti-Corruption Bureau (ACB). Decentralisation focuses on the empowerment of the people for effective popular participation and decision making in the development process in their respective areas. The MPRS includes activities aimed to developing institutional capacities for local govemance, transferring functions to local govemments and revising institutional frameworks across Govermment to ensure consistency with decentralisation. At the heart of effective govemance is democracy. By formally recognising that all legal and political authority rests in the people, democratic constitutions empower the people. In practical terms, this principle operates through elections and the existence of checks and balances on the executive. The MPRS includes activities to further strengthen formal checks and balances, especially parliament and the judiciary, in addition to efforts to strengthen informal checks and balances such as the media and civil society. Respect and exercising of human rights are fundamental to poverty reduction. In order to strengthen the protection of human rights, the MPRS includes a review of the roles and functions of the many human rights organisations and provides for capacity xv building where the organisations demonstrate their effectiveness. In addition efforts will be made to raise the awareness of citizens about their constitutional rights and obligations. Cross Cutting Issues In addition to the above components of Govemment's poverty reduction strategy, there are a number of cross-cutting issues that are crucial to Govemment's efforts to reducing poverty, such as HIV/AIDS, gender, environment and science and technology. The spread of HIV/AIDS is threatening to undermine all attempts to reducing poverty in Malawi, both directly through the prevalence of HIV/AIDS and indirectly through the resulting shortages of skilled human resources in all sectors. The MPRS will focus on reducing incidence of HIV/AIDS, while attention will also be paid to improving the quality of life of people living with HIV/AIDS and mitigating against the economic and social impacts of HIV/AIDS. Inequalities and disparities between women and men are still very pronounced in Malawi and this is one of the major causes of poverty among women and men. In view of this situation, efforts will be made to establish a gender sensitive formal and informal legal environment, eradicate gender based violence, and enhance women's participation in leadership and decision-making processes. Malawi's natural resources are threatened by the demand placed on them by the poor. Despite several efforts aimed at addressing the problem, environmental degradation continues. Henceforth, the goal is to achieve poverty reduction through wise, sustainable and economic use of natural resources and the environment. Strategies include strengthening the legal and institutional framework to encourage local communities to control and sustainably manage natural resources, developing altemative livelihood strategies and creating environmental awareness. The low content of science and technology in national economic development programmes is a barrier to economic growth and therefore exacerbates poverty. Therefore, the MPRS will improve the capacity and capability of the national system for science and technology, intensify promotion and transfer of technologies to key livelihood systems and increase investment in research and development. Macroeconomic and Expenditure Framework Macroeconomic stability is a precondition for economic growth and poverty reduction, and requires fiscal discipline and tight monetary policies. Prudent fiscal management requires that Govemment spends within its means, and therefore that expenditure requirements are balanced with resources available in a stable macroeconomic environment. xvi Economic instability in the past has been characterised by high inflation and interest rates and an unstable exchange rate. This has exacerbated poverty since inflation erodes purchasing power, particularly of the poor, and acts as a disincentive to savings and investment. High interest rates make credit inaccessible to the poor and further discourage investment. In order to rectify this, Government will adopt strong fiscal, monetary and external policies. In terms of fiscal policy, further efforts will be made to improve public expenditure management, strengthen the independence of the Reserve Bank of Malawi (RBM) and accelerate the reform of the parastatal sector. Macroeconomic projections suggest that the resource envelope consistent with a stable macro-economic environment will be K41.3 billion during 2002/3, K44.0 billion in 2003/4 and K50.3 billion in 2004/5. These projected resource envelopes are deliberately based on realistic assumptions based on past experience and technical knowledge. This resource envelope is then linked to the costs associated with the MPRS. Three types of costs are presented: statutory, statehood and MPRS. Statutory activities are by definition those that have to be funded and cannot be scaled down. Statehood activities do not directly reduce poverty, but are essential in any country as the basic activities that enable the functioning of state by promoting and protecting national integrity, security and leadership. As with any other resource allocations, these activities must have a hard budget constraint. Any extra-budgetary expenditure on statehood activities automatically necessitates a reduction in MPRS expenditure. MPRS costings are the core of the costing framework and are based on the estimated cost of each individual MPRS activity to be implemented by or through Govermnent. Where possible, unit cost analysis was used to link output targets with costs. MPRS Implementation, Monitoring and Evaluation The implementation of the MPRS will involve all stakeholders4. However, the responsibility for overall co-ordination of implementation will rest with Government, and in particular, the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning. Crucial to the success of the MPRS is the need to implement only the MPRS. The strategy has been designed to be comprehensive and has been costed so that it is in line with the resources available. To be implemented, the MPRS must at all levels be translated into the Medium Term Expenditure Framework (MTEF) and the Budget, and that Budget itself must be fully implemented. Monitoring and evaluation of the MPRS implementation is key to the achievement of the goals of the MPRS. MPRS implementation will be monitored using various indicators provided in the action plan for each component of the MPRS. Monitoring and evaluation of these various levels of indicators will take place at national, district and local levels. This system will involve all interested stakeholders at each of these 4The general objectives and strategies contained in the MPRS apply to all stakeholders. However, the costing of detailed activities is limited to those activities implemented by or through Government. xvii levels, with overall co-ordination provided by the National Economic Council. District-level monitoring and evaluation systems are currently being designed and will be reviewed and fully integrated after the first annual review process. The monitoring and evaluation system will assist in the annual review of MPRS. This will take the form of stakeholders' workshops and dissemination of reports on the review process and the revised MPRSP. Annual reviews will be complemented by a comprehensive review process every three years. This comprehensive review is to be more like the initial MPRS Preparation Process, involving District Workshops, Thematic Working Groups and a complete redesigning of the MPRS. xviii Chapter 1 - Introduction The Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper (MPRSP) is Malawi's overarching statement of strategy. It will form the basis for all future Government activities and provide a guiding framework for Government's development partners, both domestic and international. It is the product of a highly consultative process involving a broad range of stakeholders. Thus, it represents a consensus about how Malawi can develop and achieve its core objective of poverty reduction. The MPRSP focuses on what Malawi as a nation can do to meet its poverty reduction targets. The strategy as a whole belongs to the nation, but many of the specific activities within it and the overall co-ordination of implementation will be done by Government5. The private sector and civil society6 will play important roles in working with Government to implement and monitor the strategy. As a statement of national strategy, the MPRSP does not go into detail on the specific actions and spatial distribution of the activities it proposes. These details will be provided by the sector specific plans (for example, the Sector Investment Programmes (SIPs) and District Development Plans (DDPs) that will be developed in line with the MPRSP. 1.1 Distinguishing Features The Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy (MPRS) is a major departure from previous plans and strategies. Firstly, the MPRS differs in its underlying philosophy. The overall goal of the MPRS is to achieve "sustainable poverty reduction through socio-economic and political empowerment of the poor7". It moves away from seeing the poor as helpless victims of poverty in need of hand-outs and as passive recipients of trickle-down growth. Instead, the poor are seen as masters of their own destinies. Government's and development partners' role is to create the conditions whereby the poor can reduce their own poverty. This change in philosophy is reflected across the MPRS. The second distinguishing feature of the MPRS is its focus on implementation. At the heart of this focus is the emphasis on prioritisation and action. In the past, Malawi's development objectives have not been met because Government has tried to do too much and as a result has spread itself too thinly and has achieved too little. Many previous Government plans have not been implemented because of lack of action planning, broad ownership and realism. The MPRS has been designed to address ihese problems. A third and related distinguishing feature is the participation involved in the MPRS preparation process. A broad range of stakeholders were involved in the formulation of the strategy, through national level consultations, district consultations and Thematic Working Groups (TWGs), as detailed in Section 1.2 below. This participation will continue during the monitoring, evaluation and reviewing of the MPRS. Government here is defined broadly as the three branches of Government: The Executive (including the Civil Service), the Legislature (parliament) and the Judiciary. This is at both national and district level. 6 Civil society includes NGOs, faith community organisations, labour organisations and traditional authorities. 7Throughout this document the term poor" is inclusive of women, men, girls and boys. Fourthly, the MPRS differs in its comprehensiveness. Rather than treating poverty reduction as an issue separate from the bulk of Government operations, the MPRS covers the whole of Government. It is the starting point for a reorientation of Government towards meeting its core objective of poverty reduction so that all of its activities are poverty focussed (either directly or indirectly). As such, Government will ultimately implement only the MPRS, through various supporting mechanisms of which the budget is the most important. All poverty reduction and development initiatives and programmes will fall under the umbrella of the MPRS. As such, it will not only be Government that implements the MPRS - all stakeholders in Malawi have a role to play in implementation. Finally, the MPRS will be implemented in the context of decentralisation. The devolution of functions and responsibilities to the districts represents a fundamental change in the way Government will work, bringing itself closer to the poor themselves. In future years, the strategies detailed in the MPRSP will be implemented more by local Govermnents than by central Government line ministries, whose role will be reduced to national policy-making, setting standards and regulations and co-ordination. In addition, the design of the MPRS itself will be based on district level poverty reduction plans as an input into national level discussions. The integration of decentralisation into the MPRSP will be achieved through the annual review process, as the process of decentralisation proceeds and as functions are devolved to the district assemblies. 1.2 The MPRSP Process As detailed in Annex 6a, the preparation of the MPRSP was achieved through a highly consultative process involving a broad range of stakeholders8 over the course of 15 months. The process was iterative both between Government and other stakeholders and between the MPRSP Technical Committee and the sectoral working groups. Many of the details of the strategy were provided by 21 Thematic Working Groups (TWGs). These TWGs were drawn from a broad variety of stakeholders, including Government, civil society, NGOs, donors, private sector, and faith communities. They drafted sectoral contributions that were prioritised and costed to reflect the focus on poverty. The process also involved consultations on more general issues at a district level. Stakeholders in all the 27 districts and 4 cities and municipalities were consulted. Issues which emerged from these consultations are highlighted in Annex 6b. The stakeholders involved in these consultations included Traditional Authorities, Members of Parliament, Ward Councillors, political leaders of various parties, district chief executives and their staff members, local non- Governmental Organisations (NGOs) and some ordinary citizens representing the voices of the poor. s The reports on the various stages of consultations contain detailed information on participants, methodology and content of the consultations and are listed in the Bibliography. These are available from the Technical Committee or from www.finance.malawi.gov.mw 2 After the consultations and the completion of the sectoral contributions by the TWGs, a drafting team was formed, drawing members from the Technical Committee, civil society, private sector and NGOs. The resulting draft was discussed at a series of stakeholders' workshops, involving Government officials, Principal Secretaries, Members of Parliament, the private sector, Traditional Authorities, councillors, donors, NGOs, civil society, faith communities and trade unions. The comments arising from these workshops were then incorporated by the drafting team, with a focus on refining the costing and prioritisation in consultation with the TWGs. This revised draft was then conmmented on by Principal Secretaries, donors Cabinet, and civil society and subsequently this final draft was prepared. 1.3 The Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy The MPRS outlined in this paper has four pillars. These pillars are the main strategic components grouping the various activities and policies into a coherent framework for poverty reduction. These are: 1. Sustainable Pro-Poor Economic Growth - economically empowering the poor by ensuring macroeconomic stability, access to credit and markets, skills development and employment generation. 2. Human Capital Development - ensuring the poor have the health status and education to lift themselves out of poverty. 3. Improving the Quality of Life for the Most Vulnerable - providing sustainable safety nets for those who are unable to. benefit from the first two pillars. 4. Good Governance - ensuring that public and civil society institutions and systems protect and benefit the poor. In addition, there are four issues that cut across these pillars: HIV/AIDS, Gender, Environment, and Science and Technology. 1.4 The Content of the MPRSP The paper gives essential background information and outlines the strategy itself Chapter 2 answers the question: "Who are the poor and why?" by giving a situational analysis of poverty. This analysis sets the stage for the rest of the paper by defining what the problem is that needs to be solved. Chapter 3 gives some overall background of Malawi's developmental efforts and performance. It discusses why Malawi has in the past failed to meet its objectives and outlines lessons from this experience. Chapter 4 is the core of the MPRSP, since it outlines the underlying philosophy and approach of the MPRS based in part on the lessons learned from Chapter 3. It then summarises the strategies under each pillar of the MPRS, justifying them with reference to their impact on poverty and to lessons from past and present experience. Chapter 5 outlines the macroeconomic framework and expenditure framework within which the MPRS will operate. In particular, it provides macroeconomic targets and the associated resource availability. It then presents a summary of the cost implications of the strategies summarised in Chapter 4 and compares them to resource availability. 3 Chapter 6 summarises the modalities for implementing the MPRS. In particular, it outlines the relationship between the MPRS and the annual Budget, presents the institutional framework for the monitoring and evaluation of the MPRS, and describes the process for reviewing the MPRS. The document also contains seven annexes. The first presents the Action Plan for the MPRS. The second presents a summary of the costings of the MPRS activities by objective. The third presents certain large-scale infrastructure development projects. The fourth annex contains a selection of monitoring indicators. The fifth presents a glossary of terms whilst the sixth contains a summary of the MPRS Preparation Process. Finally, the seventh annex contains the bibliography. The full Action Plan matrix, with comprehensive and detailed costings and monitoring information, is available as a separate technical document. 4 Chapter 2: Poverty Analysis and Profile In general, Malawians characterise poverty "...as a state of continuous deprivation or a lack of the basics of life." 9 Basic needs include economic, social, psychological and physiological requirements. Poverty, therefore, has many dimensions including income poverty and human or capability poverty. Poverty exists, and is observable, at various levels: at the individual, household, community and national levels, and has a gender dimension. Qualitative'° information from the poor themselves also defines poverty in terms of lack of felt basic needs at household and community level. 2.1 Poverty Situation Poverty in Malawi is widespread, deep and severe. Based on 1998 Integrated Household Survey (IHS) consumption data' 1, 65.3 percent of the population is poor, or roughly 6.3 million people. The poor, in this case, are defined as those whose consumption of basic needs (both food and non-food) is below the minimum level estimated at MK 10.4712 per day in 1998. Within this number of the poor, 28.2 percent of the total population are living in dire poverty. In general, the poor have low levels of access to or acquisition of certain basic social services or capabilities. The level of inequality is well illustrated by the fact that in 1997/98, the richest 20 percent of the population consumed 46.3 percent while the poorest 20 percent consumed only 6.3 percent of total reported consumption of goods and services. In urban areas, the richest 20 percent consumed 58.4 percent while the poorest 20 percent consumed only 4.5 percent. Consumption was also more unequally distributed within urban areas where the Gini coefficient was 0.52 as opposed to 0.37 in rural areas (see Table 2.1)13. Table 2.1: Indices o Iequality in Consumption Source: Government of Malawi (2000) Profile of Powerty in Malawi.: Poverty Analysis of the Integrated Household Survey Despite this pervasiveness, some sections of the population are generally more affected than others. These include land-constrained smallholder farmers; labour-constrained female-headed households; estate workers or tenants; ganyu04 and other casual labourers; destitute or ' Govemnment of Malawi and United Nations Development Programme (1993) Situation Analysis of Poverty in Malawi 'o Government of Malawi (2000) Qualitative Impact Monitor-ing of Poverty Alleviation Policies and Programmes; World Bank (1999) Voices ofthe Poor. " Government of Malawi (2000) Profle of Poverty in Malawi: Poverty Analysis of the Integrated Household Survey 1998 12 Average Exchange Rate in 1998 was MK3 1.1 1uI US Dollar. '" Ibid. 9 4The 1997/98 Gini-coefficient cannot be compared with the 1991/92 Gini-coefficient of 0.62 due to methodological differences. lGanyu is piecework in return for cash or in kind 5 disadvantaged children, like orphans, street children and child heads of households; persons with disabilities; low income urban households; the elderly; the uneducated and the unemployed. 2.2 Causes of Poverty Poverty in Malawi is caused by a myriad of factors. Many of these factors are constraints on the economic productivity of land, labour, capital, and technology. Constraints on the productivity of land include rapid environmental degradation, and limited or inadequate access to land. Constraints on labour include generally low levels of education, poor health status including HIV/AIDS, lack of or limited off-farm employment, rapid.population growth, and gender inequalities. The key constraint on capital is lack of access to credit. All of these factors causing poverty are exacerbated by generally weak institutional capacity within the country. 2.3 Spatial Distribution of Poverty Poverty is more prevalent in rural areas than in urban areas. It is estimated that 66.5 percent of the rural population live in poverty as compared to 54 Fiwure 2.1 Soatial Distribution of Povertv as 90 percent of the population live in rural areas, 91.3 percent of the poor and 91.5 percent of the ultra poor also live in rural areas16 Individual poverty headcount The Southern Region has the highest proportion of t by district poor households compared to the other two regions in the country. Using IHS data, 68.1 percent of the population in the Southern Region were poor as compared to 62.8 percent for the Central Region and 62.5 percent for the Northern Region. The under 55% Southern Region's poverty situation can partly be 55 to 75% explained mainly by migration into the Region and above 75% by the small size of cropland holdings per capita estimated at 0.176 hectares compared to 0.257 hectares and 0.256 hectares for Central and Northem regions respectively. . ; However, the aggregate regional picture of the ,** incidence of poverty hides considerable variation. As the map shows in Figure 2.1, not all urban centres have low poverty head counts nor have all districts in the Central and Northern Regions. *C-. Pockets of poverty are found throughout the country. The areas with the highest poverty headcount are Ntcheu (84.0 percent); Phalombe 16 Government of Malawi (2000) Profile of Poverty in Malawi: Poverty Analysis of the Integrated Household Survey 1998 6 (83.9 percent); Zomba Municipality (78.0 percent); Thyolo (76.8 percent); and Ntchisi (76.3 percent). 2.5 Sectoral Analysis of Poverty 2.5.1 Demographic Characteristics Poor households tend to have larger families with many dependents. The national dependency ratio (dependents per person of working age) is 0.89. However, the dependency ratio for poor households is higher at 1.0517. Females head 25 percent of all households and these households have always been disproportionately poor, especially in the rural areas. In urban areas, female headed households are less likely to be poor and tend to' be more educated and in formal 18 employment Orphans are one of the groups most affected by poverty. According to the 1998 Census19, 1.5 percent of those aged 20 years or younger had lost both of their parents. Most of these orphans lived with grandparents who were in most cases single and resource constrained. The 1998 IHS revealed that 3.6 percent of households were headed by women aged over 65 years, whilst 0.6 percent of households were headed by individuals under the age of 20, which is a reflection of the emergence of child headed households20. 2.5.2 Educational Characteristics Malawi has a low adult literacy rate, which was estimated at 58 percent in 1998. This low level is combined with gender disparity, with the female literacy rate estimated at 44 percent. Adults who complete at least standard 8 are likely not to be poor. This was particularly true in urban areas. However, few Malawians attained that level of education as only about 11.2 percent of adults aged 25 years and above completed Standard 8, where 16.2 percent was for 21 male and 6.2 percent for female There is very little difference between poor and non-poor households in regard to the proportion of primary school-aged children who are currently in school. However, poor children are likely to drop out of school before reaching Standard 5. Drop-out rates increase with the educational ladder and are higher for girls and in rural areas. The male drop-out rate was estimated at 9.5 percent while the female rate was at 14.1 percent22 . The increase in enrolment caused by the introduction of Free Primary Education (FPE), as reflected in a Gross Enrolment Ratio (GER) of 132, has had a negative impact on the quality of education. For example, the pupil to qualified teacher ratio was 114 in 2000, leading to high repetition rates as classes become too big to manage. Repetition is highest in standard 1 (45.3 percent) and in 17 Govemment of Malawi (2000) Profile of Poverty in Malawi: Poverty Analysis of the Integrated Household Survey 1998 '" ibid. 19 Government of Malawi (1998) Malawi Population and Housing Census 20 Government of Malawi (2000) Profile of Poverty in Malawi: Poverty Analysis of the Integrated Household Survey 1998 21 ibid. 22 Government of Malawi (2000) Demographic and Health Survey 7 rural areas (47.1 percent). In urban areas the repetition rate was estimated at 29.1 percent. This is also compounded by the use of unqualified teachers. Despite the introduction of Free Primary Education (FPE), the Net Enrolment Rate (NER) has remained at 78 percent implying that there are other factors that prevent children from attending school23. 2.5.4 Health, Fertility, and Nutrition Characteristics Life expectancy has dropped from 43 years at birth in 1996 to 39 years in 2000, partly as a result of the HIV/AIDS epidemic. Infant, child and maternal mortality rates in Malawi are high by global standards. In 2000, infant and under-five mortality rates were estimated to be 104 and 189 deaths per 1,000 live births, respectively. The maternal mortality rate in 2000 was 1,120 deaths per 100,000 live births24. This might be due to limited access to health services as evidenced by a low percentage of births attended by health workers of 43 percent. Children in Malawi are generally malnourished. In 2000, 49 percent of children under age 5 were found to be stunted (low height for age). In addition, the poor consume only 66 percent of the recommended daily calorie requirement showing that malnutrition affects adults as well. Malawi also has a high total fertility rate estimated at 6.3 children per woman. It is, however, evident that the wealthier and more educated the mother, the less likely her children are to be malnourished and the lower the total fertility rate25. 2.5.3 Economic Characteristics Almost half of poor households are self-employed and agriculture is the predominant economic activity, especially for rural areas. However, most of the poor are constrained in terms of both land and labour. About 81 percent of the poorest 10 percent of households have landholdings of less than 0.5 hectare. By contrast, 64 percent of the richest 10 percent of households cultivate more than I hectare of land26. Females are disproportionately affected by labour constraints as they spend more time caring for their families including the sick, especially HIV/AIDS patients. Around 50.4 percent of the population is engaged in non-farm business activity, and this proportion is higher in urban areas (67.5 percent) than in rural areas (47.9 percent). Trading is the commonest non-farm business activity for both the urban and rural areas. However, in the urban areas trading is more common among the poor while in the rural it is dominated by the non-poor. Small-scale lending institutions appear to be operating more in rural areas than in urban areas. About 19.8 percent of households in the rural areas reported having acquired a loan while for the urban areas it was only 10.5 percent of households27. 2.5.3.1 Sources of Income As shown in Table 2.2, subsistence agriculture is the main source of income for the rural poor, accounting for 63.7 percent of income. Despite this, most agricultural production is home- 23 Government of Malawi (2000) Malawi Demographic and Health Survey 24 Government of Malawi (2000) Malawi Demographic and Health Survey 2000 25 ibid 26 Government of Malawi (2000) Profile of Poverty in Malawi: Poverty Analysis of the Integrated Household Survey 1998 27 ibid. 8 consumed. Notably, income from agricultural sales is not the most important source of cash income in rural areas. The major source of cash income for Malawian households is wage income, which contributes about 13.0 percent of income for the rural poor28. However, there is limited participation in the cash economy by the poor, especially by women. Table 2.2: Ma or Sources of Income (Percent of Total Per Ca ita Income) nome production consumed 55.9 38.1 63.7 59.1 11.8 3.1 Wages and salaries 21.5 30.9 13.0 17.3 69.2 53.7 Business income -2.3 10.5 1.3 2.6 8.1 23.6 Agiricultural sales 8.0 4.9 9.5 7.6 -0.6 0.7 (Lnet of ir,put costs) IIncome transfiers 6.2 5.0 , 6.5 6. 46 32 Other income 6.1 10.6 6.0 7.4 6.9 15.7 Source: Govemment of Malawi (2000) Profile of Poverty in Malawi: Poverty Analysis of the Integrated Household Survey 1998. 2.5.3.2 Expenditure Patterns Generally, poor households spend most of their income on food. Food insecurity is considered to be a major attribute of a poor household29. As shown in Table 2.3, about 76.0 percent of the income of the poor is used for food, while non-poor households use only 55.4 percent of their income for food. The rural poor also are likely to spend more on food (80.9 percent) than the urban poor (57.5 percent). Notably, the urban poor spend relatively more on housing and utilities than the rural poor30. Thus there is inadequate income to be spent on other basic needs as well as productive means. Table 2.3 Top Five Household Expenditure Categories (Percent of the Value of Total Consumption) Food 76.0 55.4 80.9 69.7 57.5 29. 8 Utilites and Housing 2.8 9.5 0.6 2.8 11.2 21.3 Clothing_ 5.2 7.2 5.1 7.3 5.5 7.0 Gifts, transfers, or loans 2.0 6.4 1.4 4.7 4.2 9.4 Fuels 4.3 1 3.4 3.5 3.6 1 7.7 3 .0 Source: Govemment of Malawi (2000) Profile of Poverty in Malawi: Poverty Analysis of the Integrated Household Survey 1998, Table 36. 2. 5. 3.3 Ownership of Assets Low income results in low levels of ownership of assets. Assets like beds, tables, chairs, and bicycles are absent in two-thirds of Malawian households. Qualitative studies have confirmed that lack of assets at household level is an attribute of poverty. However, even those who reported to have acquired assets, the quality of such assets is generally poor. 2S ibid. 29 Government of Malawi (2000) Qualitative Impact Monitoring of Poverty Alleviation Policies and Programmes 30 Government of Malawi (2000) Profile of Poverty in Malawi: Poverty Analysis of the Integrated Household Survey 1998 9 2.6 Summary of Poverty Issues The prevailing poverty situation highlights the issues that the MPRS must direct its focus in terms of policy and progranmne implementation. This information is also to serve as the basis for monitoring the progress in the implementation of the MPRS. It is evident that a large proportion of the people in Malawi are living in poverty and most peoples' basic needs at household and community levels have not been addressed in the past. Within households, unequal access and control over means and opportunities has further exacerbated the poverty of women and girls. Most of the poor are concentrated in the rural areas where there are limited economic activities. Rural development will therefore form the core of the MPRS with the aim of creating the conditions for the poor to increase their cash incomes and access to basic services. Pro-poor economic growth strategies are outlined in Pillar I of the MPRSP and ensure that that the poor both participate and benefit from growth. The poor socio-economic indicators point to the need to improve access and delivery of social services and therefore increase and improve human development There are implementation gaps in the quality of and access to health services both in terms of prevention and treatment of diseases. Improving the quality of and access to education is a pre-requisite for developing the country's appropriate skills and knowledge. Social service delivery is treated under human capital development strategies in Pillar 2 of the MPRSP. Food security is a serious threat to better life and this often translates into problems of malnutrition. Food security is very dependent on size of land, education, available factors of production and a person's income purchasing power. The stability or erosion of purchasing power of incomes also has strong linkages on the macroeconomic stability of the economy. -Chapters 3 and 5 of the MPRSP relate macroeconomic framework issues to poverty and indicate how unsustainable deficits lead into inflationary pressures, which adversely harm the poor. There are some core poor, who may not be in a position to take advantage of any economic opportunities that arise from the interventions under Pillars 1 and 2. They will therefore require deliberate redistribution programmes under safety nets. Pillar 3 on improving the quality of life of the most vulnerable outlines various strategies aimed at meeting the needs of the vulnerable people at the same time assisting the transient poor to be self-supporting after the programme. 10 Chapter 3 - Structural Adjustment and Poverty Malawi has implemented a series of structural adjustment programmes (SAPs) to address structural weaknesses and adjust the economy to attain 'sustainable growth and poverty reduction. The major areas of focus of the SAPs included the liberalisation of the agricultural sector, parastatal sector reform, privatisation, trade liberalisation, financial sector reform, exchange rate liberalisation, interest rate liberalisation; and the rationalisation of the Budget. Nonetheless, the adjustment programmes have had limited impact on economic growth and poverty reduction. This chapter presents an overview of the structural adjustment policies and their impact on economic growth and poverty reduction, and finally outlines the rationale for the new approach to Poverty Reduction Strategies. 3.1 Overview of Structural Adjustment Policies Between 1981 and 1994, Malawi implemented several structural adjustment programmes supported by the Intemational Monetary Fund (IMF) and the World Bank (WB). From 1995 to date, Malawi has implemented three Fiscal Restructuring and Deregulation Programmes (FRDP), another form of SAP supported by the World Bank. Malawi has also been through a series of Enhanced Structural Adjustment Facilities (ESAF) supported by the International Monetary Fund (IMF). In parallel to the introduction of the PRSP approach intemationally, the IMF has adopted Poverty Reduction and Growth Facilities (PRGF) as its main instrument in Malawi. Given that Malawi is an agro-based economy, many of the reforms were focussed on the agricultural sector. The first key reform was price decontrol, which was aimed at allowing market forces to drive resource allocation in production. Secondly, market liberalisation was intended to foster competition and ensure that smallholder farmers get good input and producer prices. In particular, the repeal of the Special Crops Act in 1995 lifted restrictions on smallholder production of burley tobacco and allowed smallholder farmers to generate more income. In the financial sector, the Reserve Bank of Malawi (RBM) and Banking Acts were reviewed in 1998/99 to allow, among other things, easy entry of new banking institutions into the financial sector and to give the Reserve Bank greater indeperidence in the formulation of monetary policy. The revision of the Acts also strengthened the RBM's powers to supervise the banking industry. The liberalisation of the financial sector also meant that monetary policy had to shift from direct to indirect instruments of monetary policy. The liberalisation of interest rates began in 1987 when lending rates were freed. Deposit interest rates were deregulated in 1988 together with the abolition of preferential interest rates to the agricultural sector. By May 1990, all interest rates became fully liberalised. Another notable policy reform undertaken was the liberalisation of the exchange rate system in order to promote the country's competitiveness in intemational trade. The Kwacha's flotation in February 1994 was meant to enhance flexibility in achieving this goal. During the same adjustment process, Govermment also undertook the privatisation of public enterprises through the enactment of the Privatisation Act passed in 1995. This was aimed at improving efficiency, fostering competition and establishing a wider base of share ownership. Although privatisation has in general been characterised as a success, a number of social and redistributive issues, such as employment and popular ownership, remain unresolved. Major industry and trade reforms were implemented in 1988 through the Industrial and Trade Policy Adjustment Programme. The programme eliminated quantitative restrictions and rationalised trade taxes. Malawi's tariff bands were reduced to four. The foreign exchange market was also liberalised to ensure efficiency in foreign exchange allocation. Locally produced goods were exempted from surtax in 1992 as a way of offering protection to local producers. The rationalisation of trade taxes ensured that only import duties were used as instruments of protection, while domestic taxes emphasised taxing consumption rather than production. To promote Public Sector Management the Government also undertook civil service reform. The Civil Service Reform programme included a census of civil servants and the retrenchment of 20,000 temporary employees. In addition, strategic and functional reviews of Ministries formed the basis for rationalisation of Government through contracting out certain functions and removal of operational overlaps. Govemment also adopted the Medium Term Expenditure Framework (MTEF) in 1997 to improve the allocation and quality of public expenditure in view of the great need for an efficient public service and the very limited financial resources available. Specifically, efforts were made to strengthen expenditure prioritisation and to increase allocation to priority sectors such as education and health. As noted these reforms were supported by the Fiscal Restructuring and Deregulation Programme, which also sought to reduce domestic financing of deficits and retiring of domestic debt. Government has also initiated several measures to improve financial management and accountability. Significant progress has been made in the design of a computerised Integrated Financial Management Information System (IFMIS) with a view to strengthening the monitoring of expenditure, and creating an integrated fiscal reporting system linking the Treasury with the Reserve Bank of Malawi and line ministries to ensure timely reconciliation of accounts. 3.2 Effects of Structural Adjustment on Poverty The impact of the wide ranging policy reforms implemented during the adjustment period has been mixed and mostly unsatisfactory insofar as poverty reduction is concemed. Although there have been periods of macroeconomic stability, sustainable growth has proved elusive. The instability has to a large extent arisen from extemal shocks, inconsistent implementation of reforms, fiscal policy slippages and the narrow base of production capacity. The inability to sustain high rates of growth over a long period has undermined any poverty reducing impact of growth. Furthermore, macroeconomic instability has aggravated the poverty situation. 12 3.3 Economic Performance during Adjustment From independence through to 1979, the Malawi economy registered impressive growth. Real output growth, mainly spurred by the agricultural sector, averaged 6.7 percent during this period. However, the benefits of this growth were poorly distributed, as growth was narrowly based on estate agriculture. Starting from 1979, Malawi suffered from a series of exogenous shocks, including high import costs due to oil price shocks, disruptions in trade routes, the influx of refugees from Mozambique and droughts that disrupted the pattem of growth. In addition, policy weaknesses and slippages exacerbated the effect of these extemal shocks. As a result of these intemal and external factors, real GDP growth fluctuated between 1979 and 1987, recovering to a high of 6.8 percent in 1984 following droughts in previous years. The agricultural sector continued to be the main source of growth and domestic saving. Following another round of SAPs, Malawi started to experience relatively buoyant economic growth between 1988 and 1991. Real GDP growth rose from 3.3 percent in 1988 to 7.8 percent in 1991. However, the gains arising from this growth were short-lived as growth fluctuated through the 1990s, largely as a result of external shocks such as droughts and the reduction of donor financial support between ]992 and 1994. For example, the economy recorded growth rates of -7.9 percent in 1992 and -11.6 percent in 1994, before recovering with a growth rate of 14.5 percent in 1996. Growth has averaged 2.6 percent between 1997 and 2000 and stands at 1.8 percent in 2001. This poor economic growth performance implies that the majority of the population experienced no change in their economic status. The situation was more serious among the poor whose household consumption even in times of relative growth has stagnated. Thus economic performance during the adjustment period from 1981 to date had minimal impact on poverty reduction. 3.3.1 Inflation and Money Supply Between 1980 and 1990, the inflation rate, as indicated by the Consumer Price Index (CPI), remained stable averaging 16.6 percent During the period of 1990-2000, the annual inflation rate fluctuated. As figure 3.1 below indicates, inflation moved from 11.9 percent in 1990, to 34.7 percent in 1994, and 83.4 percent in 1995, mainly due to fiscal slippages and external shocks. Prudent fiscal policies introduced in 1995 reduced inflation to 37.6 percent in 1996 and to 9.2 percent in 1997. The depreciation of the Kwacha in August 1998 led to cost-push inflationary pressure3' resulting in annual inflation rates of 29.8 percent and 44.7 percent in 1998 and 1999, respectively. In recent years inflation averaged 30 percent. 3 Cost push inflation results from a sudden shock to certain prices, which then has further effects on other prices (including wages). In this case the shock was caused by a depreciation of the Kwacha that increased the price of imports, such as fuel. 13 Figure 3.1: Trends in Money Supply (M2) and Inflation 1990-2000 90 (M2) 70 60 7 < '- nSouc:GvrmnofMai (vaious yer)EooicRpr 240- 30 _ 20 1S90 1991 1992 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1998 1999 2000 Source: Govemment of Malawi (various years): Econonnic Report As Figure 3.1 above demonstrates, inflation in Malawi has been caused by high money supply (largely as a result of excessive Government borrowing) and the cost-push effects arising from movements in the nominal exchange rate. Inflation is a regressive and arbitrary tax, which places a heavy burden on the poor who have no other means of countering the associated adverse effects such as interest bearing accounts. In particular, high inflation is damaging to disposable incomes as it erodes purchasing power. There is a correlation between movements in money supply and in inflation. Usually, increases in the growth of money have been followed by increases in the rate of inflation. The main source of increases in money supply is Government borrowing, from financial and non- financial institutions to finance its operations. It therefore follows that reducing the fiscal deficit will be followed by deceleration in the growth of money, and hence low inflation. Table 3.1: Basic Macroeconomic Indicators 6 miless oth7"W W§ 93 Y6 8 1J= 1!_L_ __ GDP growth rate -10.2 9.6 8.2 4.9 2.0 4 0 1.7 Average Annual Inflation 34 7 83.1 37.7 9.1 29.8 44.8 29.6 Fiscal deficit/GDP inc. grants 15.0 5.7 4.4 5.2 3.4 5.6 5.7 - Fiscal Year Domestic Saving/GDP -3.0 -3.0 3.0 0.9 6.0 3.1 3.1 Investment/GDP 29.1 17.0 11.6 12.2 13.3 14.8 15.9 Current Account Deficit/GDP -13.4 -1.7 -7.7 -10.5 -2.5 -8.3 -4.9 inc. grants Exchange rate (MK:IUSD, 8.7 15.3 15.3 16.4 31.1 44.1 59.5 average) External debts/GDP 150.6 139.1 88.6 90.8 142.7 144.0 150.3 Source Govemment of Malawi (various years): Economic Report 14 3.3.2 Nominal Exchange Rate During the period of reforms, the exchange rate between the Malawi Kwacha and the United States Dollar moved from MK1.05 to the dollar in 1982 to MK4.4 in 1993. As shown in Table 3.1, the Kwacha exchange rate moved further from MK 8.7 in 1994 to MK59.5 in 2000. By February 2001 the United States Dollar traded at MK80.5 although later in that year, the Kwacha appreciated to MK61.3 to IUS$. 3.3.3 Interest Rates High fiscal deficits as shown in Table 3.1 above have during the Structural Adjustment period necessitated excessive Government borrowing, which in turn has led to high interest rates. Interest rates (lending) moved from 17 percent in 1980 to 29.5 percent in 1993. The rate moved further from 31.0 percent in 1994 to 52 percent in 2001. This has led to the crowding out of the private sector. High interest rates act as disincentive to investment as they increase the cost of borrowing and hence retard economic growth. High interest rates have worsened poverty as the poor fail to raise credit resources to maximise agricultural production and other income generating activities. 3.4 Effects of Agricultural Reform The initial impact of the reforms implemented in the agricultural sector led to a substantial increase in the production of tobacco as well as private sector participation in marketing of agricultural produce. The liberalisation of burley tobacco production alone generated around US$185 million of revenues for the rural sector32, which stimulated the growth of trading, transport and other income. However, over time, these benefits have been offset by input prices increasing faster than producer prices. The lifting of price controls and elimination of fertiliser subsidies have contributed to increased input costs. Again, during years of bumper crops, farmers have lost out because producer prices have often collapsed without any remedial Government interventions. The failure to foster competition in both the input and output markets in response to the liberalisation compromised the sector's ability to consolidate and sustain the benefits accruing to the poor. 3.5 Fiscal Policy and Expenditure Allocations Apart from the poor fiscal and tax policies relating to the size of deficit, the allocation of resources through the budget plays a major role in poverty reduction. As indicated in Table 3.2 below, Government has allocated the largest share of the total budget to Social and Community Services from the mid- 1990s, with Education receiving the highest share within this category. However, despite this positive trend towards increased allocations to priority poverty reducing areas, Table 3.2 also demonstrates that this prioritisation has not been adequate. In particular, General Administration continues to account for a large share of the Budget (averaging around 30 percent over the period). The significant variations in the percentage shares from year to year can partly be explained by changes in the levels and recording of donor funding. 32 World Bank (2000) 15 Table 3.2: Functional Analysis of Total Government Expenditures: Estimates 1995/96- 199912000(Percent) General Administration 21.8 37.0 35.1 22.9 30.7 Genera] Public Services 15.6 29.3 27.5 16.9 24.3 Defence 3.2 4.0 3.5 2.5 28 Public Order and Safety 3.1 3.8 4.1 3.5 37 Social and Community 40.6 24.3 38.9 40.5 41.7 Services Education 17.4 11.] 17.5 14.9 15.6 Health 11.I 6.0 9.6 12 2 11.6 Social Security 7.6 4.9 6.7 5.4 7.2 Economic Services 15.6 9.3 9.5 20.0 20.2 Agriculture 9.2 6.2 4 4.7 12.4 11.0 Unallocable 22.0 29.4 16.5 16.6 7.4 Total 100.0 100.0 100.0 100.0 100.0 Source: Government of Malawi (various years): Economic Reports Although allocations to priority areas, such as social services, have increased, the quality of expenditure has not fully reached the beneficiaries. As the 2000 Public Expenditure Review (PER) clearly demonstrates, resources within the priority sectors of education, health and agriculture have not been used efficiently and effectively. In particular: 1. Education: the share of the Recurrent Budget for primary education has risen from 50 percent in 1993/94 to around 60 percent in 1999/00, with the poorest sections of the population benefiting from an increasing share of primary education expenditures. However, expenditures per pupil are 8 times higher in secondary education than in primary education, and 202 times higher in tertiary education. 2. . Health: only 18 percent of the Health Budget is spent on primary health services, which most directly benefit the poor, with tertiary health services receiving the highest share of the budget. 3. Agriculture: the highest share of the agriculture budget is spent on administration, with Headquarters receiving a significant proportion of this, partly because all donor funds are channelled through Headquarters and because of the centralised structure of the Ministry. Expenditures on agricultural research and extension as a percentage of GDP have fallen, with extension spending declining from 0.6 percent in 1995/96 to 0.3 percent in 2000/01. Thus, the detailed analysis in the PER highlights the fact that although Government has reallocated funds to those Ministries that have direct impact on poverty reduction, these funds were not always directed within the Ministries to those particular sub-sectors and activities that directly benefit the poor. This would explain why the overall reallocations in expenditures have had a limited impact on poverty reduction in the 1990s. 3.6 New Approach to Poverty Reduction As noted in the preceding section, the various structural reform programs did not translate into poverty reduction. To address this situation the Poverty Alleviation Program (PAP) was instituted in 1994 as the main strategy for addressing poverty in Malawi. The PAP emphasised the need to raise national productivity through sustainable broad-based economic growth and socio-cultural development. Some of the notable projects under the PAP included: Free 16 Primary Education, Malawi Social Action Fund (MASAF) funded Community Projects, European Union (EU) Micro-Projects and the Bakili Muluzi Health Initiative. However, the main constraint of the PAP was the absence of a well-articulated action plan to ensure a holistic approach during implementation. In addition, the PAP Policy Framework was silent in terms of setting poverty targets that needed to be achieved either in the medium or long-term. The result was the existence of disjointed initiatives, which lacked proper co- ordination. It is against this background that Malawian stakeholders, including Government, have recognised the need to do a balancing act between measures to promote medium and long-term growth and policies to reduce the short to medium term plight of the majority of the population. It has also been noted that for poverty reduction to be achieved, pro-poor economic growth must be stimulated whilst investing in social sector development and ensuring that Government intervenes to help those who cannot benefit from growth. The strategy must also address a number of cross-cutting issues, such as the HIV/AIDS epidemic, gender equality, the sustainable use of natural resources, and the creation of a science and technology culture. 17 I8 C'hantpr 4 - The Malawi Pnv erty RdAitrfion Strate t.. aa.. I a - .4. V- - A it - , - . it'.7 " WAt. 5 tO, &A ASL The MPRS has been designed in the light of the severe poverty situation and the lessons learnt from past experience. It is the result of extensive consultations as described in Annex 1. In the past, Malawi has failed to --iv s'an1 and: e t g w In +1 1970s, te was sustainable growth, but this was centred in the'estate and large-scale sectors and did not benefit the poor. in tne 1980s, SAPs succeeded in achieving relative economic stability, but thls was not-translated into economic growth, in part due to a lack of national ownership and poverty focus. In the 1990s, there were periods of equitable growth driven by the smallholder agricultural sector, but this growth was not sustained as a result of external shocks and policy reversals. As a result, as Chapter 2 demonstrates, income poverty has remained high, and distribution remains highlv unequal. 1III IlSlulIWaIi -AkjJ1ILdIL.A IVIILO LU a OL1aQLy VI jLU-.pUUI *IVWUI. 1IIID ID lIUWU1 UlU4L IIVU VOb and benefits the poor, and requires maximum participation of women and men in all sectors. This will be complemented by some deliberate transfers to the ultra-poor who are not able to lift themselves out of poverty. The concentration of poverty in rural areas requires proportional concentration of poverty reduction efforts and activities in rural areas. The poor social indicators described in Chapter 2 will be addressed through human capital development interventions, which are a precondition for improved quality of life in the medium term, and for sustainable long term income poverty reduction. T ne medium-i goal of tuhe MPRS is tuat by mid-2005 ine incidence of poverty in Malawi snould be reduced by 6 percentage points, from 65.3 percent of the population to 59.3 percent. The medium term poverty reduction goal will be met through a number of poverty reduction targets. The targets are summarized in Table 4.1 below. Table 4.1: Selected Maior Impact Taraets for the MPRS 2002-2005 Poverty headcount measured by consumption based u 65.3% T 59.3% 1poverty line. Extreme poverty headcount, measured by consumption 28.8% 20% I Dased ultra-poverty iine Life expectancy 39 years 43 years GIDP per ap-ita (crnst-nt 2001 prices) IIO,Y in0 MK0A I I Ann [ Literacy rate (female) 58% (44%) 70% (60%) Infant mortality rate (per 1000 children) 1041 90 Maternal mortality rate (per O00,000 live births) 1,120 1 8001 The MPRS is built around four strategic pillars. These pillars are the main strategic cOmponents grouping the vanrious aGtivities and nolinieq intn n cnherent framnework for povertvy reduction. The first pillar contains s.trategies that will enhance rapid sustainable pro-poor ecUUViiuici rIUWUI anlU bUULtrLU4I 1.ansUMiMLIVII. III Lite secUnUu pillia, sti a'eg1bi fusus on iuillian capital development. The third pillar captures strategies on improving the quality of life of the most vulnerable. The fourth pillar covers issues of good governance. The MPRS will also ensure that cross cutting issues including HIV/AIDS, Gender, Environment and Science and Technology, are mainstreamed in all four pillars of the MPRS. 19 This Chapter and the Action Plan matrix on which it is based define activities grouped into various levels of category, as shown in Figure 4.1 below. Each Pillar (including Cross-Cutting Issues) has a number of Goals, shown in the text as headings numbered 4.x.x. For example, Pillar 1 has two Goals: Sources of Pro-Poor Growth and Creating an Enabling Environment for Pro-Poor Growth. Many Goals are then broken down into Sub-Goals, shown in the text as headings numbered 4.x.x.x. For example, Sources of Pro-Poor Growth is broken down into 6 Sub-Goals: Increasing Agricultural Incomes, Sustainable Utilisation of Natural Resources, Develop MSMEs, Boost Manufacturing and Agro-Processing, Develop Tourism, and Small- Scale Mining. Each Sub-Goal is associated with a number of Objectives, shown in the text as underlined and numbered headings. For example, the Natural Resources Sub-Goal contains three Objectives dealing with fishery, forestry and wildlife resources. The strategies necessary to achieve each objective are described under each Objective heading. These strategies are further broken down into the specific activities necessary in the action plan. Figure 4.1: Logical Flow of MPRS - ~~~~~~~~~~4 lin rI o the Pillar b goal oeives sa ies a a are generally described* in prort order as relce in the Action Plan i nne 1. Thi descritioni t;; gint Ilendda a narrative summary of the Ato Plan Th descnptince s shouldm be readeinthe r LU context of the costing and prioritisation framework described in Chapter 5, and the detailed 20 action plan matrix, which link the Pillars, Goals, Sub-Goals, Objectives, Strategies and Activities to cost implications and monitoring information. 4.1 Sustainable Pro-Poor Growth Economic growth is a precondition for sustainable poverty reduction. Without any general increase in incomes, any redistributive measures will not be sustainable. However, economic growth in itself is not sufficient for sustainable poverty reduction - the growth must be pro- poor. Pro-poor growth is growth that involves and benefits the poor. It is a prerequisite for broadening income distribution and generation of employment. The consultations country- wide revealed a number of short-comings in the previous approaches to stimulating growth and reducing poverty. Major inadequacies were identified in agricultural production, micro- enterprises and micro-finance, rural infrastructure and macroeconomic stability. Pillar 1 is divided into two main elements: the promotion of specific sectoral sources of pro- poor growth, and the creation of an enabling environment for pro-poor growth. It is recognised throughout the Pillar that the driving force for growth will be the private sector33. The role of Government, NGOs and donors is merely to facilitate this growth, by creating an enabling environment and providing specific support for the identified specific sectoral sources of pro- poor growth. This support is generally focussed on economically empowering the poor and supporting Micro, Small and Medium enterprises and sectors in which the poor are active. However, such support is unlikely to be sufficient in generating the level of economic activity necessary for sustainable poverty reduction and lessening dependence on donor financing. Thus, the MPRS does not neglect the crucial role of the large scale private sector in generating investment, employment, tax revenue and foreign exchange. The consultation process clarified that the priority for this large scale private sector is the creation and maintenance of an enabling environment, with particular focus on macroeconomic stability, taxation and trade. Further, the large-scale private sector, as a development partner, itself has a crucial role to play in ensuring that its actions are pro-poor. Growth prospects also depend on developments in the other Pillars. For example, issues of education and health contained in Pillar 2 are critical for medium to long term growth prospects through improvements in human capital and productivity. Improving on issues of corruption, governance, parastatal reform, security and the rule of law (especially property rights), all covered in Pillar 4, are similarly crucial for the investment climate. Sustainable pro-poor growth also requires the mainstreaming of cross-cutting issues in all interventions. Government, development partners and the private sector must take measures to address the HIV/AIDS pandemic if productivity, savings rates and human capital are not to decline. Appropriate science and technology must be harnessed to increase productivity. Efforts must be taken to ensure that all gender groups are fully involved in economic activities. Finally, to be sustainable, economic activities must ensure that the stock of natural resources is not depleted further. 33 Throughout this document, the term "private sector" is used to describe all types of private business activity, from smallholder commercial farmers and small-scale vendors, to large-scale national and international enterprises 21 4.1.1 Sources of Pro-Poor Growth The key specific sectoral source of pro-poor growth in the medium term is agriculture. Efforts will also be made to diversify into sectors with greater value-addition, especially through Micro, Small and Medium Scale Enterprises (MSMEs). The key sectors identified for diversification are natural resources, manufacturing, tourism and small-scale mining. 4.1.1.1 Increasing Agricultural Incomes As Chapter 2 clearly shows, agriculture remains the most important source of income accounting for 63.7 percent of total income of the rural poor. Thus, increasing agricultural incomes will be a key source of poverty reduction, at least in the medium-term. The agricultural sector will also remain the key source of growth and employment in the medium term, as it accounts for about 36 percent of GDP, 87 percent of total employment and supplies more than 65 percent of the manufacturing sector's raw material requirements. However, poverty reduction and growth through the agricultural sector has been constrained by a number of factors identified during the MPRS preparation process. Many of the key barriers to poverty reduction through agriculture lie outside the remit of the Ministry of Agriculture and Irrigation, such as physical access to markets (rural feeder roads), access to credit and rural insecurity. In addition, the Ministry has not been focussed on its role as a service provider to farmers. Government and its partners will therefore promote poverty reduction through agriculture by providing farmers34 with the necessary services and conditions for them to increase their incomes. This will involve expanding and strengthening access to agricultural inputs; improving research and extension services, introducing smallholder friendly technologies, improving access to local and intemational markets; reducing land shortage and degradation; increasing investment in irrigation; and developing farmer co-operatives and associations. Further, issues of rural infrastructure and security, which are crucial to poverty reduction through agriculture, are covered under the sections on rural infrastructure in Pillar 1, and -on security and justice under Pillar 4. 1. Expand and Strengthen Access to Agricultural Inputs Low agricultural productivity is mainly due to unavailability or lack of access to essential inputs such as fertilizers, manure and quality seeds. Use of fertilizer and improved hybrid seed by the majority of farmers, especially smallholders, has been extremely low. Given cash flow problems associated with agriculture, even productive farmers require credit to purchase inputs. Poorer farmers are generally unable to repay loans and therefore require safety nets interventions. However, financial institutions are reluctant to lend to the agriculture sector due to inherent risks of farming, lack of collateral and high default rates. Increases in input supply through safety nets to the rural poor have resulted in increased production in the past. For instance, in 1998/99 and 1999/2000, Malawi experienced bumper harvests, among other things, owing to the implementation of free seed and fertiliser distribution under the Starter Pack Programme (SPP). 34 The term "farmers" throughout this document refers to both female and male farmers. 22 The solution to these problems is threefold. Firstly, efforts will be made to increase farmers' access to credit with more emphasis on, reaching the productive poor, who have in the past been non-creditworthy. The detailed strategies on credit are elaborated in section 4.1.2.2. However, in order to facilitate access to credit, the farmer groups and associations that will be formed throughout the country will be organised into Savings anid Credit Co-operative Organisations (SACCOs) or village banks for the purposes of mobilising savings and providing credit to members. In addition the SACCOs and village banks will be used as collateral for accessing credit from commercial banks and other financial lending institutions. Government will provide limited financial support for the capitalisation of these village-based credit schemes. Secondly, Government and its partners will encourage the production and use of compost and other sources of manure, and will link farmers to markets that demand organically produced agricultural crops. Thirdly, access to inputs for the most vulnerable will be increased through the Targeted Input Programme (TIP) and Public Works Programme (PWP) as elaborated in Pillar 3. 2. Improve Agricultural Production Through Improved Research and Extension Services. Agricultural research institutions have developed technologies that have not been fully adopted by smallholders because of high costs of technology and inadequate linkages between research and extension. Some of the technologies (such as motorised irrigation) developed are inappropriate for use by the low capital and small land holding farming communities in Malawi. The agricultural extension system has in recent years come under pressure from resource constraints, both financial and human. The supply-driven system of training individual farmers has been undermined by a growing farming population, deaths and retirement of extension workers (resulting in an attrition rate of 9 percent), inadequate training of new workers and retraining of existing workers, the specialisation required for certain issues and a lack of resources for inputs such as fuel. As a result, Government and its partners in the agricultural sector have formulated a new extension policy to make extension delivery more effective and responsive to farmers' needs. The policy emphasises demand driven pluralistic extension services, allowing farmers to determine the information required, and involving NGOs (including private institutions) in the delivery of extension services. While the government will still remain the main provider of free extension services especially to smallholder farmers, some progressive and fully commercialised estate farmers will have to pay for extension services which will be provided by some private institutions such as NGOs, ARET and NASFAM. Further, existing and new NGOs will be encouraged to provide extension services to smallholder farmers. The resulting strategies involve, firstly, strengthening extension delivery services, including the implementation of the new extension policy. Efforts will be made to reverse increases in the farmer to extension worker ratio in order to increase' farmer access to extension services. This requires training and employing more extension workers to fill the gap created by the high attrition rate. In addition, existing extension workers will be retrained to enhance their knowledge and reorient them to the new extension policy. The training will involve modules 23 on HIV/AIDS, gender, soil fertility and conservation, business management and marketing, and the formation of associations and groups. Secondly, Government and its partners will facilitate the formation and development of product specific farmer co-operatives and associations. These groups, cooperatives and associations will be the focus of future Government interventions in the agricultural sector. For example, extension services will be targeted at groups rather than individuals; groups will be expected to provide training-within and between their own members. The groups will also be the basis for the commercialisation of smallholder agriculture and will facilitate savings schemes and access to credit. In order to facilitate their formation, Government and its partners will train extension workers in group formation and management and will provide training for groups in management and marketing. Thirdly, Government will enhance and perfect production and dissemination of appropriate agricultural statistics including weather, crop production estimates, and price and market information, which will enable effective planning for production and marketing of agricultural products. Finally, research efforts in crops and animal production technologies will be strengthened. In particular, research will be made more responsive to the needs of farmers and easily adopted whilst being cost effective. To this end research and extension linkages will be strengthened by holding joint research extension strategic planning fora involving crops and animal specialists and farmers' representatives will be conducted biannually to identify farmer's technology requirements in order to come up with appropriate technologies to be transferred to farmers. A systemic approach to technology development, problem identification, and promotion and utilisation of appropriate technology will be advocated. On-farm impact assessment surveys will be carried out every year to determine usefulness and adoption rates of the technologies imparted. Table 4.1.1: Extension Ta ts Maize yield (kg/la) 1137 2000 Cassava yield (kg/ha) 16618 18000 Cotton yield (kg/ha) 776 1500 Groundnuts (kglha) 820 1000 Soya Beans (kg/ha) 685 1000 Cumulative intake of extension 100 900 trainees Farmers' groups and co- 3000 operatives formed 3. Improve Access to Domestic. Regional and International Markets There has been a general lack of understanding of domestic, regional, and international markets among Malawian farmers and small agro-enterprises such that they have not taken advantage of the market opportunities created by bilateral and multilateral trade agreements. Most stakeholders have very limited access to infornation on local and international markets especially smallholders and small scale traders, leading to lack of knowledge of the quality, 24 quantity and type of products to be produced and targeted to specific markets. The competitive position of agricultural products in Malawi is relatively weak due to high transport costs and low on-farm and agro-industrial productivity. Extension agents focus on production rather than marketing information and do not provide marketing support to farmers. The strategic actions towards addressing these problems will include developing an efficient and effective Market Information System (MIS). This will be achieved through creating a better marketing network, which will link farmers to markets. Extension workers will be oriented towards imparting marketing knowledge such as grading,. good storage and gross margin analysis. Dissemination centres will be created in all district assemblies and other conveniently accessed areas (schools, health centres, and agricultural offices). Market Information Systems in existing institutions for both inputs and outputs will be strengthened, demand driven and based on partnership between Government and the private sector. Farmers will be trained in how they can access markets (for example, by being informed by extension workers, through market research by farmer association representatives, and traders) and how to take advantage of specialised market opportunities. Intemational linkages will be strengthened, for example, through trade fairs and other buyer/seller meetings, internet access, marketing bulletins and membership of local and intemational commodity trade associations Rural farmers are not effectively involved in the marketing of their produce due to inadequate producer organisations, lack of cottage industries, lack of remunerative prices and weak rural infrastructure. In order to eliminate these problems, Government will facilitate the development of co-operatives to improve supply development. Export villages35 will be established for selected clusters of crops to improve their marketability. Government will also initiate market development programmes to capture both domestic and export markets. Specific actions will involve creating and enhancing farmers markets, promoting buyer-seller contacts, designing and producing promotional literature and collecting and disseminating market information. Further, Government will protect rural farmers from sub-standard imported agricultural products. 4. Promote Small-Scale Irrigation Schemes and Drainage The current irrigation system has failed to maximise its production potential and impact on poverty for two main reasons. Firstly, smallholder farmers have in the past been provided with motorised equipment whose utilisation was not economically viable, particularly due to high maintenance costs. Secondly, there have been inadequate trained personnel and training programmes for farmers in irrigation issues, leading to low adoption of irrigation technologies. As a result, total irrigable land (potential land for irrigation) is 200,000 hectares while only 57,000 hectares36 is currently under irrigation, of which only 8,000 hectares is by small-holder farmers. By promoting small-scale irrigation and drainage, greater efficiency will be achieved in the use of water, hence increasing productivity and raising crop yields. Farmer associations and cooperatives will be encouraged to develop and maintain irrigation schemes in order to 35 An export village is a grouping of entrepreneurs producing a particular product for export depending on the resource base of the local community. 36 Govemment of Malawi (2000) Irrigation Department Annual Workplan 2000/2001, Ministry of Agriculture and Irrigation 25 increase production of specific commodities. This will include training, technical advice and linkages to credit institutions (through training and establishing contacts). To this extent, the MPRS will facilitate the development of these small-scale irrigation schemes and undertake the drainage of marshland where necessary. Strategies will include: supporting the construction of small scale irrigation infrastructure; promoting irrigation schemes based on manual lifting devices, sprinklers and motorised pumps; rehabilitation and construction of community small earth dams, introducing training programs to build capacity in management; and draining and reclaiming wetlands for agricultural use where environmentally sustainable. Table 4.1.2: Irrigation Targets Treadle pumps supplied on loan 60,000 to farmers (cumulative) Area under motorised pump 1,300 3,700 irrigation (hectares Community dams rehabilitated 90 Area under irrigation per ADD 2,000 (hectares) 5. Encourage Production Specific Crops The Malawi economy has largely relied on tobacco for income and employment. Since the repeal of the Special Crops Act,37 there has been a tremendous increase in the production of burley tobacco as indicated in Table 4.1.3. However, with the increasing international antismoking lobby, the future of tobacco as the main foreign exchange earner is not certain. As a result, Government has pursued a policy of encouraging diversification of crop production away from tobacco to non-traditional crops. However, these efforts have not been properly effective, particularly as a result of the reliable market for tobacco compared to other crops. As a result, tobacco remains the main cash crop for most Malawian farmers, despite falling prices. To address the problems of declining prices of tobacco on the auction floors, Government has introduced a number of market arrangement schemes such as the Intermediate Tobacco Buying Scheme (IBS). The IBS has been reorganised into a new scheme called the Designated Tobacco Buying Scheme (DTBS) which has some control measures on problems experienced on the previous scheme, the IBS. Other traditional export crops, such as tea, coffee and sugar, which are produced largely on estates, will continue to be major foreign exchange eamers and employment generators for the foreseeable future. As such, Government and the estate sector will continue to work together to ensure the competitiveness of Malawian produce and to maximise the impact on poverty reduction. For example, Government will encourage the estate sector to establish more smallholder out-grower schemes. 37 The Special Crops Act prohibited smallholder farmers from growing high value cash crops such as tobacco, 26 Table 4.1.3: Final Smallholder Cro Estimates for M or Cro £ etric Tonnes) Maize 1,327,865 1,793,463 1,226,476 1,534,326 2,245,824 2,211,859 1,899,185 Paddy Rice 39,073 72,629 65,690 68,802 92,859 67,084 89,120 Groumdnuts 30,664 40,327 68,718 97,228 124,604 116,363 147,624 Tobacco 35,438 68,978 83,567 94,063 84,555 98,614 85,715 Cotton 25,207 82,591 45,122 36,336 50,589 34,907 39,584 Sorghum 20,090 54,710 39,514 41,401 41,401 36,799 37,278 Millet 13,259 20,262 16,424 19,638 20,224 19,508 19,926 Pulses 99,772 183,093 179,226 208,859 233,811 248,243 306,560 Cassava 328,424 534,549 713,566 829,821 895,420 2,757,186 3,153,988 Sweet 317,705 569,469 858,129 1,432,383 1,680,313 1,634,268 2,478,355 Potatoes __ Source: GovernmentofMalawi (2001): Agricultural StaAstical Bulletin 2001, Ministy ofAgriculture and Irrigation Government, in collaboration with the private sector, will take action to diversify and encourage the establishment of viable pToduction units of selected key export crops which will have a direct market link with industry to facilitate agro-processing for more value adding. Key crops, apart from tobacco, such as cotton, cassava and soya beans have been selected on the basis of their high productivity by smallholder farmers and that the crops could easily be processed into a number of products. These crops also have high export marketing prospects. It is envisaged that crop specific associations of these crops will be formed in areas with high comparative production advantage. Government will then provide start-up material (such as seeds) to these groups. 6. Encourage Production of Livestock Past government efforts have had minimal impact in increasing production of livestock because emphasis was placed on disease prevention services with less emphasis on production-oriented programmes. In addition, the private sector was not encouraged to produce livestock. Further, insecurity in rural areas has provided a major disincentive to the keeping of livestock. As a result, there has been very little increase, and in some cases decline, in livestock population, as shown in Table 4.1.4 below. Table 4.1.4: Trends in Livestock Population 1994-2000 Cattle 748,89 1 748,830 780,069 589,175 6131,040 750,000 775,33 3 Pigs 252,112 340,129 312,925 420,772 42S,000 451,051 Sheep 9 1,9 15 86,827 93,0 18 97,9 16 11 7,000 11 9,466 Goats 1 850,313 843,362 1 947,028 I 1,566,51 4 _1 ,460,500 1 ,620,103 Poultry - - 12,807,000 10,005,000 10,366,000 [ 12,000,000 10,000,000 Source: Govemment of Malawi (2000): Department of Animal Health and Industry (DAHI) 2000101 Work Plan, Ministry of Agriculture and lnrigation In order to address these problems, efforts will be made to improve security in rural areas, including the establishment of anti-cattle theft units as described in Pillar 4. Government in conjunction with NGOs will strengthen its advisory services in production and marketing of livestock and its products, including training on feed formulation. To this end, the formation of livestock producing farmers' groups will be facilitated through training in group formation and management, and these groups will be encouraged to obtain credit and operate revolving funds. 27 Basic animal health services such as dipping tanks will be expanded, upgraded and supported. . Surveillance and control of animal diseases will be revamped and strengthened. These will partly be sustained by cost sharing. Table 4.1.5: Livestock Tarts _N - -omm, I- -e - Number of farmers reached by 1,120,000 animal husbandry extension Production of cattle 775,333 868,373 Production of pigs 451,051 676,577 Production of Sheep 119,466 155,306 Production of goats 1,620,103 2,106,134 7. Reduce Land Shortage and Degradation. Land constraints in Malawi arise mainly from low productivity of fragmented pieces of smallholder land, lack of security of tenure, high population density and an unorganised land market system. High population densities and lack of off farm employment opportunities have exacerbated the land scarcity problem in most parts of the country. Current land inheritance patterns encourage fragmentation of holdings and discourage long-term investments and improvements on land. Poor implementation of land policies and enforcement of the law has led to cultivation on slopes and river-banks, resulting in deforestation and serious soil erosion. There has been weak planning and coordination among sectors dealing with land. The absence of proactive policy interventions and limited capacity for dynamic monitoring of land administration may have directly contributed to current problems of poverty, food insecurity, and perceived inequalities in access to arable land. The strategies for achieving this objective are the implementation of the Land Policy, including providing land to the landless; increasing productivity of small land holdings; promoting low cost conservation technologies, consolidating reproductive and gender issues into land management, and ensuring sustainable environmental and natural resource management. This will be achieved through redistributing 14,000 ha of land to 3,500 farmning households, guaranteeing security of customary land tenure, conducting soil conservation and fertility campaigns; and training and promoting family planning to reduce pressure on land. 8. Promote and Expand Farm Mechanisation. Agricultural mechanisation in Malawi is presently at low levels. The predominant source of power is human power and the hand hoe is the main implement. This limits the performance of critical operations like tilling, planting and weeding. Currently only about 13.5 percent of farmers in Malawi are using animal drawn implements, mostly in the central and northern regions. Motorised power is essentially limited to estate farms, which cover just 30 percent of the total cultivated land. Despite the low use of basic animal drawn implements, their demand and the demand for work oxen has been on the increase in the period from 1992 to 2000. However, it has been difficult to fully satisfy the demands because of reduced numbers of animals and increased costs of farm implements. Past government initiatives towards improving mechanisation such as the use of power tillers in the rice schemes, draught animal power utilisation, motorised maize shelling, and aerial spraying of cotton failed. The reasons 28 for the failure ranged from lack of spare parts, high cost, poor consultations with farmers, poor hiring arrangements, lack of accountability of funds collected from farrners, and inadequate care for animals. These problems will be addressed by increasing access to draught animals and animal drawn implements by expanding training of work oxen and encouraging use of alternative sources of animal power such as donkeys. Further, farmers will be encouraged to use animal drawn implements through wide publicity and demonstration of the benefits of using such implements, Local artisans and suppliers will be supported and linked to industry. Efforts will also be made to increase access to tractors for hire. Existing schemes have been unsuccessful because of small and fragmented land holding size. The new approach will involve provision of tractors for hire to groups of farmers in co-operatives with land consolidated for easy operation with tractors. Table 4.1. 6: Mechanisation Targets. Number of animals trained 60,000 Number of artisans trained in 300 production of animal drawn implements Number of donkeys in use - 865 9. Reduce Weaknesses in Institutional and Policy Framework. Farners are unable to participate in the formulation of agriculture programrnes owing to a lack of co-ordination between farmers, the Ministry of Agriculture and Irrigation and other organisations in the agricultural sector. The respective roles of Government and private sector are not clearly stated or understood and in many cases lead to confusion and wastage of resources, due to the lack of a core functional analysis for the Ministry. Ineffective decision-making mechanisms have led to poor development and implementation of policies. Policies and legal frameworks in most cases exist to guide the activities of the Ministry but resources for implementation are diverted to non-core functions. In order to address these problems, the Malawi Agriculture Sector Investment Programme (MASIP), under formulation, will provide a framework for partnerships between Government, donors, Non-Governmental Organisations (NGOs), and the private sector in development of the agriculture sector. In particular, this will involve strengthening co-ordination between farmers and other institutions within the agricultural sector, redefining and restructuring the Ministry around its core functions and in response to impending decentralisation, and instituting clear arrangements for implementation of non-core functions by the private sector, NGOs and fanner associations. 10. Reduce Gender Disnarities, HIV/AIDS Infections and Effects in the Agricultural Sector. In the past, agricultural services have not been equally provided to females and males. In most cases, services such as development of technologies and dissemination favoured men, leaving women, boys and girls at a disadvantage. Conversely, technology dissemination in food and 29 nutrition was targeted at women, leaving out men. This gender imbalance has resulted in inequity in uptake of knowledge and competence necessary for understanding and benefiting from agricultural technologies between and among different gender groups of the farming community. On the other hand, HIV/AIDS has adversely affects productivity and food security for Malawian farmers and yet it has not been adequately incorporated within agricultural programmes. In order to ensure quality participation, the sector will strive to design and implement activities that will generate, disseminate, avail and promote use of appropriate technologies that impact on basic and economic needs for the various gender groups. The MPRS endeavours to achieve gender balance, prevention and mitigation of HIlV/AIDS through the following strategies. Firstly, campaigns for mainstreaming gender and HIV/AIDS will be undertaken for both communities and the work place. This will involve conducting gender and HIV/AIDS awareness meetings, which will involve participation of the local community to expose them so that they support services on gender and HIV/AIDS. Secondly, diagnostic surveys will be undertaken to bring about deeper understanding of needs, issues and links of HIV/AIDS, gender and agriculture development in selected areas (model villages and sample areas). In this regard, there will be a situation analysis at work place and community level. Thirdly, policies and programmes will be developed to support the activities of HIV/AI!DS and gender in the agriculture sector. Fourthly, technical backstopping to agriculture training institutions, comununities and workplace on gender and HIV/AIDS interventions will be provided. There will be training for skills development in dealing with HIV/AIDS impacts, prevention and reducing gender disparities in agriculture development through short courses for officers, on the job training for field staff at ADDs, RDPs, research stations and EPAs, and mobile training for community mobilisers on gender and HIV/AIDS. Finally, specific mechanisms will be put in place to mainstream gender in all the other agriculture strategies mentioned above. 4.1.1.2 Encourage Sustainable Utilisation of Natural Resources Malawi's abundant natural resources in the form of land, forestry, water and fish are currently dwindling and are rapidly being exploited unsustainably, primarily by the poor. At present, forestry and fisheries account for about 12 percent of GDP. About 21 percent of Malawi is forest reserves, national parks and wildlife reserves or conservation areas. However, the expansion of these sectors has been restricted by previous management policies, which put communities at the periphery and stressed natural resources conservation. Communities were prohibited from utilising and deriving tangible benefits from natural resources in forest and wildlife reserves. This situation resulted in conflicts between communities and Government and further violation of the laws by the communities. In addition, Government was managing. the natural resources directly. In forestry, for example, despite Government policing mechanisms, Malawi has experienced a rise in wanton cutting of trees for conversion to agricultural land, firewood and charcoal production, resulting in environrmental degradation, soil erosion and river sedimentation. Forest cover is currently 28 percent and has declined at by 19 percent over the past 25 years, a loss of 2.0 ha million. Demand for wood currently outstrips production by 33 percent. At the 30 same time, existing forestry resources that could be used sustainably as a source of rural livelihoods have not been fully nor efficiently utilised. Fish is the single most important source of protein in Malawi, contributing about 60-70 percent of national animal protein. However, due to over-exploitation, the total production has declined by 40 percent, to 4045,000 tons per year, from a peak in production in the early 1 990s. This has resulted in a concomitant reduction of 45 percent in the average per capita fish consumption rate. This decline in production is also explained by the use of primitive fishing methods, which restrict fishing to shallower areas. There is need to explore more advanced methods, especially for deep water fishing. Furthermore, the potential for fish farming (aquaculture) has not been exploited despite efforts by Government and some development partners. Natural resource management activities will therefore be focussed on three key sub-sectors of forestry, fisheries and wildlife. For each of these sub-sectors, the aim will be to promote Community Based Natural Resources Management (CBNRM). In particular, the legal and institutional framework will be strengthened so that rural communities are organised and trained to empower them to effectively participate in decentralised environmental management and to sustainably benefit from natural resources. Communities will be encouraged to sustainably manage fishery, forestry and wildlife resources based on clear mechanisms of ownership and control. Secondly, efforts will be made to promote alternative livelihood strategies, for example by encouraging natural resources-based enterprises (including value- adding activities) for generation of more income in the rural areas. Finally, mass awareness of environmental management issues will be created. For example, communities will be given civic education on the importance of sustainable utilisation and conservation of natural resources to providing habitat for wildlife, reducing soil erosion, reducing global warming, increasing soil fertility and influencing weather. These general strategies will be applied to each sub-sector as outlined below: 1. Increase Sustainable Utilisation of Fishery Resources In fisheries, the empowerment of rural communities will focus on Beach Village Committees (BVCs). The key livelihood strategies will be to promote off-shore fishery, and local fish farming. Fisheries extension services will be strengthened and focussed on the promotion of technology to increase off-shore fishery, fisheries enhancement technology and fish farming in local communities. These efforts will be particularly targeted at women. Further, efforts will be made to promote the establishment of better markets and marketing practices for fish through training in handling, processing and packaging of fish products. Traders, fishing groups and the private sector will be encouraged to invest in appropriate physical infrastructure, such as refrigeration facilities. Awareness of environmental management issues will be achieved through improving fisheries curricula at extension training colleges, and translating existing fisheries research data into user-friendly information materials. 2. Encourage Sustainable Utilisation of Forestry Resources In addition to devolution of forestry co-management to CBNRM groups, the private sector will be encouraged to add value to non-timber products and to manage plantations through 31 contracts and lease agreements. Management plans for potential plantations will be developed for use by the private sector. Forestry extension services to farmers, village committees and schools will be strengthened and a co-ordinated extension framework with other stakeholders developed. Further, mass tree planting campaigns will be conducted, focussing on the economic benefits of planting. Finally, the forestry curriculum at training colleges will be improved and existing research translated into user friendly material. 3. Encourage Sustainable Utilisation of Wildlife Resources In addition to devolution of wildlife co-management around national parks and reserves to CBNRM groups, the strategy will also involve privatisation of wildlife through encouraging game farming and ranching. Efforts will be made to minimise contact between wildlife and animals, for example through fencing park boundaries and training hunters on control of dangerous animals. Table 4.1. 7: Natural Resources Targets. Fish farmning production 500 1,000 (tonnes) BVCs trained and functional - 270 Forest under private sector 50,000 Parks under private sector 50,000 4.1.1.3 Micro, Small and Medium-Scale Enterprises (MSMEs) Apart from small-holder agricultural production and natural resource utilisation, pro-poor growth will rely on Micro, Small and Medium Scale Enterprises (MSMEs). It is these MSMEs that have the potential to allow the poor to generate their own incomes. The Gemini Baseline Survey 2000 estimates that there are about 747,363 MSMEs, of which 83 percent are located in rural areas. In terms of sectoral distribution, 75 percent of the MSMEs conduct off-farm activities including manufacturing, commerce and trade and services. The remaining MSMEs are based on crop production (22 percent), with just 3 percent on other primary activities such as livestock production, fishing, forestry and mining. About 91 percent of these firms fit into the micro category of 0-4 employees according to the national enterprise size classification. The primary production sector, especially fishing, mining crop and livestock production, tend to have more employees. About 34 percent of all the MSMEs are owned by women, a proportion that is significantly lower than the average of 60-75 percent recorded in most other African countries. Women's MSME activities are concentrated in the off-farm sector, primarily in commerce (mostly vending farm produce) and in manufacturing (mostly processing foods and brewing beer). On the other hand, married couples and multiple owners of businesses tend to be concentrated in crop production and trade. These ownership pattems, also observed in other studies, are determined not only by economic factors but also by certain social and cultural relations, including gender. The development of MSMEs has been hampered by a lack of business skills and technological expertise, lack of capital, and inadequate supportive infrastructure for efficient production and 32 marketing. The following strategies will be put in place to create an enabling environment for MSMEs development and operation, providing financial support for development of MSMEs and improving institutional coordination and support. 1. Provide Support for Development of MSMEs Support to MSMEs will be provided through a number of channels. Firstly, Govermment will develop industrial sites for MSMEs with common user facilities in conjunction with the private sector. Secondly, efforts will be made to improve marketing, supply of raw materials, technology and productivity through the introduction of special assistance programmes, such as a subcontract exchange system, training in quality improvement, research and development grants and the creation of networks for joint supply of raw materials. There will also be a focus on exporting specific products where Malawi has a comparative advantage through the establishment of export villages, the organisation of intemational fairs and the provision of information to MSMEs on export procedures. 2. Improve Institutional Coordination and Support. There are a number of activities that will be implemented under this objective. The structure and operations of MSMEs will be strengthened through the formation of gender responsive product specific associations and cooperatives. Entrepreneurship development will be included as one of the key subjects not only in training schools but also in secondary schools. This will involve preparing self-employment programmes for school leavers and linking them to support institutions; formalising the apprenticeship p;ogrammes; and linking TEVET and other business growth programmes. Finally, laws and regulations affecting the development of MSMEs will be reviewed and appropriate technology transferred through training programmes. 4.1.1.4 Manufacturing andAgro-Processing Malawi's industrial growth will be greatly influenced by the success in raising agricultural output and incomes. The bulk of manufacturing activities are highly dependent on agriculture and natural resources as sources of raw materials and provider of foreign exchange for the importation of inputs and components. In addition, increased agricultural incomes will stimulate greater demand for manufactured goods. At present, the industrial sector is relatively small, with manufacturing activities concentrated in a few agro-processing activities as shown in Table4.1.4. However, research38 suggests that Malawi's current comparative advantage in these agro-processing industries will not last into the long-term unless deliberate efforts are made to increase efficiency and introduce up-to-date technologies. 38 Government of Malawi (1995) Malawi Industrial Sector Opportunity Study 1994, Ministry of Commerce and Industry 33 Table 4.1.8: Structure of Manufacturing Sector, Sub-Sectoral Shares (Percent) in Manufacturing Value Added, 1994 - 2000 h of total manufactures Agro processing - 45.1 45.6 43.8 46.3 41.7 41. * 43.2 Food 13.8 14 4 13.9 14.4 11.2 1_l._ 12.3 Beverages 15.2 16.4 14.5 14.2 13. 13. 14.3 Tea 3.8 3 _ 3_._4 2_ 2.51 2.6 Tobacco 2.2 2.3 2.9 3.2 2., 28 2.9 Textiles, Nettings and Blankets 4._ 2._ 2.3 2.3 2._ 2.1 2 Clothing, Leather Goods and Footwear 2.6 2.6 2.5 4.1 4.4 4. 4.3 Sawmill and Wood Products 3.3 3. 3. 4.1 4. 4. 4. Manufacturing 52.1 52 53._ 50.4 5s 54.3 52.9 Packing Materials, Pnnting and Publishing 10. 12.1 12.2 14.1 14.8 15.- 13.7 Chemicals and Fertilizers 5;- 5.1 _ 5.3 6.2 4.31 3.8 Pharmaceuticals, Paints and Soaps 13 1 13. 14.1 13.6 13. 14.2 Plastic Products and Tyre Retreading 5.2 3.8 4 3.6 3.5 2fA 2.4 Non-metallic Mineral Products 4._ 1 3._ 3 2 4 3.2 34 3.7 Metal Products other than Machinery 9.3 9. 1( 7 9. 10.3 10.8 Machinery and Motor Vehicle Assembly 4. 3.d 4.51 3.9 X X 4.3 4.3 All Other Manufactures _ 2 _ 2.! 3.11 3_ 3 3_3 3.9 39_ Source: Government of Malawi (Various years): Monthly Statistical Bulletin, National Statistical Office The major constraints in the manufacturing sector are limited linkages with MSMEs, use of obsolete technologies, inadequate standards and quality assurance and limited intemational marketing capabilities. In addition, most local firms cite the need for collaboration with foreign firms as a necessary condition for their growth and survival, because of their capacities, capital and access to markets39. Further, utility interruptions, inadequate raw materials, and limited engineering and marketing skills constrain the development of the manufacturing sector. In order to facilitate the development of the manufacturing sector, efforts will be made to broaden the industrial base, develop new cluster-based industries, integrate MSMEs in industrial development and establish a credible institutional framework. Other constraints such as skills development and utility interruptions are dealt with elsewhere in the strategy. 1. Broaden the Industrial Base MIPA will spearhead the identification of new sources of growth and promote them so as to strengthen and diversify the industrial base. Research, investment promotion, and training programmes will be focussed on the development of export-oriented, high value-added, high technology industries, with greater assistance and support from domestic research and development. These will ensure that labour intensive, capital intensive and technologically advanced industries have the capability to produce quality and competitive products that are integrated with the regional and intemational markets. 2. Develop New Cluster-Based Industries Emphasis will be placed upon development of competitive industry clusters through integration of key industries, suppliers, supporting industries, critical supporting business services, requisite infrastructure and institutions. Value chains with significant backward and forward 39 Malawi Investment Promotion Agency (MIPA) 34 linkages, domestic spin-offs and value added will be developed with more emphasis on domestic MSMEs. The following industry cluster groups are earmarked for active development, promotion and support: textiles and apparel; agro-based and food products (cassava, soya, fish and fish products, livestock and livestock products, floriculture, fruits and vegetables); resource-based industries (wood and wood products, gemstones, handicrafts); chemical products (pharmaceuticals, fine chemical's), engineering industries (automobile consumables and components) and consumer manufactures. Investment promotion will focus on these clusters, with an emphasis on increased collaboration with foreign firms. 3. Accelerate Regional Development In order to accelerate regional development and reduce transport costs, Government will continue to promote spatial development initiatives. In particular, it will focus on Nacala and Mtwara development corridors, and the ZMM (Zambia, Malawi and Mozambique) growth triangle. For each initiative, the approach will be to identify the resources in the area, and then involve all stakeholders to plan and promote infrastructural investments. 4. Improve Product Standards and Quality Standards and quality control systems will play anjincreasingly vital role in enhancing exports as more and more value-added products are produced. Manufacturers will be encouraged to institute in-house quality control measures in order to produce products that are consistent in quality and competitive in price. The public sector through the Malawi Bureau of Standards (MBS) will work with the private sector to strengthen quality and standards. 5. Integrate MSMEs in Industrial Development As described in Section 4.1.1.3, measures will be taken to facilitate and maximise participation of MSMEs by strengthening their competitiveness through improved access to finance, markets, infrastructure, information, results of research and development and training. Govermnent efforts shall focus on identification and review of the financial, fiscal, administrative and legal constraints inhibiting growth of the MSMEs. 6. Establish a Credible Institutional Framework A credible institutional framework (Business Council) will be established to provide guidance on the implementation of the industrial strategy. The Business Council will facilitate a productive flow of information among the key actors, act as a forum to remove misunderstanding, and enhance mutual respect and forge relationships between the public and the private sectors. 4.1.1.5 Tourism The tourism sector has potential for income and employment generation, particularly in rural areas. However, most tourism developments have been led by foreign investors with limited participation of local communities. Tourism is currently hampered by poor product development, lack of clear standards and guidelines, lack of innovation in marketing and inadequate supporting infrastructure. In order to facilitate poverty reduction through tourism, the MPRS will promote development and investment in diverse tourism products, develop and adopt updated and professional 35 approaches to tourism and marketing, and establish an appropriate regulatory framework to improve the standards and quality of tourism product. These interventions will be implemented in partnership with the private sector on the basis of the Tourism Strategic Plan. 1. Promote Development and Investment in Diverse Tourism Products New tourism products will be developed in their original and traditional settings. Government will work with the private sector to involve rural communities in tourism development, from construction of new facilities such as eco-tourism lodges to running and maintaining them, and through tourist villages, curio markets and cultural events. Training and basic infrastructure (such as tour guide training and construction of vending shelters) will be provided to communities. Investment promotion will be intensified by designating tourism growth areas and formulating investment and concession agreements. In partnership with the relevant authorities, the development of appropriate infrastructure will be planned. 2. Develop and Adopt an Updated Approach to Tourism Promotion and .Marketing The primary strategy will be the creation of a distinct and unique image of Malawi's natural heritage and cultural resources. Strengthening Malawi's identity as the "Warm Heart of Africa" will be an important component of tourism development. Further effort will be made to intensify marketing in both old and new markets at domestic, regional and international level, utilising developments in information and communication technology. 3. Regulate Tourism on the Basis of Defined Standards Standards, classification guidelines and licensing will form key components in ensuring highest possible standards of accommodation, catering establishments, incoming tourism agencies, travel agencies, destination management companies and other tourism service providers. There will be need to set physical standards and regulations for various elements of the tourism product, set processing guidelines for new development and reclassify and license existing establishments according to standards. 4.1.1.6 Small-Scale Mining The mining sector offers the opportunity for creation of rural income and employment generation. The sector employs nearly 3,000 people and there is scope to increase the employment level to 10,000 by 2004, while informal employment is expected to double within the same period4 . Whilst Malawi is endowed with a variety of mineral resources, such as bauxite, coal and uranium, the MPRS will focus on small-scale mining involving quarry stone, lime, gemstones, pottery-ceramics, gemstones, salt aggregate, limestone, sand and clay (pottery and brick moulding). The key objectives in promoting small-scale mining are to disseminate information on mineral availability, identify mineral resources suitable for small scale mining, encourage the development of small-scale mineral based industries, provide technical and financial support, ensure appropriate mining legislation, improve understanding of value adding methods and promote marketing. 40 Government of Malawi (2000): Economic Report, National Economic Council 36 1. Disseminate Information In order to have proper dissemination of information relating to availability of minerals, exploration-status, mining and setting up of mineral based industries, a focal point will be created in the Department of Mines to undertake a number of activities. Firstly, the Department will oversee the preparation and updating of an inventory of minerals available and produced in the country, including district-wise tenement maps. Secondly, the introduction of a quarterly publication of the 'Malawi Mineral Bulletin', including studies in the field about mining methods, reduction and utilisation of mining waste and development of mining machinery and equipment for use in small mines. Thirdly, brochures will be prepared for target minerals like granite, ceramic minerals, decorative and dimensional stones to facilitate setting up of mineral based industry. 2. Provide Technical and Financial support Technical support on both mineral extraction and value-adding will be provided by the Department of Mines and Geological Survey through district-based training programmes. Credit institutions will be encouraged to extend credit facilities to small-scale miners (see Credit and Microfmance section in Pillar 1). 3. Identify Mineral Resources Suitable for Small-Scale Mining Although a variety of mineral deposits and resources suitable for small-scale mining are known to occur in the country, very little detailed information on quality and quantity of the minerals is available. The Geological Survey Department will identify and evaluate more mineral resources, which can be mined and processed by small-scale miners. In order to assist the small-scale miners the Geological Survey Department will focus its exploration and evaluation on minerals that can be developed or utilised locally. Where possible, preliminary and prefeasibility studies will be jointly conducted by the two departments. Minerals such as gemstones, kaolintic clays, gypsum, phosphate, alluvial gold and graphite can easily be developed by this category of miners. 4. Encourage the Development of Mineral Based Small-Scale Industries To accelerate the deliberate development of mineral based small-scale industries, there is an urgent need to strengthen existing research centres, which will develop simple technologies in the manufacturing of finished mineral based products. The Geological Survey Department will extend its research activities in the application and utilisation of indigenous mineral raw materials. The existing laboratories in the Department of Mines and Geological Survey need to be upgraded. The research centres will thus provide training and extension services to small- scale entrepreneurs in mining, mineral processing and manufacturing of finished mineral based products. 5. Ensure Appropriate Mining Legislation Emphasis will be placed on smoothening prevailing office procedures for greater convenience, avoidance of delays and reduced time lag in grant and renewal of mining leases and streamlining the system to ensure greater objectivity, transparency and proper application of the law. 37 6. Promote Value-Addition, Marketing and Exports Small-scale miners will need assistance to improve the quality standards acceptable to foreign markets. This will in part be achieved through the formation of miners' clubs and associations. In addition, suitable incentives will be developed to increase exports. The following measures will be taken to promote export of minerals: Fairs and exhibitions will be organised locally, periodically, so that the type of minerals and decorative stones available in the country may have the desired publicity; visits to national and international trade fairs, exhibitions and seminars will be organised for both potential exporters; and standard equipment will be used to improve and maintain quality standards suiting the requirements of foreign buyers. 4.1.2 Creating an Enabling Environmentfor Growth Apart from the specific sectoral sources of pro-poor growth identified above, it is clear from the consultation process and from intemational and historical performance that in order to generate growth, the private sector must operate in an enabling environment. This environment will enable the private sector (whether small scale or large scale, domestic or intemational) to identify and exploit investment opportunities in any sector of the economy, without major Govemment generated obstacles. The key factors that will contribute to an environment conducive for pro-poor growth are macroeconomic stability, access to credit, and improved rural infrastructure. Efforts will also be made to improve other infrastructure, strengthen trade and review taxation policy. Further, issues of human capital development covered in Pillar 2, issues of governance (security, rule of law, corruption, and parastatal reform) covered in Pillar 4, and issues of macroeconomic management discussed in Chapter 5 are important components of an enabling environment. 4.1.2.1 Macroeconomic Stability Macro-economic stability is a precondition for economic growth. Strategies to ensure macro- economic stability, which include improved fiscal discipline and tight monetary policy, are described in Chapter 5. 4.1.2.2 Credit and Micro-Finance Micro-finance plays a critical role in poverty reduction by increasing access to credit by the productive poor. Programmes and schemes run by the Government through Development of Malawian Entrepreneurs Trust (DEMAT), Small Enterprise Development Organisation of Malawi (SEDOM) and NGOs have been seen to have positive impact on the lives of the recipients in terms of increased food consumption, increased savings, increased self- employment, access to other basic necessities and business expansion. However, these can only be targeted at the productive poor who are able to make sufficient return on their investments. The unproductive poor who cannot generate surpluses will only become indebted and therefore worse off, and are better served with safety net interventions, as outlined in Pillar 3. Limited access to affordable credit has emerged as one of the important factors affecting production by poor households. The problem of access is in three main forms, namely, geographical coverage, costs or affordability of the credit available, and the insufficiency of 38 loanable funds, particularly as they relate to micro-finance institutions. Where credit is available, access, particularly by women, has been hindered by prohibitive collateral requirements, although women have demonstrated high repayment rates. From the financial institutions' point of view, the high rates of default, particularly in agriculture or rural-based enterprises, have significantly reduced the willingness of financial institutions to lend to farmers and small business. As a result of these constraints, farmers have not been able to buy inputs such as fertilisers, seeds and other chemicals, leading to lower yields and inability to help themselves. High default rates are commonly attributed to a poor credit culture in Malawi. This is caused by a number of underlying factors. Firstly, lending methodologies directly affect repayment behaviour - there are some institutions that have maintained repayment rates of over 95 percent due to well-designed methodologies. Secondly, schemes with conflicting objectives or political motives tend to create confusion as to whether the programmes offer loans or grants. Thirdly, credit programmes targeting the unproductive poor are likely to have low repayment rates and will force the poor into debt. Finally, agricultural loans are subject to additional risks due to weather and international market factors. Access to credit by rural communities has also been hindered by collateral requirements and high cost of borrowing due to high interest rates. Finally, the micro-finance sub-sector has in the past been segmented and poorly coordinated. While a micro-finance network has been established to create and promote common rules and standards for the sector, there is need for additional efforts from practitioners, government and donors to increase the coordination of the sector and establish a regulatory framework. Government's goal in micro-finance is to promote the development of a sustainable micro- finance industry, which provides credit, savings opportunities and other financial services to the poor thereby creating wealth and employment. This necessitates strategies to address the broader financial sector, which support micro-finance. 1. Reduce the Cost of Credit. Government will strive to restore macro-economic stability through the observance of strict fiscal discipline and tight monetary policy to bring down inflation and interest rates, as discussed in Chapter 5. 2. Strengthen the Institutional Framework The regulatory authorities (such as the RBM) together with the micro-finance institutions (MFIs) will establish an appropriate framework to regulate and supervise the activities of MFIs. This will ensure that activities carried out by Governments institutions, NGOs, banks, financial institutions, commercial companies and the donor community are co-ordinated and have a common agenda of sustainable poverty reduction. Specific actions include the development of legislation describing the regulatory framework including the self-regulatory mechanism and the thresholds for full supervision by the regulatory authorities. Further, Government in collaboration with the micro-finance network will carry out an impact assessment study to evaluate the impact on the lives of poor clients. The micro-finance 39 network will develop a code of conduct to promote perforimance standards in the industry with an aim to maximise the poverty impact through increased outreach in terms of client and portfolio and cost effective operations. Government will assist the micro-finance network to establish an operational secretariat and encourage their micro-finance partners to join the network. 3. Reduce High Default Rates To address the problems of high default rates among the low-income credit clientele, tougher and more efficient legal sanctions will be introduced to ensure that borrowers make an effort to repay their debts. The creation of a credit reference bureau will be facilitates. Recovery of bad debts by the lending institutions also requires enforcement legislation to be strengthened so that the legal process of dealing with defaulters is speeded. In addition, Government will promote the formation of farmers clubs and co-operatives to reduce problems of identity and collateral. Finally, in order to overcome the high risks associated with lending to rural communities, Government will encourage the use of other forms of collateral such as land and life policies. Where these may not be available, an appropriate credit guarantee scheme or insurance fund will be established. 4. Expand Competition and Efficiency in the Credit Market Government will strive, at the appropriate time, to commercialise and privatise all Government controlled micro-finance institutions to enhance efficiency and competition. This strategy will reduce political interference, which is contributing to misallocation of resources and high default rates. In addition, in order to expand coverage and innovative lending by institutions, there is need to further encourage competition in the system. Specifically, interlocking ownership linkages among the two dominant commercial banks will be eliminated through full privatisation of the two banks and by encouraging new entrants into the system. 5. Diversify and Expand Coverage Government will increase its efforts to mobilise donor support to provide financial resources to act as seed capital to strengthen and expand the geographical coverage of most MFIs. In collaboration with the micro-finance industry, Government will design and provide incentives for the development and expansion of MFIs operating in rural areas. Domestic resource mobilisation by formal institutions such as the Malawi Savings Bank (MSB), commercial banks and other financial institutions will be encouraged and linked to MFIs so that they can be channelled to the poor. Finally, as outlined under agriculture, village banks and SACCOs will be promoted and capitalised. 4.1.2.3 Rural Infrastructure Improving rural infrastructure is an essential requirement for the commercialisation, modemisation and growth of agriculture and MSMEs. Better market incentives will be irrelevant if the physical barriers to and economic costs of doing business in rural areas are too high. Hence, there is need to provide good rural roads (including bridges), water and sanitation, energy, and telecommunications. 40 Investment in rural roads has direct impact on linking the rural areas, urban and peri-urban areas. Improved access to rural areas reduces transport costs and leads to the creation of marketing networks to enhance value adding. Rural feeder roads also have social benefits through better access to social services such as health centres by facilitating mobility. Further, improved rural infrastructure will alleviate gender disparities, as women bear the burden of transporting heavy loads and travelling long distances to access social services. The rural population will benefit directly from the construction of the rural roads through employment generation under the Public Works Programme (see Pillar 3). The provision of and equitable access to potable water supplies and reasonable sanitation facilities are central to poverty reduction as they have a direct impact on health status and therefore productivity. The need to improved access to safe drinking water was also amongst the top priorities during the MPRS district consultations. The MDHS 200041 shows that only 65.6 percent of households have access to potable water supplies. However, only about 60 percent of existing boreholes are currently functional. Further to this, there is a limit to the extent to which the nation's groundwater resources can effectively be exploited through construction of boreholes without irreversible damage to the environment. Thus, borehole construction will be complemented by an expanded programme of construction and rehabilitation of rural gravity-fed piped water schemes. Increased access to safe water must be complemented by sanitation measures. At present, only 81.4 percent of households have reasonable access to a latrine. Finally, in order to sustain the borehole and piped water system construction, it is important for the sector to equally continue to put in place mechanisms for the conservation and management of the nation's water resources Stable energy supply is essential to materialise the growth of the sectors identified above in the section on sources of pro-poor growth. The demand for power and other forms of energy will increase as the growth sectors increase their economic activities and electrification proceeds. Electricity is also an essential input to improved social services and mass-communication through television. Providing households with alternative energy other than wood fuel is essential for reducing poverty and envirommental degradation. Renewable energy technologies such as solar and wind power will be an area of focus. Malawi's internal telecommunications coverage is low at around four lines per thousand persons and is concentrated in urban and semi-urban areas. Telecommunications can benefit rural firms and people by giving them direct access to customers and linking them to information about markets, suppliers, technology, and government regulations. Such networks can also make it less expensive and more efficient for firrns to locate in rural places, and can enable small towns to import services like healthcare through telemedicine technology and education through distance learning facilities. 41 Govemment of Malawi (2000) Malawi Demographic and Health Survey 2000 41 1. Improve Rural Transport Infrastructure Govermnent and other stakeholders will improve feeder roads to increase accessibility and productive potential of rural areas. Government through the National Road Authority (NRA) has formulated a five year programme in the road sub-sector based on: improving the accessibility of the road network, reducing transport costs, increasing network coverage particularly in the rural areas, and improving road safety. Firstly, priority sections of the rural feeder road network will be restored from a state of severe deterioration to a fair condition through rehabilitation. Government will further ensure that a sustainable road grading and maintenance programme is in place to preserve the rural feeder road network infrastructure as a capital based asset in which government has already made substantial investment. Government will also improve accessibility to remote areas through the construction of new feeder roads. Finally, Government will decentralise responsibilities for planning and management of urban and district road maintenance and construction to local assemblies. Table 4.1.99: Rural Feeder Roads Targets Kilometres graded 12,150 Kilometres rehabilitated 2,100 Metres of other infrastructure 24,000 (bridges, waterways etc.) 2. Increase Accessibility to Good Drinking Water and Sanitation The strategies under this objective are to .construct and rehabilitate water facilities, extend water supply capacity, promote community based management and improve water resources conservation and management. Government will combine an expanded borehole rehabilitation and construction programme with effective borehole maintenance strategies. This will be achieved through capacity building among rural communities to own, operate and maintain their facilities. In addition extension workers will be trained in borehole maintenance and will subsequently be used to assist rural communities as technical experts. This borehole programme will be complemented by an expanded programme of construction and rehabilitation of rural gravity-fed piped water schemes. Secondly, capacity to meet the growing demands from industry and domestic users will be expanded. This will involve the extension and rehabilitation of the existing infrastructure, water loss reduction measures, enhancement of cost recovery measures and strengthening of the viability of the water supplies. Further, reforms to improve the operational autonomy and commercial viability of the nation's water boards will be pursued more vigorously. The conservation and management of water resources will include the construction and rehabilitation of small community multi-purpose earth dams and instruction of catchment management authorities. In addition, institutional capacity will be strengthened to improve the collection and quantification of hydrological data vital for the determination of viable water resources. 42 Finally, measures will be taken to reduce the incidence of waterbome diseases. This will include the introduction of VIP latrines and other appropriate rural water sanitation technologies. Table4.1.10: WaterandSanitation Ta ts Households with access to 65.6% 84% potable water Rehabilitation of boreholes (% 60% 100% (rehabilitate 2,000) functional) Construction of new boreholes 7,500 Rehabilitation of rural piped 15 water supply schemes Households with sanitary 81.4% 100% excreta disposal _ 3. Increase Access to Affordable and Sustainable Rural Enereg The objective is to increase access to modem and commercial energy, and to ensure economic efficiency in supplying and utilising energy at affordable prices. The first strategy is to increase rural and pen-urban electrification from the present 4 percent national average. This will involve rehabilitation and extension of national grid distribution lines, and the creation of mini-grids powered by mini-hydro, diesel or photovoltaic power generation. The second strategy is to reduce pressure on wood fuel. The rate of utilisation of fuel wood greatly exceeds the rate of its natural growth in Malawi. Rural households will be encouraged to use more energy efficient charcoal and wood stoves. There will be need to encourage, develop, produce and market reliable, economically accessible and appropriately priced alternative energy supplies (such as biogas). Low-income urban families will be assisted with appropriate credit and interventions for purchasing stoves and appliances that use these fuels. Thirdly, the MPRS will expand electricity supply options and to provide incentives for the development of fuel retail outlets in rural areas. Table 4.1.11: Rural Energy Targets Number of new sites electrified 73 New biogas plants 105 Dissemination of charcoal and 2 districts 27 districts wood stove technology coverage 4. Improve Rural Telecommunications The first strategy is to finalise the rural telecommunications policy in order to encourage the private sector to provide telecommunications services in rural areas, for example through rural cellular based telephone bureaux. In order to complement this, network providers will be encouraged to expand their networks to serve these private sector providers. 43 4.1.2.4 Other Enabling Infrastructure The key component in the enabling environment for the private sector is the quality and availability of investment infrastructure. The provision of reliable economic infrastructure is crucial for private sector development. Regular power supply, availability of water and sanitation services, good transportation and good port facilities, efficient telecommunications and infrastructure are necessary to complement public and private initiative in production and commerce. Major investments will be required to clear the backlog of maintenance and rehabilitation, and undertake new investments to match the excess demand for infrastructure needed to support productive sectors. Many of these investments will not be financed by or through Government, as they are not immediate priorities for poverty reduction. However, given their importance to private sector development and therefore to long term poverty reduction, Govermment will actively seek private sector and international investors to finance these investment projects. Where necessary, this will involve using innovative financing arrangements (such as Build-Operate- Transfer). This issue is discussed further in Section 5.4 and in Annex 3. The enabling infrastructure falls into five categories: transport, energy, telecommunications, broadcasting and postal services. The sources of growth identified above cannot deliver without energy. As the economy grows, industry expands, coverage is increased and urbanisation continues, demand for energy will rise significantly. In order to meet this demand, there is need to increase supply capacity, including diversification to other renewable sources within the context of the Energy Policy. The telecommunications sector was liberalised following the enactment of the Communications Act in 1998, which has led to an increase in the number of operators as well as the separation of postal services from telecommunications. Malawi Telecommunications Limited (MTL) was incorporated in May 2000 and is now undergoing privatisation. Government has also liberalised services such as cellular networks, e-mail and internet, leading to a proliferation of providers of these services. However, these developments have not yet achieved the desired goal of facilitating growth and diversification as MTL is still a monopoly and does not meet demand. Radio and television play an important role in poverty reduction through mass information, education, mobilisation and entertainment whilst creating awareness of political and socio- economic issues. However, at present, this role is difficult to fulfil due to inadequate equipment and poor resource mobilisation. The ability to communicate is important to private sector development as well as community development and empowerment. The current postal system in Malawi is inadequate with poor service delivery, due to mismanagement and inadequate cost recovery. 1. Strengthen Transport Networks Government will complement its efforts as regards rural feeder roads with efforts to rehabilitate and maintain the core road network. The expansion of the core road network and 44 investment in other transport sub-sectors (such as railways and airports) will be financed through private sector and intemational investors using innovative financing arrangements. . 2. Increase Access. Efficiency and Reliability of Modem Energv Supplv The main focus is in the sub-sectors of electricity, liquid fuels and renewable energy. The objective is to increase access to reliable and equitable electricity services and to ensure economic efficiency in the supply chain of liquid fuels and their end utilisation at affordable prices. The strategies will be implemented in the context of the new Energy Policy. Given that growth and diversification rely on power, it is evident that Electricity Supply Corporation of Malawi Limited (ESCOM) should implement strategies, financed by the private sector and intemational investors, which will lead to reduction of electricity losses, and improve its operation through the setting of tariffs at economic levels and separating into semi- autonomous, operational units. Reforms in this sector will continue to include strategies aimed at increasing the number of players through provisions in the Electricity Act. The other strategies will include the interconnection with neighbouring countries and utilising coal and petroleum products and other sources of energy in electricity generation. These strategies will aim at satisfying the energy requirements for the medium-term and beyond, in a scenario of stable economic growth and diversification. 3. Expand Telecommunications Coverage MTL in partnership with the private sector and intemational investors will continue to expand its coverage, aiming at increasing the number of working telephone lines to not less than 150,000 by 2004 and reach two lines for every one hundred people as soon as possible after that date. In addition, Govemment will continue liberalisation of the sector by opening up the provision of telecommunications to the private sector. This will help to raise the quality of service and reduce charges. 4. Improve Oualitv of and Access to Broadcasting Efforts will be made to improve the quality of radio broadcasting by restructuring the Malawi Broadcasting Corporation (MBC), replacing obsolete transmission equipment with modern equipment, and computerising radio studios, financed by advertising and other revenue together with private sector and international investors. In order to provide televised information to the population, Television Malawi (TVM) will migrate from analogue to digital formats, install more low power transmitters to ensure maximum television reach in the country, improve the transmission network, establish community-viewing centres, improve studio infrastructure and open regional centres to ensure regional coverage of news issues. As with MBC, the investment costs will be covered by increased advertising and other revenue together with private sector and intemational investment. Further, adequately trained personnel will be required to ensure professional packaging of information to the viewer. Finally, efforts will be made to ensure that programmes broadcast focus on poverty and development. 5. Improve Postal Services Access to postal services will be improved by increasing the number of post offices, including renting existing infrastructure. Efforts will be made to ensure sustainability of postal services 45 and the financial independence of the Malawi Postal Corporation (MPC), by increasing charges to cost recovery levels, and introducing innovative methods of service delivery, such as contracting out mail delivery services and mutual arrangements with other public institutions that frequently visit rural areas. 4.1.2.5 Domestic and External Trade Both domestic and external trade continue to play a major role in the growth and development of the economy. Trade has facilitated the development of both economic and social sectors, particularly agriculture, manufacturing and tourism. There are a number of constraints to growth of domestic and international trade and these include lack of access to credit, lack of appropriate skills, weak linkage to markets, inadequate quality assurance and standards, and poor packaging. The objectives to address the development and promotion of domestic and international trade include the provision of supportive infrastructure, expansion of domestic market share, expansion of export market share and negotiation of preferential arrangements. 1. Provide Supportive Infrastructure Physical infrastructure will be improved through the measures outlined in sections 4.1.2.3 and 4.1.2.4 and the support to MSMEs and agro-processing discussed in sections 4.1.1.3 and 4.1.1.4. In general, the private sector will be encouraged to play a greater role in infrastructural development, through innovative financing arrangements. In addition, trade administrative infrastructure will be established, including the creation of sustainable export credit refinancing. 2. Expand Domestic Market Share Local manufacturers and producers will be encouraged to increase their share of the domestic market. This will also help in the expansion of the domestic market for Malawian products and reduce the current preference for imported goods. The main emphasis will be placed on instilling a sense of loyalty and national pride among domestic consumers to purchase local goods. Other measures will include giving recognition to manufacturing companies that will have achieved high standards and quality in the production of goods. Specific measures will be instituted to enforce more transparent preferential treatment of local .entrepreneurs. Other measures will include the encouragement of bulk purchases, joint advertisements and promotions, joint ventures and buy-outs. Formal and informal networking among the traders will be supported through collation and sharing of market information and consumer behaviour. Private sector trade associations are expected to play a more effective role than in the past. Steps will be taken to protect consumers by enforcing the competition law, ensuring that consumers are protected from unethical and unfair trade practices, misleading advertisements, unsatisfactory services and other unethical marketing practices. 46 3. Expand Export Market Share The promotion and development of exports will be further strengthened. Malawi Export Promotion Council will re-orient its activities to be business like to ensure full co-ordination and consolidation of export promotional activities. Trade promotion centres will be established whilst rationalising existing trade representations. 4. Negotiate Preferential Arrangements Government will ensure compatibility of trade agreements and ensure reciprocity in the implementation of regional and bilateral arrangements. The multiplicity of trade agreements offers a challenge in terms of compatibility and implementation. Continuous efforts will be made to expand the market shares within the existing as well as new market and non-traditional markets. Regional trade and cross-border investment will be expanded through SADC, COMESA and bilateral agreements. Government will also focus on maintaining and strengthening preferential non-reciprocal agreements with developed countries such as the Lome Convention and the Generalised System of Preferences, the EU's Everything But Arms (EBA) initiative and the US Africa Growth and Opportunity Act (AGOA). Government recognises that least developing countries, including Malawi, can make use of the special clauses of the Uruguay Round providing differential and more favourable treatment and implement and benefit from the commitments undertaken. Meanwhile, Government will continue to negotiate with its HIPC and LDC partners for preferential agreements and the removal of barriers and subsidies in developed countries. 4.1.2.6 Taxation Government has undertaken a number of tax reforms during the past decade. However, there remains a need to develop a coherent longer-term taxation framework which balances revenue generation with the need to support the private sector. At present, the taxation system applies high rates of taxation to a narrow base of the medium and large scale formal private sector. In addition, exemption criteria are not transparent and there are often delays in processing applications for exemptions and refunds. Further, the Malawi Revenue Authority still faces problems in enforcing compliance. A fundamental change is needed in the approach to planning public finances. At present, the tendency is to decide on public spending first and then identify the sources of funding. The new approach should move towards deciding the level of taxation and expenditure consistent with the level of taxation and tax burden. 1. Define and Enforce Transparent Tax Exemption Criteria Government will, in consultation with the private sector and other development partners, define transparent tax exemption criteria in order to ensure a "level playing field", reduce the potential for corruption, and reduce administrative delays. These criteria will focus on encouraging investment and development activities consistent with the MPRS. Tax relief and incentives will be rationalised and retained in highly selective circumstances for fixed period where it can be shown that they are most likely to achieve increases in employment and investment. 47 2. Review Corporate Tax The corporate taxation system and rates will be reviewed in consultation with the private sector. Particular attention will be paid to removing distortionary and duplicative taxes and rationalising the system to ensure simplicity and compliance. Effort will be taken to ensure an appropriate balance between the need to generate domestic public resources for implementing MPRS activities through the Budget, and the need to ensure adequate domestic resources for employment and investment 3. Widen the Tax Base A further widening of the tax base will be pursued in order to facilitate the lowering of tax burden on the enterprise sector. In particular, surtax will be extended and the Malawi Revenue Authority (MRA) will increase its collection and enforcement activities. 4.2Human Capital Development Human capital is key to poverty reduction in Malawi. A healthy and educated nation leads to increased productivity, better income distribution and a generally improved standard of living. A deteriorating health situation undermines the ability of individuals to lift themselves out of poverty and leads to a general decline in productivity. Similarly, an uneducated population does not understand and appreciate the need and means for achieving higher incomes, reducing infant mortality and population growth as well as improving nutrition and health. Functionally, the major economic sectors of agriculture and industry demand an educated, skilled and healthy workforce to take on the new challenges and aspirations of the sectors. At the same time, with appropriate human capital, the public and private sectors, civil society and poor people themselves will be able to positively influence and impact on processes and outcomes of the entire poverty reduction strategy. Statistics show that there is much room for improvement on human capital in Malawi. The national illiteracy rate stands at 42 percent42 due to problems of access to and quality of education. There is also lack of skills development due to inappropriate education curricula at all levels and low access and intake into technical, entrepreneurial and vocational training institutions. In terms of health, life expectancy at birth has reduced from 43 years43 in 1996 to 39 years in 2000 mainly due to the HIV/AIDS epidemic. Malnutrition is also high among children resulting into about half of all the children being stunted and 30 percent underweight. In order to address these problems, this pillar has four goals, ensuring the development of human capital through implementation of education, technical, vocational and entrepreneurial education and training (TEVET), health, and nutrition programmes. 4.2.1 Education Education yields broad social and economic benefits. Not only is education positively associated with agricultural productivity, higher incomes, lower fertility rates and improved 42 Government of Malawi (2000) Malawi Demographic and Health Survey, National Statistical Office 43 Ibid. 48 nutrition and health, it is also a prerequisite for attaining these outcomes. Hence, education is the centrepiece for the poverty reduction strategy. In particular, basic education will be accorded highest priority in the MPRS. It is recognised, however, that this is not a sufficient condition for an individual to escape poverty. Sustainable national development also requires the development of secondary, higher and pre-school education. Poverty reduction through education in Malawi is faced with a number of challenges as some indicators testify. On a positive note, the introduction of Free Primary Education (FPE) in 1994 led to an increase in enrolment from 1.9 million (1993/94) to 2.9 million children (1994/5). This led to an increase in the gross enrolment rate to 132 and the net enrolment rate of 7844 by 1999. However, the challenges in primary education include dealing with the large numbers of over-aged pupils resulting in high repetition rates.45 Moreover, this increase in the quantity of primary education has been offset by a decline in quality and a high drop-out rate. For example, there is a serious shortage of teaching and learning materials such as textbooks; the pupil to qualified teacher ratio is high at 118 and the pupil to classroom ratio is high at 95. The national target for the latter two ratios is 60. Partly as a result of the above problems of quality, retention of children in school is low, especially among poorer households and females. At present, it is estimated that only 30 percent of children who start primary school complete Standard 846. There have also been significant problems of access to basic education for children with special needs, as the necessary enabling environment and infrastructure has been inadequate. At the secondary level, access is still very limited, with a gross enrolment ratio of 18 percent. Access is also highly unequal, particularly affecting children from low-income families and girls. The latter account for only around 37 percent of gross enrolment. The quality of secondary education is also inadequate and unequal, as demonstrated by poor examination results and the disparities between Conventional Secondary Schools (CSSs) and Community Day Secondary Schools (CDSSs). This is in part caused by the crowding out of quality inputs (such as qualified teachers and teaching and leaming materials) by expenditures on boarding and administration47. Access to higher education in Malawi remains low, with fewer than 4000 places available. Females occupy less than 30 percent of the places. Enrolment is limited by inadequate school places, boarding facilities and financial resources. As a result, capacity in terms of physical infrastructure and human resources is frequently under-utilised. Furthermore, the limited financial resources received are used inefficiently by the University of Malawi, which spends more than half of its resources on boarding and administration48, yet student to staff ratios remain very high. In addition, the quality of higher education has been undermined by poor 44 For definition of GER and NER, see Glossary 45 See Chapter 2 on Poverty Profile 46 Government of Malawi (2000): Public Expenditure Review 2000, Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning 7 4ibid. pg. 8 48 ibid. pg. 100 49 linkages to industry in the curriculum and frequent closures of colleges due to the high burden on Govemrnment resources. In light of the positive link between education and poverty reduction, there is a clear need to increase access to and improve the quality of education at all levels. To achieve this, there are five main objectives applicable at each level: (1) improve quality and relevance of education; (2) increase access and equity in education, focusing on girls, orphans and children with special needs; (3) strengthen management, planning and finance; (4) respond to HIV/AIDS pandemic; (5) strengthen co-ordination across all players in the education sector, both public and private. 4.2.1.1 Basic Education In the context of basic education, the objectives are as follows: 1. Improve the Ouality and Relevance of Primary Education Improving the quality and relevance of primary education involves four main strategies: teacher recruitment, training and incentives, development of relevant .curriculum, teaching and leaming materials and supervision and inspection. In terms of teacher recruitment, training and incentives, Govenmment will improve Teacher Training College facilities to enable the recruitment and training of more primary teachers. In addition, existing unqualified teachers will be provided with initial training and qualified teachers' skills will be upgraded using in-service training (INSET). Moreover, the Department of Teacher Education and Development will be upgraded and further strengthened, and due attention will be given to issues of teacher management and deployment. Finally, Government will revise teachers' remuneration packages, to ensure retention of teachers, particularly in rural areas. In order to improve the quality and relevance of education, the teacher and basic education curricula will be revised so that they meet the needs of pupils, potential employers and the nation. Students should be offered a curriculum that will equip them with knowledge of life skills, such as technical, entrepreneurial, and agricultural skills. Maintaining quality will also depend on government ensuring that all pupils have access to an adequate supply of instruction materials. This will require a change in management and planning such that the distribution of education materials will be decentralised to a zone based system. Finally, Government will promote a well-coordinated and more effective. supervision and inspection service. The teacher to Primary Education Adviser (PEA) ratio will be decreased and the number of advisory visits per term will be increased. Schools will have to meet both instruction and physical infrastructure standards. School comnmittees will be trained in community based management. The monitoring of school health and sanitation provision will be strengthened, with measures taken to construct adequate boreholes and latrines. 50 Table 4.2.1: Basic Education Quality Targets Number of teachers 45,784 51,323 Teacher Trainees (cumulative) , 12,000 Pupil to qualified teacher ratio 118 85 Teacher to PEA ratio 145 81 Drop out rate 12% 8% Repetition rate 15% 10% 2. Improve Access and Equity at the Primary Level, Focusing on Special Needs Education and Girls. Basic education for the disadvantaged: the poor, girls, orphans, children with special needs and learning difficulties, has much room for improvement in Malawi. The current enrolment level of children with special needs is only 5 percent. Special needs education suffers from inadequate leaming centres, non user-friendly infrastructure, lack of learning materials and inadequate specialist teachers. In terms of infrastructure, there are currently 15 resource centres for the visually impaired and only 4 centres for the hearing impaired at primary level. The strategies to improve access, quality and relevance of basic education for children with special needs will involve the establishment of adequate learning centres with adequate accommodation. The recruitment and training of specialist teachers, the development of relevant curricula for teacher training, the procurement of learning materials and equipment and the introduction of a bursary scheme for these students will be priority areas in the short- medium termn. Students with mild disabilities will be integrated into conventional schools. In addition to promotion of special needs education, equitable access will also require social mobilization campaigns which target orphans, those affected by HIV/AIDS, girls and out of school youths. Finally, Government will expand physical access to education by increasing the usage of school blocks through double shifting, increasing the number of school blocks and ensuring adequate rehabilitation and maintenance of existing blocks. Table 4.2.2. Primay Education Access Tarts - et u u19=_ _ Number of new classrooms 2,250 (cumulative) Number of classrooms 4,500 rehabilitated Female enrolment (total) 1.4 million 1.5 million Female enrolment (%) 48% 50% Pupil: specialist teacher ratio 48 26 (Visually impaired) Pupil: specialist teacher ratio 13 7 (Hearing impaired) Pupil: specialist teacher ratio 18 5 (Leaming difficulties) _ 3. Increase and Improve Functional Adult Literacy and Numeracy. To achieve increased and improved adult literacy will require close co-operation between Government (Ministries of Education, Science and Technology and Gender, Youth and Community Services) and NGOs.. Government will revise the adult literacy policy and curriculum, train 12,000 literacy instructors (including primary school teachers) and print and 51 distribute adequate adult literacy teaching and leaming materials. Efforts will also be made to open up more Rural Instruction Centres (RICs) in existing facilities for adult literacy. Table 4.2.3: Adult Literacy Education Targets Number of adults enrolled 37,500 300,000 Number of instructors 2,000 12,000 4. Provide Special Education for the Out of School Youth The objective will be achieved through the development of multi-purpose youth centres, equipped with appropriate learning materials to impart vocational and technical skills. There will also be a strengthening of out of school youth clubs, lead by trained youth patrons, where it is envisaged that youths will gather to exchange ideas. Table 4.2.4: Out-Of-School Youth Education Targets Number of youth patrons 1,300 2,985 Number of youth centres 10 81 5. Expand Pre-School Education/Early Childhood Development (ECD) It is important that an adequate supply of motivated new care givers are provided and trained, including training of existing ECD teachers. There will then be a need to identify ECD centres and to construct new ones, where appropriate. Efforts will also be made to provide adequate learning materials and communities will be encouraged to contribute locally made materials. Table 4.2.5: Pre-School Education/ECD Targets Number of ECD teachers 620 1,500 Number of ECD centres 0 70 6. Respond Urgently to Problems Created by the HIV/AIDS Epidemic The HIV/AIDS pandemic has adversely affected the education sector. The toll through loss of teachers and the related burden of welfare costs erodes the resources provided for the sector. So far there has been no coordinated and. consolidated effort to fight the disease but a strategic plan is in the process of being developed. In order to deal with HIV/AIDS in the education sector, Government will implement a sector- specific strategic plan on HIV/AIDS, involving prevention and mitigation among teachers and pupils. In addition, HIV/AIDS education will be imparted to the youth through the media and youth clubs. 7. Decentralise Administrative and Planning Responsibilities Decentralisation will be the major driving force in strengthening efficiency and accountability of resources and results. Basic education will be made accountable to local level authorities with development and operational responsibilities transferred from central government to the districts. Self-regulation mechanisms through school committees at grass roots level will be introduced. In addition, teacher training and institutions will be decentralised by making them independent cost centres and by reducing central controls. Further strategies include the 52 strengthening of monitoring and evaluation systems so that data collection and analysis is carried out in order to make informed decisions, through the establishment of a District Education Management Information System (DEMIS). 4.2.1.2 Secondary School Education Whilst basic education is the minimum necessary for an individual to escape poverty, secondary education is also necessary for equipping students with the skills required for private and public sector employment. Moreover, secondary education is expected to enhance entrepreneurial skill, business management, agricultural expertise and life skills capabilities which are important for self-employment and life improvement. In addition, secondary education encourages further studying, as an input to the acquisition of the range of essential skills. The objectives of secondary education will be as follows: 1. Increase Access and Equity to Secondary Schools There are two aspects to access and equity issues in secondary education: firstly, increasing access to secondary education for girls, children from poor families and children with special needs and secondly, increasing the total number; of secondary school places to absorb the increasing number of primary school graduates. In order to increase access for girls, children from poor.families and those with special needs, the secondary school bursary scheme (SSBS) will' be expanded. In addition, more secondary school places will be created, and school blocks will be made user-friendly for students with special needs. In terms of general access, Govermment will introduce double shifting to improve efficient utilisation of existing infrastructure, provide distance learning and build new school blocks. Measures to support the development of the private schools sector will be taken, to ensure capacity for the targeted private sector enrolment. 2. Improve Quality and Relevance of Secondary Education This objective involves eight key strategies: (i) upgrading facilities and equipment; (ii) reforming the curriculum to include life skills, entrepreneurial skills, and agriculture development needs, (iii) teacher recruitment, (iv) training and remuneration, (v) increasing teaching and leaming materials, (vi) enhancing supervision and support services, (vii) upgrading under-qualified teachers through distance methods, and (viii) redesigning the Secondary Teacher Education Programme and consolidating programmes at provider institutions. The upgrading of facilities and equipment will focus on bringing Community Day Secondary Schools (CDSSs), to which the poor have more access, up to the standards of Conventional Secondary Schools (CSSs). In addition, Government will ensure that there are adequate resources for the maintenance and rehabilitation of existing infrastructure, much of which is in a state of disrepair. Initially, only minimum standards will be enforced. 53 In order to improve the relevance of education, the teacher and secondary education curricula will be revised so that they meet the needs of students, potential employers and the nation. Students should be offered a curriculum that will equip them with knowledge of life skills, such as technical, entrepreneurial, and agricultural skills. The curricula will be reviewed every ten years to ensure it is up-to-date. There will be periodic reviews of the examination system to improve efficiency and effectiveness. Assessment approaches must provide measures of what an individual's achievement levels are in terms of competencies and skills. Measures must be comprehensible to the general public. Measures will be taken to ensure parallel improvements in textbook and learning support. Quality secondary school education also depends on the recruitment, training and retention of teachers. This will involve instituting an updated, relevant and rigorous programme of teacher education in all higher education institutions, both public and private. Non-residential training will also be introduced and subject specialisation encouraged. Various refresher courses will be undertaken for teachers. These actions, in combination with a revision of remuneration packages, will create an environment conducive to teacher retention. Finally, Government will ensure an adequate supply of teaching and leaming materials. This will involve the strengthening of textbook revolving funds and the introduction of cost sharing, in conjunction with the bursaries mentioned above. Table 4.2.6: Secondary School Targets _1_ I__II_ffll Number of students 236,500 324,031 Number of private students 16,555 64,806 Number of students entenng 11,550 MCDE Number of teachers 5,269 8,130 Female gross enrolment 19% 25% Schools teaching information 8 100 and communication technology _ 3. Improve Management and Administration of Secondary Education Efforts will be made to improve the efficiency and effectiveness of secondary education by decentralising responsibilities, strengthening managerial capacity at district and school level, and rationalising the use of resources. This rationalisation will involve phasing out or introducing cost recovery for non-core services, such as boarding, and ensuring that human and financial resources are allocated according to needs. This, in turn, will require ensuring the Education Management Information System (EMIS) covers the secondary system. 4.2.1.3 Higher Education The MPRS will transform the higher education system to respond to new realities and opportunities within the context of poverty reduction. The sector will increase the participation rate for both men and women to meet the demand for highly trained graduates in different fields taking into account labour market and poverty reduction needs. The sector will strive to advance high-level capacity through the expansion of post-graduate training to support scientific and technological improvement and social development. 54 The main focus of the MPRS will be on improving efficiency and quality education measured by increased access of females, males and disadvantaged students in higher education, reduced unit costs, production of highly qualified graduates and less dependency on subvention through cost recovery and decentralization. The sector will also focus on increasing motivation of teaching and research staff. 1. Increase Access and Equity in Higher Education The first strategy is to ensure full capacity utilisation of facilities including the introduction of double shifting and distance learning. The University Education Act will be reviewed to accommodate private sector initiatives. In order to increase equity, about 30 percent of intake will be reserved for girls and this proportion will be increased to 50 percent by the year 2012. In the context of increasing user fees discussed below, scholarship schemes will be introduced for girls and needy students and loan schemes will be strengthened for other students. 2. Improve Quality and Relevance of Higher Education Higher education institutions will introduce programmes in non-traditional subjects such as science and technology, gender, food security, human rights, biodiversity and HIV/AIDS, among others. This will involve the establishment of adequate research centres that would be addressing emergent development issues, providing grants to graduate students so that they participate in teaching undergraduate courses and as research assistants. The second strategy is to increase the motivation of teaching and research staff, by reviewing salary packages and encouraging privately funded research. The private sector will also be encouraged to participate in the definition of subjects, curricula and research and to give visiting lectures and classes so as to improve the relevance of higher education. 3. Reduce Reliance of Higher Education on Subventions Reducing the reliance of higher education on Government subventions involves two types of interventions: firstly, reducing costs of provision of higher education and secondly, generating alternative sources of resources. In order to reduce costs, non-core services such as catering and boarding will be commercialised and contracted out. Further, administrative staffing levels will be reduced and administration decentralised to constituent colleges of the University of Malawi. As a result, the role of the central University of Malawi Office will be reviewed so that staffing and costs are substantially reduced. In order to generate alternative resources, the University will introduce cost recovery for non- core services, such as boarding, and will increase cost sharing for tuition, both in the context of strengthened scholarship and loan schemes. Institutions will create business developmeni units to generate resources by charging for the use of existing facilities and for collaborative programmes outside school sessions. 55 Table 4.2.7: Higher Education Targets Number of students 3,526 6,824 Students in private colleges 35 1,100 Number of distant learners 0 558 Number of female students 698 2,047 Number of needy students 500 1,706 Females in non-traditional 225 801 subjects Number of students with 20 30 disabilities Number of students in 821 1,500 information technology 4.2.2 Technical, Entrepreneurial Vocational Education and Training According to the labour market survey of 1998, about 300,000 people leave the formal education system every year. However, only 30,000 enter formal employment annually, leaving a balance of 270,000 people who enter the labour market annually and seek some other source of income other than formal wage employment. These figures suggest that technical, entrepreneurial vocational education and training (TEVET) needs to cut across all levels of education for people to become active players in poverty reduction. This will require development of relevant competence based curricula at primary, secondary and post-secondary levels as well as the development and acquisition of appropriate teaching and learning materials and equipment. In addition, qualified teachers will be necessary to impart the vocational and technical skills. The existing TEVET system has failed to satisfactorily meet the potential demand for a number of reasons. In terms of providing places, the current annual capacity within the public technical colleges is 1,441 and capacity within private provider institutions is 18,000. These capacities are not adequate to cater for prospective entrants into the TEVET system. The focus on formal, full-time residential training, particularly in public technical colleges, has undermined the possibilities of achieving better coverage and outreach, and at the same time, has taken attention away from the potential offered by more flexible, demand-driven training, such as that provided by the Malawi Entrepreneurship Development Institute (MEDI). Demand for places has also been limited by a number of factors. Firstly, lack of basic education, high illiteracy and lack of knowledge, exposure and information pertaining to the provision of vocational training. Secondly, cultural factors have led to lack of exposure to the prospective subsistence and carrier opportunities. Thirdly, lack of access to funds catering for tuition fees, boarding fees, transport and utilities. Finally, limited recognition of vocational skills has led to poor investment in human resources and infrastructure. It is therefore envisaged that the MPRS will address some of these problems. To achieve this, the following strategies will be implemented: 1. Promote Self Employment through Skills Development Initiatives The MPRS will empower the poor in the informal sector through establishment of skills development initiatives in the rural areas. Govemment will expand and increase outreach and 56 coverage of TEVET programmes through mobile village polytechnics49 in all districts. This will involve establishing and running polytechnics, mounting and running mobile training units, and linking decentralised units to designated resource colleges in catchment areas. Further, skills development will involve implementing on the job training programs in specific occupations for the youth in collaboration with MASAF and other stakeholders, conducting demand-driven specialised skills training programmes, and training of trainers for entrepreneurship development in the informal sector. Youth specific skills development will be achieved through developing multipurpose youth centres and providing resource and educational information, training youth patrons and leaders and providing actual vocational training. 2. Improve Oualitv and Relevance of TEVET The relevance and quality of TEVET will be improved by reviewing, developing and implementing competency-based curricula. This will involve revising all existing curricula in primary and secondary schools and within the TEVET sector, developing new curricula within all occupations (including HIV/AIDS prevention messages and the use of appropriate technologies), and training teachers in using new curricula. The quality of TEVET will also rely on the development of appropriate, and sufficient human capacity by establishing a flexible and cost effective technical teacher training system. 3. Rehabilitate Existing Infrastructure and Equipment The MPRS will ensure sustainability and quality standards by promoting maintenance and effective operation of equipment in education institutions and other training colleges. Strategies include taking stock of existing equipment and assessing needs within public technical colleges, training staff from public colleges and private providers in preventive and corrective maintenance, and rehabilitating classrooms, workshops and existing public colleges. 4. Strengthen Management and Financing of TEVET Government will strengthen the partnership between the public and private sector, and take measures to improve compliance with the TEVET Levy. Table 4.2.8: Vocational Training Targets Public training capacity % of population 0.01% 0.03% Public vocational training % of districts 21.43% 28% Private training capacity % of population 0.18% 0.20% Private vocational training of districts 75% 78% Enrolment ratio female 20% 26% Enrolment ratio male 80% 74% HIV infection rate students 15% 13.5% HIV infection rate teachers 15% 14.2% Boarding Capacity (% of training 22.7% 20.5% capacity 49 Village polytechnics involve setting up simple structures at EPA level to train people in specialised skills they require in that area 57 4.2.3 Health and Population The health of an individual is directly related to economic and social well-being. An improved health situation will strengthen the ability of individuals to lift themselves out of poverty and will lead to a general increase in productivity. However, as described in Chapter 2 and Table 4.2.8, health indicators in Malawi have remained poor despite a relative increase in resource allocation towards the sector over the past ten years. Health interventions (both preventative and curative) take place at four levels: community, primary, secondary and tertiary. Preventative interventions are focussed on nutrition, sanitation and public information campaigns, for example on the use of mosquito nets. Preventative interventions relieve pressure on other levels of healthcare and are less costly to the poor. Community level healthcare is delivered through Health Surveillance Assistants (HSAs), some of whom manage Drug-Revolving Funds and Bakili Muluzi Health Initiatives in conjunction with Village Health Committees (VHCs). Primary healthcare is delivered through health centres and clinics, and is aimed at improving maternal and child health and the promotion of early treatment of common disease conditions. Secondary healthcare, delivered through the district hospitals, is aimed at treating more specialised conditions. Finally, tertiary healthcare, delivered through central hospitals, provides referral services for highly specialised conditions. Table 4.2.9: Comparative Health Indicators South Africa 623 54 69 m _567 UKnda 65 837 131 590 41.9 Mozambique 28 127 203 1100 40.6 Sub-Saharan - 107 172 48.8 Afric'a _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ OECD . 13 15 76.4 Source: UNDP (2001): Human Development Report 2001, UNDP p.159-169 An overview of the health sector shows that the health system has been centralised with many of centrally designed and vertically managed projects, resulting in substantial duplication of effort, poor co-ordination and high administration costs. In addition, there has been inadequate support to and coordination with private sector providers, such as the Christian Health Association of Malawi (CHAM) and certain NGOs. A major problem leading to Malawi's poor health indicators is a lack of qualified and adequately compensated medical staff, in terms of doctors, nurses and related personnel. This problem is particularly acute in rural areas, and has been exacerbated by the HIV/AIDS pandemic and internal and external "brain drain" due to low remuneration and poor career prospects. This results in extremely high population per physician ratios, estimated at 58 45,73750. Furthermore, access to drugs is a problerm, again particularly in rural areas. This is caused by a combination of low (but increasing) allocations to drugs, and distribution problems, including pilferage and inefficient allocation. There is also an acute shortage of clinical and technical support services in most hospitals and health centres. These include laboratory services, pharmacy services, radiology, ambulance services, district and regional-level blood bank, orthopaedics and physiotherapy. This is due to low investment in these facilities particularly in district hospitals. Technical support services play a crucial role in empowering persons with disabilities to undertake activities for daily living. Referral bypass currently poses major challenges to the health sector. This is both a cause and a consequence of poor health facilities and services; at primary level, particularly in rural areas. People seeking medical services avoid clinics, due to the poor quality of infrastructure and the shortage of medical workers, drugs and medical supplies. As a result, it is estimated that as many as 85 percent of central hospital admissions could be treated at lower-level facilities51 This concentration of cases at secondary and tertiary levels further draws resources away from primary facilities. The primary healthcare system has suffered disproportionately from the general problems outlined above. In particular, it has suffered from a combination of high human resource demands in terms of Health Surveillance Assistants (HSAs), nurses and clinical officers, with low levels of financial resource allocations. In addition, physical access to health centres has remained poor, with only 3 percent of the population living in a village with a health centre. Existing health centres are in poor condition, and have an inadequate supply of drugs and medical supplies. In addressing these problems, the overriding objective is the design and implementation of an Essential Healthcare Package (EHI'). Essentially an EHP is a bundle of health services provided at community, primary and secondary levels, supported by the necessary administrative, logistics, and management systems. The EHP addresses the major causes of morbidity and mortality among the general population and focuses particularly on medical conditions and service gaps that disproportionately affect the rural poor. The EHP also addresses issues of family planning and population. In recognition that not all services can be provided to all people, an EHP can be seen as having a particular equity focus, through guaranteeing access to a minimum standard of health care for everyone. Thus the EHP is an explicit form of rationing, through identifying certain services as high priority. This is contrasted to the current implicit rationing of health services as witnessed through drug stock- outs, staff unavailability and long queues. The EHP development process provides an opportunity to revisit the distribution of funding in order to determine whether the relatively scarce resources might achieve greater impact through a shift in their allocation. 50 World Bank (2001) "Malawi Public Expenditures: Issues and Options", pg.37 5' ibid. p. 37 59 Table 4.2.10: Conditions Addressed in the Malawian EHP MMONROMMU_U- Malaria 1st cause of outpatient first EEC, incJuding promotion of ITNs attendance: Vector control 36.4% under-5; 28.8% 5 and Diagnosis and treatment of simple malaria over Referral Acute respiratory infection Upper respiratory infection BCG irmmunisation and imnnunisable diseases 2nd cause of outpatient first Polio, measles, DPT attendance: Diagnosis and treatment of ARI 13.8%under-5; 11.5% 5 and Referral over Acute diarrhoeal disease Other diarrhoeal disease 3rd IEC cause of outpatient first Water and sanitation facilities at health centres attendance: Treatment of Tnild diarrhoca with ORS 8.8% under-5; 5.70/o 5 and Case management of acute diarrhoea and cholera over Referral Nutritional 49% stunting among under 5s, Provision of Vitamin A conditions/deficiencies half of whom are severely Provision of iodine stunted; Anaemia ._____ _ Deworming Maternal Maternal mortality estimated Antenatal care conditions/pregnancy between 600 and 1100 per Clean and safe delivery complications 100,000 live births Postnatal care (tetanus injections) Family planning Referrals [EC Sexually transmitted diseases, including Screening for syphilis, contact tacing, treatment HIV/AIDS VCT Treatmnent of opportimistic infections Condom promnotion Tuberculosis Leading cause of inpatient IEC mortality Screening, contact tracing, treatment Referral Eye and ear infections Injuries Schistosomiasis Vector control Treatment (mass) Source: EHP Design Team 4.2.3.1 Preventative Healthcare The key areas for preventative healthcare are nutrition, water and sanitation, and prevention of common diseases such as malaria. Issues of nutrition and water and sanitation are covered under separate sections in Pillar 2 and 1 respectively. Issues of common disease prevention are covered under the EHP, as shown in Table 4.2.9 above, and described under the section on the EHP below. 4.2.3.2 Essenlial Healthcare Package (EHP) The EHP covers issues of community, primary and secondary healthcare. EHP strategies are grouped under three main objectives: improving quality and availability of essential healthcare inputs, improving access to and equity of essential healthcare, and strengthening administration and financing of essential healthcare services. 1. Improve Quality of Essential Healthcare The first component of the EHP is to promote clinical human resource development. Human resources are an absolutely critical delivery input of the EHP implementation. This will involve ensuring that clinical teaching and training institutions are fully utilised and expanding 60 the training of various clinical cadres like HSAs, nurses, medical assistants, clinical officers, and technical support services (such as radiographers, orthopaedic technicians and pharmacists). Government will also review the remuneration and career structures for medical staff in order to address problems of attrition through "brain drain". The second component is to increase the availability of drugs and medical supplies. The drugs and medical supplies required in an EHP must be constantly present in health facilities, both in adequate quantities and of appropriate quality. To achieve the availability, there is need to ensure that: the procurement, logistics, management, distribution, and prescription of drugs is reviewed so that all drugs procured reach the intended patients and are prescribed properly. There is also need to reform the Central Medical Stores to function efficiently. These steps are essential complements to the phased increase of allocations to drugs and medical supplies. The third strategy is to expand and promote clinical and technical support services. This will involve expanding and promoting clinical and technical services by ensuring that certain services are present in district hospitals and health centres. These include; laboratory services, pharmacy services, radiology, ambulance services and district or regional-level blood bank. 2. Improve Access to and Equitv of Essential Healthcare Government will ensure increased access to healthcare facilities by rehabilitating existing infrastructure and increasing mobile health services. In particular, delivering the EHP at health centre level will depend on the existence of well-maintained health centres with fully functioning support systems, piped or bore-hole water supply, solar, stand by generator or ESCOM power and radio and telephone communication systems. 3. Strengthen Management and Financing of Essential Healthcare Services. The first strategy is to develop financial and managerial resources so as to strengthen planning, budgeting and transport management, particularly at a district level. This will involve training and retraining financial managers/accountants, administrators, senior nurses and matrons. In order to improve the financing of essential healthcare, Government will develop and implement an integrated financing strategy for the EHP. Operational research will guide the decision as to whether the EHP will be free at the point of entry, or subject to user fees charges with an exemption mechanism for poor or targeted groups. Non-EHP services in government facilities will be financed through cost-recovery schemes (for example, mandatory user fee schemes) or health insurance coverage. The financing strategy is also likely to recommend voluntary user fees for core EHP services that have an additional comfort or practical element (such as private wards, better food, faster attention etc). This element will also be part of expanded health insurance coverage. This financing strategy will take full account of the fact that many Malawians can afford to contribute towards better health care: the National Health Accounts (2001) has shown that the richest 40 percent spent K822 million in 1999 to 2000 on health care. The financing and management of essential healthcare services will also be strengthened through the development of a Sector Wide Approach (SWAp) in the health sector. The major role of the SWAp is to coordinate, strengthen and make more effective donor and government 61 financing of the EHP. This will largely leave private sources of finance to develop the rest of the (non-EHP) health sector. In its early stages the SWAp will detail a joint vision of the donor and govemment funded component of the health sector, and describe a joint programme of work and monitoring systems. In later stages, joint financial systems maybe developed and utilized, including the co-mingling of funds. Finally, the ongoing decentralisation of the health sector, within the context of the broader devolution to the local government through district assemblies, will create the setting in which the EHP is to be delivered. One common objective of decentralisation is to take the planning of health services closer to the people they are intended to serve. If local involvement is to be meaningful, there should be flexibility for district managers, in consultation with health staff and community members, to "weight" resource allocation to the various components of the EHP according to local needs (for example, less bilharzia or more malaria in specific districts). Table 4.2.11: Selected Essential Healthcare Targets Number of HSAs trained 7,000 Number of nurses trained 470 Number of technical staff trained _ 825 Number of physicians trained ._ _ 60 % of health centres equipped to EHP standards 100% Drugs and medical supplies expenditure per capita US$1.25 US$2.50 4.2.3.3 Tertiary Healthcare In tertiary healthcare, the key challenges are to reduce referral bypass, to reduce crowding out of tertiary services by primary and secondary services. This will in large part rely on the improvements to primary and secondary healthcare at health centre and district hospital level outlined in the above section on the EHP. However, in addition, Government will strengthen the referral system and promote hospital autonomy. 1. Strengthen Referral System In order to ensure only genuine cases are referred to central hospitals, a strengthened formal referral system will be introduced, with unsubsidised outpatient fees for self-referral cases and civic education on the role of central hospitals. 2. Introduce Hospital Autonomy Government will autonomise central hospitals within 3 years. Once the hospitals attain full autonomy, they will be able to introduce cost recovery programmes, re-capitalise their facilities to compete with other providers for insurance of referral contracts. Further, the autonomised hospitals will be encouraged to contract out non-core services (such as catering, laundry and mortuary services) to the private sector and to improve the efficiency of resource allocations. Table 4.2.12: Health Targets for 2007/8 Infant mortality (per 1,000 live births) 104 90 Under 5 mortality rate (per 1,000 live births) 189 150 Maternal mortality rate (per 100,000) 620 400 Nutrition (% children underweight) 30% 20% Population (fertility rate) 6.1 5.5 62 4.2.4 Promotion of Good Nutrition Malnutrition is both a cause and a consequence of poverty. Increased illness and mortality as well as reduced work productivity due to malnutrition have exacerbated poverty and continue to retard economic growth and development. Therefore good nutrition is a precondition for, and not merely a result of, human and economic development. The immediate cause of malnutrition is inadequate dietary intake, which is caused by a combination of underlying factors including household food insecurity, poor child-feeding and care practices, and inadequate education and lack of knowledge. The situation is further worsened by frequent and persistence infections, especially malaria, diarrhoea, acute respiratory infections (ARI) and HIV/AIDS. Statistics show that 49 percent of children are stunted (height for age); 25 percent are under weight and 6 percent are wasted. In addition, malnutrition has caused widespread mental retardation. For the past decade there has been no significant improvement in the nutritional status, as shown in table 4.2.13. Table 4.2.13: Nutrition Indicators 1992 - 2000 _F' de;_ e 1 wst 1992 MDHS 44% 27% 7% 1995 MSIS 48% 30% 7% 2000 MDHS 49% 25% 6% If the situation remains unchanged, loss of life, reduced productivity and high rates of illness will continue. The goal is therefore, to prevent and control protein, energy and micronutrient deficiencies. This will be achieved through the following objectives: 1. Improve Infant and Young Child Feeding Poor infant and young child feeding practices contribute greatly to malnutrition. For instance the majority of infants are not exclusively breast fed up to 6 months and they are later fed on low energy and nutrient-dense complimentary foods. In order to address these problems, the MPRS includes strategies to promote exclusive breastfeeding, complementary feeding and feeding during illness and convalescence through the Baby Friendly Health Initiative (BFHI). 2. Diversification and Modification of Diets Dietary diversification is very poor in Malawi. T1e diet is monotonous, predominantly with nsima made from maize with vegetables. This lack of diversification is reinforced by inadequate awareness of nutrition issues among policy makers and the general public. There is need to change peoples' attitude towards making nsima from one type of cereal as it could be made from different starchy foods. It is also very important to diversify diets using other locally available foods. This will be achieved through community awareness campaigns on nutrition, food and security and nutritional policy, together with campaigns on HIV/AIDS and fiutrition. Further, Government will organise short courses for various workers in all districts on the prevention 63 and control of malnutrition, will train senior personnel on food and nutrition, and will review the curricula of extension agents, primary and secondary school teachers in order to incorporate nutrition issues. 3. Strengthen Institutional Capacity Effective implementation of nutrition interventions requires well co-ordinated efforts from different stakeholders. Currently nutrition activities and research are uncoordinated and have resulted in little impact. In order to address this problem, Government will create a Food and Nutrition Council as a technical machinery to spearhead the implementation and coordination of nutrition activities and research. In particular, it will coordinate relevant research on food and nutrition, monitoring of fortified foods, evaluation of food nutrition programs and establishing sentinel nutrition surveillance system. 4.31mproving the Quality of Life of the Most Vulnerable The proposed broad-based growth in Pillar 1 and the inclusive human capital development in Pillar 2 will go a long way in reducing the numbers of the poor. However, it is recognised that there are still going to be some sections of the population that are not going to benefit and will need direct assistance for them to improve their living standards. The overall goal of the third pillar is, therefore, to ensure that the quality of life of the most vulnerable is improved and maintained at an acceptable level by providing moderate support to the transient poor and substantial transfers to the chronically poor. The most vulnerable are broadly defined to include individuals or households affected by disasters; households headed by orphaned children, elderly and single-parents (especially female headed); persons with disabilities; under-five children, lactating and pregnant mothers; orphans in streets, orphanages, foster homes and extended family member households, the unemployed and underemployed in urban areas; the land constrained in rural areas; and technology-constrained small-scale farmers. It is noted, however, that this general categorisation does not mean that all people or households falling under these categories are the most vulnerable. The determining factor is their ability to meet their basic needs. Figure 4.4.1 below presents the safety nets programme on the basis of poverty characteristics. Malawi has sought to improve the quality of life of the poor in the past in a number of ways. Firstly, Government sought to protect the poor by the use of market-based polices including price controls, price subsidies and minimum wages. Secondly, Govemment and other development partners, especially NGOs, have also used administered safety nets programmes like nutrition supplements, free food distribution, free input distribution, food or inputs for work and public works programmes to assist the vulnerable and the poor in general. Thirdly Govenmment provided direct assistance and social welfare transfers through the Department of Social Welfare, the Malawi Council for the Handicapped (MACOHA) and the Department of Disaster Preparedness, Relief and Rehabilitation (DDPRR). Finally, the poor have traditionally relied on informal safety nets, such as the extended family. 64 However, these efforts have faced many problems. Most of the market-based policies were inefficient, fiscally unsustainable and mostly benefited the non-poor and missed the core poor. Consequently, all the market based protection policies, with the exception of minimum wages, were abolished under the economic reforms. The administered programmes were fragmented, uncoordinated and were poorly targeted, suffering from both inclusion and exclusion errors. Direct assistance and social welfare transfers have been small in size and limited in coverage, largely due to financial constraints. The informal safety nets, likewise, have become over stretched and vulnerable to shocks due to increased poverty and the HIV/AIDS.scourge. Poverty-stricken extended families and communities are increasingly being put under unbearable pressure, as they take care of HIV-infected chronically sick and AIDS-related orphans. Figure 4.4.1: Con V tual Frameworkeforgna f Nets ' tiEl Chronically ill oo Elacaigmtersy w ° S c}Rr Persons with critical Publ j i ~~Malnourishcd under-5s Tree Vulnerable pregnat/ Targeted lactating mothers Nutrition Rural poor with labour Publicgo Urban poor Works >o > 0L * J'G) ~ Rural poor T X with land Ipt The group "persons with critical disabilities" includes those persons with disabilities that are unable to create their own income. In general, the poor with some resources like land and labour require productivity enhancing interventions like targeted inputs and public works as indicated in the bottom half of the figure. Meanwhile, the capacity or resource-constrained poor require welfare support in the form of interventions like targeted nutrition and welfare transfers, as indicated in the top half of the figure. The productivity enhancing interventions generally reduce poverty while the consumption support interventions alleviate poverty. 4.3.1 Safety Nets The overall goal of this pillar is to ensure that the quality of life of the most vulnerable is improved and maintained at an acceptable level by providing social safety nets. These safety nets will consist of productivity enhancing interventions for the transient poor (those within the poorest 30 percent of the population who are capable of moving out of poverty) and substantial welfare transfers to the chronically poor (the poorest 5 to 10 percent of the population). 65 For each of these types of safety nets, there are common challenges. In particular, the, prograrmmes must be designed to ensure good targeting, distribution, co-ordination and management. These challenges are addressed below for each type of safety net: 4.31. 1 Productivity Enhancing Interventions As highlighted in Pillar 1, low incomes and inaccessibility of input credit have prevented small-holder farmers from increasing their productivity and therefore their incomes. Similarly, the IHS has shown that 81 percent of the poorest 10 percent of households haye landholdings of less than 0.5 hectare and most of their cash income is generated from non-agricultural, mainly piecework (ganyu). There are therefore two types of productivity enhancing interventions: targeted distribution of inputs for the capital-constrained poor, and public works programmes for the land-constrained poor52. The Targeted Input Programme (TIP) will therefore provide a pack containing open pollinated maize and legume seeds and two types of inorganic fertilizers for a period of three years to identified poor small-holder farmers. This pack is expected to be applied to 0.25 hectare of land. Each targeted household is expected to graduate after three years. The programme will target 340,000 beneficiaries. Public Works Programmes (PWP) will play a major role in providing alternative sources of income and food for the poorest segments of the population apart from providing long-term benefits to communities through the created socio-economic infrastructure. In essence PWP give a chance to the participants to develop themselves, and be self reliant instead of depending on handouts; especially if the wage income is invested in income-generating activities. Beneficiary and impact assessments have shown that most of these programmes had positive welfare effects. Some participants of the cash-for-work PWPs have managed to use the cash received under PWP to start up micro-businesses. It has also been established that half-day work schedule give time to labour-constrained households to work in their fields while participating in PWP. Major problems of PWPs are their short-term nature and timing mismatches. The average engagement is 60 days yet most of the core poor who are supposed to benefit from these remain vulnerable for at least half of the year. Secondly, these programmes are not available when they are needed; that is in the months of December to April. 1. Distribute Free Inputs to Capital Constrained Poor Farmers Unlike the previous targeted inputs programmes, the packs will be distributed through major retail outlets. For areas not covered by the participating retail chains, non-governmental organizations will be asked to tender for the delivery of the packs. The selected NGOs and the retail chains will be responsible for the procurement and delivery of the packs. The selected beneficiaries will be issued with vouchers that will be exchanged with the packs at the participating retail shops. 52 The categories "land constrained" and "capital constrained" are not mutually exclusive. Certain households may qualify and benefit from both programmes. 66 The office of the Minister of State Responsible for Poverty Alleviation Programme (MSPAP) will have the overall coordination and management of the programme. Among other responsibilities, MSPAP will design the programme, manage the tendering, and reimburse retailers on the basis of vouchers exchanged at their outlets. District Assemblies are to assist in geographical and beneficiary selection. Communities are to be responsible for the selection of beneficiaries. The Ministry of Agriculture and Irrigation is to work with MSPAP in designing the programme as well as recommending the pack composition and mounting agricultural extension campaigns specific to the recommended pack. The beneficiaries will be selected using a two-stage' selection process. The first is geographical targeting, selecting areas on the basis of food insecurity and vulnerability. The second stage will involve selecting the beneficiary household, using community-based beneficiary selection committees. In designing the guidelines for the selection of beneficiaries, priority will be given to households taking care of orphans, the elderly, chronically sick and dependent persons with disabilities. Finally, public awareness campaigns will be conducted, involving the training of communities, supervisors and field staff, designing and mounting public awareness-building campaigns, and discussing with retailers and NGOs. 2. Implement Public Works Programmes for Land-Constrained and Urban Poor The works to be undertaken include rehabilitation, of earth roads, construction of small earth dams and other rainwater harvesting structures, storm water drainage channels, flood protection structures, afforestation and road maintenance. Some of these PWPs will run all year round to provide a continuous source of livelihood for the beneficiaries. The rehabilitation of earth roads works will take advantage of existing designs and capacities of District Roads Improvement and Maintenance Programme (DRIMP). In some cases, small- scale contractors used will be encouraged to employ women as is the case under Community Roads Improvement Maintenance Programme (CRIMP). 53 The Public Works Programme will generate employment for as many as 250,000 participants Targeting will be done in two stages. The first, stage is geographic areas selection using Vulnerability Assessment and Mapping (VAM) verified by the District Assemblies using TA- level food production assessment. The second level is beneficiary selection, using wages as a self-selection mechanism combined with traditional leaders, project committees and rotational targeting. Public awareness campaigns will also be conducted at community level to encourage voluntary participation, especially amongst women. Cash is the form of transfer for most of the PWPs. However, others adopt payments-in-kind (mostly maize) and vouchers to maximise food security. Food vouchers will give households freedom to choose when to get their rations since they allow beneficiaries to acquire the food when they need it. 53 It should be noted, however, that the proposed PWP is not a guaranteed employment scheme because such a system would require a lot of resources (human and financial).' Further, guaranteed employment scheme would require continuous availability of public works through the year and in all parts of the country where the poor are. 67 The public works will be carried out by small-scale contractors using labour employed from communities. The selection of the small-scale contractors will be done jointly by MSPAP, District Assemblies and the Community Development Committee. The Community Development Committee will- be responsible for the selection of the beneficiaries and the communities are to be responsible for the election of the committee and selection of the public works. National coordination of PWPs will be managed by MSPAP, whilst District Assemblies will be responsible at district level. The role of sectoral ministries and departments will be to assist in the development of the common standards by providing technical specifications and assist in the supervision of the relevant works. All public works projects will be required to implement training and capacity building components to enable the District Assemblies to implement the sub-projects efficiently and effectively. 4.3.1.2 Welfare Support Interventions There are two types of welfare transfers: targeted nutrition interventions for malnourished children and vulnerable pregnant and lactating mothers, and direct welfare transfers for the poor who cannot be supported by any of the other three programmes. These include groups like the chronically ill, the elderly and orphans. Persons with disabilities falling in the category of the poor will be considered alongside the other poor depending on their poverty status and capabilities. However, as a group, persons with disabilities will continue to work with institutions like MACOHA that are specifically set up to deal with their needs. Malnutrition is a key cause of the high infant, child and matemal mortality rates depicted in Chapter 2. Further, nutrition status in a child's early years (from conception to five years) determines in part the child's future potential. This malnutrition is largely attributable to poverty and lack of appropriate diets for children and pregnant and lactating mothers. The provision of nutritious food to these vulnerable groups would assist reduce malnutrition and illnesses and deaths of infants, children and pregnant mothers. As outlined in Figure 4.4.1, there is a group of people who are unable to fend for themselves and have to rely on others. This group will not be able to take advantage of the other three types of safety nets either because they are unable to work or have no resources. Further, some households and communities are affected by drought and floods, undermining their ability to provide for themselves. Finally, as a result of over-stretched informal safety nets, some individuals (especially orphans) are forced to move to urban centres to beg and live in unhealthy conditions. 1. Implement Targeted Nutrition Programmes for Malnourished Vulnerable Groups The programmne will provide nutrition packs54 to moderately malnourished children and vulnerable pregnant and lactating women and administer therapeutic feeding in nutrition rehabilitation centres to severely malnourished children. Beneficiaries are expected to graduate after five months. In addition, the pilot phase will include the provision of training in basic 54 Mothers will be given vouchers that can be exchanged for a pack containing a 10-kg bag of Likuni Phala, 10-kg bag of Mgaiwa (unrefined maize flour), 3-kg packet of legume seed, and a packet of vegetable seeds. 68 nutritional behaviour, cultivation of the contents of the pack better weaning practices, and cooking demonstrations. The nutrition packs, just like inputs packs, will be stocked by retailers and exchariged with the vouchers. For remote areas where retail coverage is inadequate, the procurement and delivery will be tendered out to NGOs or commercial companies for delivery direct to health facilities. Households that qualify for this programme will automatically be assessed for inclusion in the other safety nets programmes. The children will be selected on the basis of their age and weight. The mothers will be selected on the basis of clinical examination. Key factors in the examination include signs of malnutrition, anaemia, multiplicity of births (twins or triplets) and age (less than 15 years and older than 35 years). Apart from providing food transfers, the programme will also admit severely malnourished children for medical treatment and therapeutic feeding. 2. Provide Direct Welfare Transfers to the Core Poor and Disaster Affected Households. The Targeted Welfare Transfer programme will involve the direct transfer of cash or a cash proxy (retail voucher). Since the programme has not been carried out extensively in Malawi, its implementation will be done on a pilot basis. The programme will be implemented alongside TIP, utilising the community based targeted approach and alongside the Targeted Nutrition Programme. The programme will also use specific support groups such as those for the elderly, orphaned and the chronically ill. After beneficiaries are identified, cash transfers will be made through District Assemblies. In some cases, the programme will use value-based welfare retail vouchers (flexi-vouchers). To reduce security risk, the vouchers will be both beneficiary and date specific. The value of transfer will be determined by resource availability and factors such as household monthly food requirements and minimum wage levels". One of the key institutions for this programme is the District Assemblies. However, implementation will be done by a number of stakeholders. The MSPAP will be responsible for the overall program design, coordination of the piloting, policy support, as well as monitoring and evaluation. District Assemblies are to take over the management of financial resources. In addition, the District Assemblies will assist in the beneficiary selection exercises, delivery of cash/vouchers as well as the redemption of vouchers. The Department of Disaster Preparedness and Rehabilitation will also be strengthened and linked accordingly with its stakeholders. The civil society and other specific support groups will be responsible for distribution of vouchers. 3. Improve Capacities of Support Groups As already seen, the informal safety nets are under strain. However, it is recognised that these safety nets are the best mechanisms for taking care of orphans, the elderly and people with disabilities. Government and other stakeholders will therefore work to strengthen the capacity of families and communities to provide support and protection to orphaned children, the aged 55 The value of the transfer is expected to be about US$83 per beneficiary per annum 69 and persons with disabilities. Further, the problems faced by the extended family system caring for these vulnerable groups have led to the growth of community-based support groups. The work of these support groups has been recognised as important hence their use under the direct welfare transfers. It is, however, recognised that the capacity of these support groups needs to be strengthened. This will involve training of foster care parents, volunteer counsellors, and home-based carers and committees, and establishing community-based childcare centres. Table 4.3. 1: Safety Nets Targes Number of TIP beneficiary households per year 568,000 Number of PWP beneficiary households per year 250,000 Number of TNP beneficiary households per year 150,000 Number of income support beneficiaries per year 100,000 4.3.2 Improving Disaster Management Malawi is frequently affected by natural disasters and calamities. The Lower Shire has been declared a disaster area a number of times due to floods, which occur almost annually. Other areas, in particular lakeshore areas; are also prone to floods during years of heavy rains as was the case in 2001 when 15 out of the 27 districts were hit by floods. The MPRS therefore recognises the impact of such weather-related calamities on the poor and the need to put in place adequate disaster management measures. Natural disasters like floods and hailstorms destroy crops, livestock, and other infrastructure thereby reducing the poor's productivity.and removing their sources of livelihoods. The MPRS recognises that different categories of the poor are affected differently according to their specific production potentials affected by the disaster. It also recognises that for the poor not to be annual victims, disaster management must go further than emergency response. The MPRSP will regard disaster management in a continuum that addresses problems of preparedness, prevention, mitigation, reduction of impact, relief (emergency response), as well as rehabilitation and reconstruction. 1. Strengthen Disaster Preparedness The strategies under disaster management include the full use of established early warning systems like the Famine Early Warning System (FEWS) and the National Early Warning System (NEWS). This will be done in close collaboration with the Ministry of Agriculture and Irrigation as well as the Meteorological Department. At a regional level disaster preparedness will take advantage of SADC Disaster Management Unit in forecasting weather related calamities, and therefore institute necessary impact mitigation tools. This will also ensure foresight in assessing risks and hazards and coming up with solutions ahead of calamities, as well as identifying the vulnerable groups using VAM. 2. Ensure Effective Disaster Relief Disaster victims will also be covered under relief programmes. The DDPRR will continue to prepare Emergency Operation Programmes, which run for 90 days to ensure that disaster victims maintain sustenance while they reconstruct their shelter. On the other hand seed will be 70 provided for dimba56 planting to produce a replacement crop. Alternatively seed will be provided for the next crop production season. Basic necessities of non-food items will also be distributed. 3. Facilitate Rehabilitation and Reconstruction Disaster victims will also benefit from rehabilitation and reconstruction of destroyed amenities such as boreholes as well as infrastructure such as roads, schools, clinics, and police units. In certain disaster situations, the DDPRR will cooperate with the World Food Programme (WFP) and NGOs to introduce income generating activities as a post-disaster activity. Other small- scale programmes such as replacement of small livestock like goats, and the Food for Work (FFW) programmes will target poor communities to ensure food security. Except for disaster preparedness, the strategies under disaster management are in concert with the four main strategies in Pillar 3. Therefore an assessment of the impact of disaster on the livelihoods of the affected individuals, households and areas will be done in terms of the best response. Depending on the assessment, any or a combination of the four safety nets types will be implemented. For example, food distribution will be implemented if food production is affected. Likewise if the disaster requires some rehabilitation of the affected area or if income- generating capacities are reduced, public works programmes will be implemented. 4.4Good Governance Even with the best strategies for pro-poor growth, human capital and safety nets, poverty will not be reduced unless there is development-oriented governance. Good governance in this sense consists of three elements: political will and mindset, security and justice, and responsive and effective public institutions. For example, the technical design of the MPRS will be irrelevant unless there is the political, bureaucratic and popular will to implement it. The poor must also be protected from crime, violence, arbitrary state power and injustice. Finally, public institutions must be transparent and held accountable (including through checks and balances) so that they are responsive to the needs of the poor and effective in the implementation of the strategies outlined in this paper. The overall objective of Pillar 4 is therefore to ensure that public institutions and systems protect and benefit the poor. 4.4.1 Political Will and Mindset A recurring theme of the MPRS process and other recent consultations has been the problems caused by a lack of political will and wrong mindset. In particular, a consensus is emerging that poverty reduction cannot be achieved without a change in mindset and strong political will. This recognition is in itself a major step forward, since there has in the past been a culture of denial of such problems. However, the issues of political will and mindset cannot be addressed by bemoaning the decline of work ethics or the dominance of short-term individualism over medium to long-term local and national prosperity. Nor can they be addressed by blaming others for their mindset - 56 A dimba is a small vegetable garden 71 all stakeholders must accept their own responsibilities first. Similarly, the issues cannot be solved by civic education - there are underlying reasons for peoples' behaviour that cannot be addressed by persuasion alone. Instead, the solutions lie in the identification of the root causes of this behaviour, and a concerted effort by all Malawians. 4.4.1.1 Political Will In order for development and poverty reduction to become reality, political leaders from all political parties must depoliticise development, make and accept constructive criticism and be prepared to make hard decisions. A strong message emerging from the MPRS District Consultations was the need to depoliticise development. In particular, all stakeholders should be involved in planning, implementation, monitoring and evaluation of all poverty reducing activities regardless of political affiliation, and political leaders must recognise the need to foster development in all districts and constituencies, regardless of political representation. A recurring theme from the stakeholder consultations was the need to reduce political interference in their sector - for example in public expenditure management, security and justice, credit, taxation and infrastructure. Malawian politics is characterised by patronage and regional relations rather than ideological or policy commitment. There has been an apparent lack of political will on all sides to make and implement the hard prioritisation decisions required to improve the effectiveness of Government activities. In particular, prioritisation requires that certain low priority activities must either be scaled down or stopped altogether. Again, it is not enough to bemoan the lack of commitment of politicians and their short-term populist focus. There are several reasons for the observed behaviour. Firstly, the dominance of patronage politics is a result of historical experience, and the lack of education and short- term focus of the poor. Similarly, the very nature of politics, particularly in democracies, dictates that politicians favour short-term gains and populist acts over medium to long-term reforms, which often have short-term costs, such as unemployment. It must also be accepted that politicians are elected to make decisions - many reform proposals involve reducing substantially the scope for altering policy and therefore undermine their democratically justified powers. However, the political leadership is often not fully briefed on the negative consequences of its actions and the benefits of altemative actions, since those advising the political leadership depend on those leaders for their careers. Finally, donor driven reform programmes are frequently introduced and reformed. Government, therefore, has an incentive to commit to the programme long enough to receive the associated aid, then to abandon it. These reasons must be recognised and addressed. They suggest a two-tier strategy. In the short to medium term, leaders and technicians should ensure that the design of reform programmes includes short-term benefits, so that the reforms have broad-based support. In addition, the timing of reforms should be linked to the electoral cycle, so that unavoidable short-term costs of reform do not have a disproportionate political impact. Reforms should also be flexible and country-owned so that there is broad commitment to their full 72 implementation. The short to medium strategy should also include efforts to change the terms of political discourse away from undeliverable promises and creating expectations of material gain in return for electoral support. Finally, efforts must be made to restore the neutrality and professionalism of the public service. This, in part, will involve change management training for political leaders, focussing on how to interact with their team of civil servants. In addition, it will involve clearly defining the dividing line between Governnent and party political roles, functions and resources. In the long term, the strategy consists of strengthening parliament and civil society so that they are able to play their role of providing checks and balances on the executive. In addition, it is important that the people participate in decision-making processes through decentralisation. Education, both basic and political, is also part of the long-term strategy - only an educated population will be able to hold its leaders to account. Finally, the reduction of donor dependence is crucial if Malawi is to avoid policy reversals. 4.4.1.2 Mindset The issue of mindset arises in the public service, the general population, the private sector and in the donor community. In the public service, the mindset is perceived as one of "business as usual", laziness and personal greed. This is in large part caused by the existing incentive structure in the public service, which is characterised by low basic salaries, lack of performance monitoring, lack of sanctions against poor performance and rewards for good performance, and promotion systems based on regionalism, tribalism, seniority and political affiliation rather than merit. In this context, an elaborate structure of allowances has emerged as effective salary support that is ripe for abuse and distorts management priorities. The solutions to this problem of public service mindset lie partially in the public sector reforms described below. In particular, Government should introduce stronger accountability mechanisms and increase salaries whilst simultaneously removing all but essential allowances from the system. The mindset of the general population is often regarded as one of laziness and dependency on Government. Again, it is important to look at the root causes of this perceived mindset. Firstly, it is due to the lack of economic empowerment of the poor who in many cases lack the knowledge or capacity to seize productive opportunities. This can be addressed through appropriate education and improving access to credit and markets. Secondly, the perceived dependency on Government handouts is based on historical experience that Government and donors will provide for the poor, especially in times of severe hardship. This is further encouraged by the terms of political discourse, which create expectations of material gain in return for political allegiance. The dependency culture can be addressed by ensuring that where possible, safety net activities focus on empowerment, by concerted efforts to change the terms of political discourse, and by disseminating the message that Government has limited resources and cannot do everything. In the private sector, there is a culture of blaming Government for all its troubles - although this may be partially true, it enables the private sector to deny its own problems, such as poor 73 management skills, lack of entrepreneurial spirit and lack of meritocratic recruitment and promotion. In addition, the private sector simultaneously demands tax cuts and exemptions, higher public infrastructural expenditure, lower utility prices and protection from intemational competition. These demands are not consistent. The private sector should, therefore, focus on building its own capacities and professionalism whilst working with Govermnent and appreciating its constraints. There is often an underlying assumption on the part of development partners that because they are benevolent donors, everything they do is in the best interests of Malawians and they are above criticism. However, the reality is that at best, donors do not effectively use their resources for poverty reduction, and at worst, help to exacerbate poverty by undermining Government's planning and priority setting and adding to Malawi's debt burden. Efforts to build Malawian ownership of programmes, employ more local staff, move from loans to grants, and shift from project to programme funding have begun to improve the situation. However, to a large extent, these shifts are limited to rhetoric - ultimately, donor Governments still make the crucial decisions on funding, and pressure is still put on Govemment to conform. The MPRS offers an opportunity to move beyond the rhetoric - donors should buy in to the MPRS and genuinely only fund programmes and projects within it. Ultimately, however, Malawi must learn to live on its own resources and not rely on donors. Another theme related to mindset that has been emphasised throughout the process is that of patriotism. There is consensus that the problems of mindset and political will arise partly because of a lack of patriotism across Malawian society. In particular, it appears that regionalism, tribalism and individualism outweigh considerations of patriotism. In order to reverse this trend, efforts should be made to inculcate positive values and attitudes (including the Malawi First concept) through sports, youth development, community development, information and broadcasting, and cultural events. This will not generally involve additional expenditure or events, but rather involve a shift in the emphasis of existing programmes, events and broadcasts. Secondly, the "Malawi Incorporated" concept should be promoted so as to increase the complementarities between the public and private sectors. 4.4.2 Security and Access to Justice Issues of security57 and justice are closely linked to issues of poverty. Protection from crime, violence, arbitrary state power and injustice is a fundamental part of welfare. Equally importantly, insecurity makes it too risky for the poor to accumulate assets and wealth, particularly in a rural setting, as any assets or wealth are likely to be stolen. This undermines the ability of the poor to generate their own incomes and reduce their own poverty. Crime has a disproportionate impact on the poor since they are the most vulnerable and least able to cope. An accessible, efficient and gender responsive justice system can help to reduce crime by punishing offenders, and creates a level playing field for the poor so that they can protect themselves from those with more economic and political power. Poverty and crime can also be part of a vicious cycle - crime reinforces and increases poverty, and poverty causes crime. For the ultra-poor, the only means for survival may be stealing food 57 Security is defined narrowly as physical security of individuals and assets. 74 or assets from other poor people. It is therefore important that this cycle is broken - by poverty reduction efforts, by exploring non-custodial sentences for minor offences, and by ensuring that prisoners are well treated and taught skills they can use to sustain themselves once released. However, it is not only through the theft of the poor's assets that crime impacts on poverty reduction. Crime and insecurity also have significant indirect impacts on the poor. For example, fraud, corruption and tax evasion reduce the resources available for Government to spend on poverty reducing activities. Insecurity also negatively impacts the growth of foreign investment and tourism, which in turn affects economic growth potential. Security and access to justice in Malawi has a sad history. Between independence in 1964 and 1994, the police was used as a tool of the one party state and was implicated in many human rights abuses. Similarly, the state exercised power arbitrarily, imprisoning opponents and those accused of crimes with little or no recourse to the justice system. Prisons were overcrowded and inhumane. Since 1994, extensive efforts have been made to reverse this situation through police reform programmes, the closure of the most notorious prisons, and the creation of human rights bodies. However, these efforts have not been able to prevent a rising trend in crime, a continuation of political violence and a general decline in security. The police: population ratio stands at 1:1667 against a regional standard of 1:500. As a result, the rate of crime has risen by 6 percent over the past five years, whilst the crime detection rate has not moved above 20 percent. This has been in part blamed on increases in illegal immigration in the country, which has also contributed to a reduction in economic opportunities for Malawian citizens and has undermined the integrity of Malawian passports. Finally, prisons have remained overcrowded and inhumane. The prison population has risen from 4000 in 1995 to 8000 in 2001, and the warder: prisoner ratio has fallen to 1:14, against an intemational standard of 1:5. This situation is partly a result of lack of financial and human resources. There is insufficient police presence, especially in rural areas, and the justice system does not have enough lawyers, judges or courts to process cases effectively and timely. As a result, the number of prisoners has expanded with many individuals on remand, whilst little additional prison infrastructure has been built. Further, a breakdown of discipline and professionalism coupled with low salaries has contributed to an increase in police corruption and the HIV/AIDS epidemic has worsened the shortage of police officers and lawyers. Finally, some stakeholders have expressed concem that the police and the justice system are becoming politicised, both in terms of recruitment, deployment of the police and protection of certain individuals from justice. Currently there is little appreciation amongst the general public of the role the law plays and the potential it offers for empowerment. The law is an essential tool for social and economic development since it seeks to establish order in a society. It does not just relate to crime and the Police, but affects virtually every aspect of life. However, the supremacy of the law is currently undermined by a general failure to respect the rule of law. 75 In response to these problems, an integrated approach to security and justice has been adopted, as reflected in the Malawi Safety, Security and Access to Justice programme (MASSAJ)58 This programme recognises that the various elements are interdependent. For example, although crime reduction has traditionally been seen as the sole responsibility of the police, this approach recognises that the police will have a minimal impact on crime reduction if there is an ineffective justice system. The resulting strategy has three. interlinked objectives: 1. Reduce Crime In terrns of crime reduction, the way forward is on five levels. Firstly, crime control capacity will be increased, particularly by deploying more officers in rural and urban areas and building associated police infrastructure. Secondly, a crime prevention strategy will be reviewed and implemented, to include enhanced community involvement in policing, development of counselling methods at all levels (for example, household, community, police, and prisons), reduction in abuse 6f firearms and the supporting role of the Malawi Defence Forces in crime prevention. Thirdly, co-ordination with and regulation of private sector security firms will be improved through the introduction of a new regulatory framework. The fourth strategy involves efforts to improve the quality of investigation, using modem technology. Finally, there will be further organisational development of the Police, Prisons and Immigration services to ensure that they are transparent and accountable. This will also involve ensuring that mechanisms are in place to deal with emerging human resource issues, including putting in place strategies to prevent the spread of HIV/AIDS, mitigating against the impact of the pandemic, and ensuring that the recruitment system is not biased in terms of gender. Inprove Access to and Delivery of Efficient and Effective Justice The judicial system will work to ensure improved access to and delivery of effective and efficient justice, particularly to the poor and vulnerable. The highest priority will be on increasing the crime prosecution rate by recruiting more prosecutors, lawyers and judicial staff, and by constructing more court-rooms. The independence of the Judiciary must also be strengthened as one of the three branches of Government. The second priority will be to enhance the capacity to provide access by the poor to justice, by increasing the availability of lawyers through the Legal Aid programme, and civic education on their legal rights. The third area of focus will be on safeguarding the rights of victims, suspects and perpetrators of crime, by establishing victim support units, improving prison conditions and encouraging community service for petty offences to relieve pressure on prisons and act as a measure of compensation to the community. Finally, effective rehabilitation programmes for prisoners will be developed so that the cycle of crime and poverty is broken. 2. Ensure Respect for the Rule of Law Respect for the rule of law depends to a large extent on strengthening of the capacity and independence of the Judiciary referred to above. For the rule of law to prevail across Malawian society, a clear example must be set by national leaders and institutions. This requires an independent Judiciary that has power to ensure that those leaders and institutions operate within the Constitution and Laws of the Republic of Malawi. It also requires strong 5S There are, however, strategies outside the MASSAJ strategy document that are proposed here. 76 political will to respect the independence of the Judiciary and abide by Laws and judicial decisions. In addition, this objective will involve strengthening the oversight bodies of security organisations, depoliticising the police and justice systems and civic education on rights and responsibilities under the constitution. A summary of the objectives and associated targets is produced in Table 4.4. 1: Table 4.4.1: Security and Access to Justice Targets Police: Population ratio _ _ 1:1912 1:1200 Crime detection rate 20% 40% Prosecution rate (cases per year, using 150 300 homicide as proxy) l Community service cases 525 5000 Warder: prisoner ratio 1:14 1:9 4.4.3 Ensuring Responsive and Effective Public Institutions The second main element of this pillar consists of strategies that enable Government as a whole to implement its planned strategy, and enable the populace to ensure that the Government keeps its promises and is responsive to the needs of the population. 4.4.3.1 Public Expenditure Management Good public expenditure management (PEM) is increasingly being recognised as one of the prerequisites for economic- growth and development and hence for poverty reduction. Good PEM guarantees that public resources are allocated to priority areas as identified by the MPRS, produces value for money in service delivery, and ensures adherence to aggregate fiscal policies and targets. The central tool for public expenditure management is the budget process, which since 1995 has been based on the principles of the Medium Term Expenditure Framework (MTEF). The MTEF was introduced in order to ensure strategic medium term budgeting, bringing together policy-making, planning and budgeting roles of Government into a rolling three-year horizon. The chosen focus was on the reallocation of resources to priority activities. The role of the budget under the MTEF was to change from a centralised inventory of inputs adjusted on an incremental basis to an output focused approach based on costings of priority activities and projections of available resources. However, there has been dissatisfaction with the implementation of the MTEF. Firstly, the strategic prioritisation process is not influenced by extensive costing of activities. By and large, sector policies remain unaffordable and resources end up being spread too thinly across many activities. Secondly, there have been persistent and significant divergences between approved and actual expenditures, undermining the set priorities. This reveals an apparent lack of appreciation at both the political and technical level of the significance of resource constraints. 77 Finally, Budget execution has been undermined by pressures to finance new and unbudgeted activities at the expense of identified priorities. This extra-budgetary funding causes, major damage through two channels. Firstly, the process of planning and budgeting stops working effectively. The way Government spends money is no longer decided through a process of careful analysis, discussion and selection of priorities, but through the success of each ministry in winning resources through extra-budgetary requests. Secondly, Government loses control of the macroeconomy. Each year Government borrows more money than it can really afford, leading to high interest rates, which destroy the private credit market, and poor control of the money supply, and hence inflation. In such a situation, it is the poor who are hurt more than the rich. Hence, the major challenge of the PEM in the context of the MPRS will be to ensure an effective, medium-term output focussed system by strengthening the MTEF. The MTEF Review of 2000 identified a number of essential characteristics of a successful MTEF59 Government will implement a number of activities aimed at achieving these characteristics, with the overall goal of ensuring effective use of resources for poverty reduction. 1. Improve Budget implementation by Creating Hard Budget Constraints The first strategy under this objective is to strengthen political leadership of the Budget process so that there is broad-based popular and political participation in the formulation and execution of the budget. This would ensure that political intentions are reflected in stated policies, which are translated into the Budget and reality. This will involve improving the structure and presentation of the Budget (ensuring a transparent activity focus), submitting activity-based expenditure reports to Parliament and the Cabinet and strengthening the capacity of political oversight bodies such as the Budget and Finance and Public Accounts Committees of Parliament. Finally, there will be basic public finance training for MPs, Cabinet Ministers and Controlling Officers, emphasising the impact of expenditure decisions on the economy and on poverty. The second strategy is to ensure accountability by improving financial management and expenditure control mechanisms so that fiscal targets are met and unauthorised expenditures are eliminated. In order to achieve this, Government will implement the Integrated Financial Management Information System (IFMIS) and will further strengthen the Credit Ceiling Authority (CCA) system and the Commitment Control System (CCS). To reinforce these measures, the current Finance and Audit Act will be split into a new Finance and Management Control Act with clear and strong public financial management regulations including sanctions against those who break the regulations, and a new Public Audit Act ensuring the independence of the National Audit Office. Finally, Government will strengthen monitoring of expenditure inputs and outputs, and introduce expenditure tracking systems as outlined in Chapter 6. The thiTd strategy will be to strengthen resource forecasting in order to improve the predictability of resource flows to service providers. This will involve a quarterly review of 78 revenue collections and the according re-alignment of expenditures. Also, there will be regular reviews of donor inflows to ensure that they are less erratic. 2. Improve Public Expenditure Planning and Budget Preparation The first strategy under this objective will be to increase the comprehensiveness of the Budget, so that all public expenditures are subject to the same decision-making criteria based on MPRS priorities. In the past, planning has been made difficult by donor-funded projects that have been outside the budget and whose recurrent cost implications have not been planned for. Expenditures by state-owned enterprises and NGOs need also be included to ensure comprehensive planning. Of particular concem is the MASAF project, which needs to be aligned to the MPRS. Secondly, Government will formalise and strengthen Budget scrutiny, in order to ensure that budgets are clearly focussed on affordable outcomes and policies. Under this strategy, the process of Budget formulation will be revised to ensure that Budget submissions are in line with MPRS priorities, and Ministers will report to parliament annually on achievement of outputs of their respective ministries. In addition, there will be a capacity building programme for the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning to improve budget scrutiny and monitoring. 4.4.3.2 Public Sector Reform Public sector reform will ensure efficiency and effectiveness in service delivery, which is crucial for poverty reduction. The public sector constitutes the core competence of the nation for formulating, implementing and monitoring national, sectoral and district/community level policies and actions. Govemment is undertaking public sector management reform (PSMR) as a key part of govemance improvement. The PSMR seeks to develop the capacity of the public sector so that in the long run it can become the national instrument for the attainment of MPRS objectives. Despite some reforms, there is urgent need to strengthen the overall capacity of the public sector to make it an effective instrument for the effective delivery of public goods and services. 1. Improve Public Sector Conditions of Service and Work Ethics The major challenge for the public sector is the need to establish an effective incentive structure that will improve work ethic and productivity. The first strategy to meet this objective is to review and establish realistic and equitable remuneration. Under this strategy, many benefits and allowances will be monetised and integrated into basic salaries, whilst revising and strictly enforcing equitable regulations on allowances. In addition, Government will review the performance related contract scheme, focussing on setting and monitoring financial management performance criteria. After this review, the scheme will either explore the possibility of extending the scheme to some lower grades or enhancing the remuneration package for grades below those covered by the scheme. 59 The characteristics are: political involvement and commitment; effective management and coordination of reforms; predictability in the funding of services; clear, consistent and affordable policies; transparent preparation and presentation of the Budget; comprehensiveness of Budget coverage; and accountability 79 Apart from this, Government will devise and implement a comprehensive wage policy to ensure appropriate and equitable remuneration across Government. This will include ensuring that front-line service delivery agents (for example, nurses and teachers) have remuneration packages more in line with their counterparts in central Government headquarters. In order to complement this strategy, Government will simultaneously improve the enforcement of standards for the Civil Service. This will involve developing and enforcing a code of conduct for public officials, designing and implementing a performance based appraisal system for civil servants, and reviewing the Public Service Act. Finally, Government will introduce a new public pensions system in order to ensure that pensions are linked to the cost of living, and that they have a fixed, predictable budgetary impact. This will include a feasibility study on the introduction of a funded, privately managed pension fund. 2. Review the Structure of the Civil Service The second objective of the public sector reform component is to review the structure of the civil service so that it focuses on poverty reduction. This will involve revisiting the functional review process and redefining Ministry functions and staffing on the basis of MPRS priorities. This restructuring will be implemented in the context of decentralisation, which will also help to ensure that Government resources, both financial and human, are used for poverty reduction. 3. Address Capacity Constraints across Government The third objective is to address capacity constraints across Government. This is related to the issue of increasing the number of qualified personnel in key posts through a training programme of existing public servants, improving secondary and tertiary education, promoting the training of key professional cadres (such as accountants, lawyers, engineers and economists) as well as mitigation against the impact of HIV/AIDS. Furthermore considerable attention will be paid to the development and implementation of management development programmes so as to build capacity to ensure continuous delivery of quality services to the public. 4. Strengthen Public Policy-Making The fourth objective of public sector reform is to strengthen public policy-making at all levels. This will include ensuring broad participation in policy-making, particularly through the annual MPRSP review process described in Chapter 6. In addition, the capacity of central Government Ministries (including the Cabinet Office, the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning and the National Economic Council) will be strengthened, particularly as regards the implications of new policy proposals, including their input on expenditure and poverty. Further, efforts will be made to ensure that the operations of all ministries are governed by clear and transparent policy guidelines. 5. Improve Effectiveness of Parastatals The fifth objective is to improve the efficiency and effectiveness of public enterprises. The performance of both commercial and subvented parastatals has been unsatisfactory, resulting in 80 losses and repeated Govenmment bail-outs, thereby using resources meant for priority programmes. This poor performance is largely caused by management problems aggravated by the lack of an appropriate institutional mechanism to monitor their financial performance and hence to make them accountable to the general public. Govemment will, therefore, undertake parastatal sector reforms aimed at restructuring and commercialising most parastatals to improve their financial performance. This will not only reduce Govermnent bail-outs but also will help to foster private sector development. Special measures will be taken to eliminate inefficiencies by recruiting competent managers. In addition, boards of parastatals will be continuously reviewed to improve govemance and only qualified individuals with relevant experience will be considered. Efforts will also be made to ensure charges by utility companies cover costs, and to accelerate privatisation, particularly in telecommunications, power and water. Finally, the Public Enterprise Reform and Monitoring Unit (PERMU) in the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning will undertake continuous scrutiny of the financial performance of public enterprises and will co-ordinate reform efforts. In terms of specific parastatals, Govermment will continue to implement the action plan for privatisation and commercialisation of ADMARC. Firstly, all ADMARC subsidiaries will be privatised or liquidated. Government will also identify excess marketing and storage infrastructure for valuation and auction. Further, cotton ginning operations will be transferred to a separate company. Govemment will then repeal or amend the ADMARC Act and incorporate ADMARC as a limited liability company in preparation for its privatisation. Finally, the Malawi Development Corporation (MDC), Malawi Telecommunications Limited (MTL) and Air Malawi will all be privatised by offering a strategic partner controlling shareholdings. 4.4.3.3 Fraud and Corruption The MPRS district consultation process showed that corruption is one of the major concerns of the people. High levels of corruption and fraud reduce economic growth by discouraging legitimate business investment, and reduce the public resources available for the delivery of services to the poor. In addition, corruption gives disadvantages to the poor in selling their agricultural produce, and reinforces the unequal distribution of wealth and power in society - only those who can afford to pay a bribe benefit while the poor, the weak and the vulnerable suffer. In order to address issues of corruption, Government established an independent Anti- Corruption Bureau (ACB) to check corruption of any kind and at any level. However, the Bureau's effectiveness is hampered by weak human and financial capacity and systemic institutional weaknesses. As a result, corruption is still growing in most sectors of the economy. 1. Improve the Prevention of Corruption and Fraud The key strategy to achieve this objective is to: reduce the opportunities for corruption and fraud through the creation of a new Malawi Procurement Authority (MPA). This Authority will oversee decentralised procurement across' Government, enforcing clear procurement guidelines so that all public procurement is transparent. In addition, the Anti-Corruption 81 Bureau (ACB) will continue to conduct and encourage anti-corruption campaigns. Finally, the prevention of corruption and fraud is dependent on the improved detection and prosecution of cases so that a clear message is sent to potential offenders. 2. Increase Detection and Prosecution of Corruption and Fraud Cases This will involve reviewing the legal framework and relationships between and among the Anti-Corruption Bureau (ACB), the Director of Public Prosecutions (DPP), the National Audit Office (NAO), the Malawi Revenue Authority (MRA) and the Public Accounts Committee (PAC). In particular, steps will be taken to ensure the independence of the ACB so that political interference is eliminated. In addition, the capacity of these institutions must be built, so as to improve coverage and timing of audit, ensure tax compliance, strengthen investigation and prosecution of corruption and- fraud cases, and ensure speedy processing and prosecution of corruption and fraud cases. In addition, in the context of decentralisation, efforts will be made to ensure that each district has an officer responsible for anti-corruption activities, co- ordinated by the ACB. 4.4.3.4 Decentralisation Decentralisation focuses on the empowerment of the people for effective popular participation and decision making in the development process in their respective areas. In the past, there have been many competing and fragmented development projects, which were largely uncoordinated and managed centrally. This has resulted in substantial duplication of effort and has tended to confuse rather than help the beneficiaries. In order to address these problems, Malawi is undergoing a process of decentralisation, or more specifically, devolution. In the past, a number of line ministries have undergone a process of administrative decentralisation, or deconcentration. However, this form of decentralisation has not yielded the benefits expected because the decision-making power and resources have remained in central Government. Devolution will fundamentally transform the way Government works and interacts with the public, both administratively and politically. Local Governments have been created at district level to perform functions previously performed by central Government, and crucially will be accountable to the population of their district, through the District Assemblies. Since the passing of the Local Government Act in 1998, significant progress has been made in establishing the legal and administrative framework for decentralisation. A number of laws have been revised to ensure consistency, local government elections were held on 21" November, 2001, and Interim Assembly Administrations have been formed. Progress has also been made in establishing the financial framework for decentralisation, including the design of an Inter-Governmental Fiscal Transfer System, the devolution of business licensing and the functioning of the District Development Fund in most assemblies. Finally, there has been progress in preparing for the devolution of functions to the Districts, through the preparation of Sector Devolution Guidelines and the establishment of District and community level planning structures and guidelines. 82 Despite this progress, a number of challenges remain. Firstly, the political will and technical commitment needed to complete the preparation and successful implementation of devolution plans must be sustained. Secondly, capacity building programmes in the Assemblies must be consolidated and accelerated. Also, a sustainable financial base for the Assemblies needs to be developed whilst institutionalising accountability and transparency of resource use at a district level. In addition, there must be continuous consensus building and commitment to the devolution of functions from line ministries to assemblies, whilst building a democratic culture and participatory institutions in the community so that people are empowered to participate fully in local govemance of these functions. Finally, there is need to integrate gender and HIV/AIDS issues into training programmes at a district level and to design programmes that address gender equity with regard to decision making and access to and control of resources. The resulting decentralisation strategy has seven strategies grouped under two objectives: 1. Develop Institutional Capacity for Local Govemance The first strategy under this objective is to develop an appropriate accounting and financial management system. This will involve computerisation of local financial management systems, building the capacity of assembly personnel in financial management, and introducing activity based budgeting in co-ordination with Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning. The second strategy is to establish effective administration systems for local Govemment. This will involve training assemblies and management and strengthening national coordination of decentralisation. 2. Transfer Functions. Resources and Planning to Districts The first strategy under this objective is to establish a local government financing system. This will be attained through fiscal reforms, including the development and implementation, in a phased manner, of a system for Inter-Governmental transfer, the strengthening of revenue collection by assemblies and training of accounting personnel. The second strategy is to devolve functions to the assemblies.' The main activity will be to prepare and implement sector plans in a phased manner. These two main strategies will be backed up by efforts to ensure an effective local development planning and management system integrated in to the national planning system (especially the MPRS), to create a consistent legal and operational framework for decentralisation by reviewing govemment policies, procedures and regulations and review of bye-laws, and to ensure that the public understands and appreciates decentralisation through civic education programmes and coordination with civil society institutions. 4.4.3.5 Democratisation At the heart of effective governance is democracy. By formally recognising that all legal and political authority rests in the people, democratic constitutions empower the people. However, the authority of the constitution cannot be taken for granted, and in particular, elected leaders must continuously respect the supremacy of the people. In practical terms, this principle operates through elections and the existence of checks and balances on the Executive. Empowering the poor through elections ensures that Govemment is held accountable to the 83 people and that the poor have an influence over policy. This is crucial when decisions are to be made on the use of scarce national resources. Checks and balances ensure that Govermnent is held accountable for its actions and remains responsive to the needs of the poor between elections. These checks and balances are both fornal (for example, Parliament and Judiciary) and informal (such as the media and civil society). A multi-party system offers a transparent choice between potential governments and ensures that Parliament offers effective scrutiny of Government activities. Malawi adopted a new democratic constitution in 1995. This followed the transition that ushered in a new era of political liberalisation and democratic governance. The constitution established the institutions of democracy outlined above, enshrines fundamental freedoms and rights and established a number of constitutional watchdogs (for example, Office of the Ombudsman, Malawi Human Rights Commission). Since 1994, Government has moved to consolidate the fumdamental transformation that introduced multiparty democracy. A second general election was held successfully in 1999, followed by Local Government Elections in 2000. Informal checks and balances have strengthened over time, as demonstrated by the emergence of vocal civil society groups. However, there is a perception amongst many observers that progress in the consolidation of democracy has slowed down in recent years and that many elements of the previous regime have been retained or have resurfaced. In particular, there is concem that the principle of a multi-party system is being undermined by the continued dominance of strong patronage networks. Similarly, people have noted that the principle of equitable participation has been weakened by political violence associated with elections and other national functions, the persistence of regionalism, tribalism and nepotism, and the terms of political discourse, which offers direct material gain in return for electoral support. In addition, there are worries that the rights and responsibilities involved in a democratic system have been misunderstood and the rights abused at the cost of responsibilities. There is a perception that infommal checks and balances have been weakened by the inequitable access to the broadcast media, the lack of professionalism of the print media, and the focus of the media on political rather than development issues. Thus, there is need to strengthen the governance system and institutions enshrined in the constitution and informal checks and balances to ensure popular and equitable participation in governance. Much of this cannot be done technically. The problems of democratisation are largely related to the questions of political will and mindset. However, there are specific actions that can be taken to improve the quality of democracy: 1. Strengthen Formal Governance Institutions In terms of formal institutions, there is need to further strengthen electoral processes by improving law enforcement related to elections, strengthening the capacity of the Electoral Commission and through civic education to increase voter turnout and create awareness of the respective roles of Members of Parliament (MPs) and local councillors. Also, civic education through traditional modes of communication can help to improve understanding of democratic 84 rights and responsibilities. Between elections, improved participation of the poor in national policy dialogue can be achieved using the MPRS concept, and the Executive can be made more accountable to Parliament by providing support to parliamentary committees, training MPs and strengthening political parties. 2. Strengthen Infonnal Governance Institutions Informal checks and balances can be strengthened by ensuring the independence and professionalism of the mass media, particularly radio broadcasters, and by increasing the capacity and accountability of civil society organisations such as NGOs. 4.4.3.6 Human Rights Human rights are also an essential part of democracy and are fundamental to poverty reduction. Declarations of human rights are intended to protect the poor from mistreatment by more powerful individuals and organisations such as Government, and guarantee access of the poor to basic services. Prior to 1994, Malawi's human rights record was amongst the poorest in the region, if not the world. Since then its record has improved. The Constitution through Sections 12 and 13 explicitly guarantees the right to basic economic and social rights. In addition, Government has ratified major international human rights instruments as well as key human rights related International Labour Conventions. A number of civil society organisations (including churches and NGOs) play the role of additional watchdogs. However, there is still limited observance and enforcement of human rights provisions. Issues of human rights have not yet taken centre stage because of conflicts between customary practices and the bill of rights, low level of professional skills in human rights organisations and inadequate systems to monitor human rights violations. In addition, the many human rights institutions in Malawi do not have clear roles and do not use their limited resources effectively. 1. Ensure Observance of Human Rights In order to address these problems, the capacities of the many human rights organisations will be developed by Government and its development partners. This will involve clearly defining their roles, hiring and training personnel and increasing funding where the organisations demonstrate their effectiveness. In addition, all public servants, particularly those in enforcement agencies, will be trained in human rights issues. Finally, efforts will be made to raise the awareness of citizens about their constitutional rights and obligations. 4.5Cross Cutting Issues In addition to the above components of the MPRS, there are a number of cross-cutting issues that are crucial and have been mainstreamed in the four Pillars. A detailed discussion of these cross-cutting issues is meant to underline their importance for poverty reduction. 4.5.1 HIV/AIDS Malawi has one of the highest HIV infection rates in the world. HIV infection rapidly penetrated the population during the early 1 980s and the impact of this in terms of illness and death is now being increasingly felt throughout the country. Recent estimates made by the 85 National AIDS Commission indicate infection rates in women attending antenatal clinics varying from 13 percent in rural areas to nearly 25 percent in urban areas60. The combination of the estimated 30 percent risk of mother to child transmission and the current high infection rates of HIV in women of child-bearing age suggest that many children are born HIV infected. The National AIDS Commission estimates the number of infected children at 65,000 in 200161. Conservative estimates put the HIV infection rates in the 15-49 age group at around 15 percent nationally62, and this rate is significantly higher in urban areas (25 percent) than in rural areas (13 percent). The HIV infection in people aged 15-49 is concentrated in younger age groups, particularly women. There is evidence that HIV infection in younger females aged 15-24 is about 4 to 6 times higher than the infection rate in their male counterparts. The NACP further estimates that 46 percent of all new adult infections in 1998 occurred in youth aged 15 to 24. Of these new infections, 60 percent of the new infections in young people occurred in women and 40 percent occurred in men. These already high infection rates seem to continue growing in spite of the apparent high awareness of HIV/AIDS amongst the general population. It should however be noted that most of these HIV infected individuals do not yet know their status. The impact of the HIV/AIDS pandemic threatens all developmental efforts. For example, around 70,000 children become orphans every year, adding to the already large number of orphan, estimated at about 850,00063. Further, there has been a three to four fold increase in tuberculosis (TB) cases, from 5,000 cases in 1985 to about 25,000 cases in 1999. High infection rates also cause increased absenteeism from work due to AIDS related illnesses and funerals, increased medical bills, funeral costs, and payment of premature death benefits. In general, HIV/AIDS will continue to divert labour from productive activities to care provision, thereby increasing food insecurity and threatening the survival of communities. There are clear links between HIV/AIDS and poverty. Poverty is one of the major underlying factors driving the epidemic. People living in the state of serious and worsening poverty are more vulnerable to HIV infection due to a number of factors. Firstly, they have poor access to health care facilities, both because they cannot afford to pay for quality care and that the general free health services are inadequately resourced as a result of the overall national poverty. This poor access to health care means that the people are in poor general health enhancing risk of HIV infection and progression of AIDS. Secondly, in search of income for subsistence and survival, people living in poverty participate in labour migration which results in breakdown of male and female relations, increasing likelihood of multiple sexual partners or casual sexual partners and risk of HIV infection. In addition, women in poverty can be forced to enter into high risk sexual relationship in battering sex for subsistence. This increases their vulnerability to HIV infection. Finally, people who are poor also have poor access to information, including information on HIV/AIDS issues which is critical for them to make informed decisions and choices about their sex and sexuality. 60 National AIDS Commission (2001) National HIVPrevalence Estimates from Sentinel Surveillance Data 61 National AIDS Commission (2001) National HlVPrevalence Estimatesfrom Sentinel Surveillance Data 62 ibid. 63 Ministry of Gender, Youth and Community Services estimates 86 This is compounded by the fact that the poor also have poor access to education services and are generally illiterate to benefit from IEC campaigns. Just as poverty deepens the HIV epidemic, the epidemic also deepens poverty in a serious vicious cycle. The HIV/AIDS affects the productive people in all sectors, who are central to poverty reduction. At national level, national productivity is reduced, and ability to provide social services diminished because of HIV/AIDS. Further, at community and individual level HIV/A1DS diverts household incomes to care, and reduces time spent on productivity thereby worsening poverty. Indeed unless HIV/AIDS is addressed comprehensively, including all the three components of a national response, namely prevention, care and mitigation, all attempts at poverty reduction will not succeed. HIV/AIDS erodes gains made on reducing poverty at a faster rate than any attempt to improve the poverty situation. Therefore, efforts to reduce poverty must go hand in hand with efforts to contain the HIV/AIDS epidemic. These effects of HIV/AIDS on the productive population require improvement of human resources planning and training in all sectors. In addition, it calls for well-designed workplace programmes for prevention and mainstreaming HIV/AIDS as a factor of human resources management in all sectors. Given current levels of poverty and incomes in Malawi, it is highly unlikely that most Malawians will be able to afford any future effective AIDS drug. The only sustainable and effective strategy to combat HIV/AIDS is therefore prevention through behavioural change. However, there is increasing evidence that the response against HIV/AIDS will be more effective where prevention efforts are combined with care and impact mitigation services. To address the HIV/AIDS problem, Government has designed a Comprehensive National Strategic Framework, coordinated by the National AIDS Commission and supported by cooperating partners. The Strategic Framework directs the National HIV/AIDS response in the period 2000-2004. It forms the basis for formulating policies, operational programmes, projects and activities. The Strategic Framework has three main objectives: to reduce the incidence of HIV/AIDS, to improve the quality of life of those infected, and to mitigate against the economic and social impacts. 1. Reduce Incidence of IIIV/AIDS The first strategy is to prevent HIV infection among the youth so as to maintain a youth free of HIV infection. This will involve incorporating HIV/AIDS in school curricula at all levels including teacher-training colleges. Further, adolescent reproductive health services will be increased, including voluntary counselling and testing, management of sexually transmitted infections, encouraging people to abstain from extra-marital sexual activities and increasing condom distribution and education on proper usage. Emphasis will also be put on the promotion of use and distribution of female condoms. Secondly, efforts will be made to improve implementation of HIV prevention activities for the general public including- commercial sex workers. This will involve programmes for controlling mother to child transmission of HIV, voluntary counselling and testing services at all levels, strengthened blood safety, improved condom promotion, distribution and use, and promoting infection prevention practices in health facilities. 87 2. Improve Ouality of Life of those Infected with HIV/AIDS The main strategy under this objective is to improve the management of HIV related conditions, including putting in place guidelines for treating Opportunistic Infections (OI) to' improve care at both hospital and community levels. In addition, it is crucial that Government puts in place clear guidelines and policies for Anti-Retrovirals (ARVs) and negotiate for reduced prices to enable poor people to afford them., Finally, Government will put in place standards and regulations on the management and control of drugs in general to ensure availability and access. 3. Mitigate against the Economic and Social Impacts of HIV/AIDS The mitigation of the impact of HIV/AIDS is essential if poverty reduction is to become a reality. Impact mitigation needs to be integrated into planning at all levels and across all sectors and actors. The first strategy is to provide frameworks that support those who are affected indirectly by the HIV/AIDS pandemic, such as orphans, widows, widowers and households. This will include supporting legislation on inheritance, introducing less labour intensive crops, and providing food to affected households. The second strategy is to work with herbalists and traditional healers. The third strategy is to include a budget line item in all line ministries for workplace programmes and other HIV related interventions. Finally, Government will improve the management and co-ordination of the HIV/AIDS response at national level, focusing on the strengthening of the National AIDS Secretariat and District AIDS committees. 4.5.2 Gender and Empowerment Poverty is experienced differently by men and women. Disparities between women and men are still very pronounced in Malawi and this is one of the major causes of poverty in Malawi. It has to be noted that poverty has a gender dimension due to various social, economic and cultural constraints, options, opportunities and needs. As such, addressing gender disparities is a critical prerequisite for attaining increased economic growth and sustainable human development. Gender and empowerment entails participation of all gender groups' in socio-economic development with full recognition of their responsibilities, roles, rights and relationships, as reflected in the pillars of the MPRS. When women and men have no voice and power to participate in decision making in matters that affect their lives, be it public institutions, civil society organisations, in households and at individual levels, they will not be able to engage in activities that directly or indirectly address both their basic and strategic needs which are essential for reducing their poverty. Empowerment therefore ensures that different gender groups are able to actively participate in development with maximum access and control to related resources and benefits at all phases of development thereby enhancing ownership, equity, efficiency and sustainable outcomes. ' Gender groups are defined by mainly sex, age class ethnicity and all other factors significant to Malawi's development 88 Contrary to the Women in Development (WID) approach, which sidelined men and failed to address the fundamental causes of gender inequality, the Gender and Development (GAD) approach that has been adopted in recent years explicitly deals with gender relationships and includes both women and men in all initiatives. However, insufficient attention has been paid to the implementation of this approach. As a result, Malawi is ranked 163 out of 174 countries in the world, with a Gender Development Index (GDI) of 0.374, implying large disparities between women and men. In addition, Gender Based Violence (GBV)64 has remained a persistent problem, leading to physical, psycho-socio consequences such as drug and alcohol abuse, sexual abuse, unwanted pregnancies, HIV infection and homicide all of which deplete labour productivity, create health care expenses and reduces the capability of men and women to be empowered and to be productive. There is a positive relationship between the level of education and movement of social indicators. In Malawi social indicators reveal low education levels among women, with a 44 percent adult literacy rate for women against 72 percent for men. This affects women's access to gainful employment and other economic resources, and further contributes to the poor infant mortality and morbidity rates, high fertility rate, and high HIV infection rate. This emphasises the need for greater gender equality in education. Full-time female farmers make up 70 percent of the agricultural labour force. However, women continue to have limited access to agricultural extension, training and' inputs. This situation is exacerbated by migration of men to towns and estates to seek paid employment, leaving behind low literate women to manage the farms and families. Consequently, over 71 percent of men are in formal employment compared to only 24 percent of women who are mostly concentrated in lowly paid and female-related traditional jobs such as nursing, teaching, home-craft and secretarial jobs. Currently, very few women are in decision-making positions with almost 91.5 percent of all management positions being occupied by men compared to 8.5 percent females. There are only 17 women Members of Parliament compared to 193 men and only 8 women Cabinet Ministers against 29 men. As such, most of the decisions are male biased and perpetuate gender disparities. Violence increases vulnerability of different gender groups and is one of the major sources of poverty in Malawi. According to a study by GTZ, 90 percent of the cases of violence against women are to do with domestic violence (1999). Reported cases of violence against women increased from a total of 800 cases in 1990 to 8,000 in 1999. On the other hand, there were 20 male cases reported in 1990 and 5 1 0 in 1999. Gender based violence can be defined as any unlawful act perpetrated by a person against another person on the basis of their sex that causes suffering on the part of the victim and 64 Gender Based Violence can be defined as any unlawful act perpetrated by a person against another on the basis of their sex that causes suffering on the part of the victim and results in among others, physical, psychological and emotional harm or economic depnvation. 89 results in physical, psychological, emotional or economic harm or deprivation. The prevalence of all forms of Gender Based Violence can lead to physical, psycho-socio consequences such as drug and alcohol abuse, sexual abuse, unwanted pregnancies, HIV/AIDS and homicide all of which deplete labour productivity, create health care expenses and therefore reduces the capability of men and women to lift themselves out of poverty. In view of the current situation the national challenge on gender and empowerment is to create an enabling enviromnent where, women, men, girls and boys are empowered to actively participate in, and benefit from socio-economic activities that meet their basic and strategic needs for poverty reduction and sustainable development. The following objectives will therefore be implemented in the context of the National Gender Policy and its mainstreaming: 1. Strengthen the Institutional Capacity for Implementation of the National Gender Policy Attaining this objective will involve strengthened sectoral linkages between the Ministry of Gender and other stakeholders, by establishing gender focal points in stakeholder institutions and developing tools for gender monitoring and evaluation. Once these linkages have been made, Goverrnent will build capacity for gender responsiveness, planning, implementation, monitoring and evaluation by training the gender focal points on gender analysis and establishing a gender documentation centre. 2. Engender Budgets Government will develop a policy on engendering sectoral Budgets and will build capacity for poverty focussed and gender responsive plans and budgets. 3. Promote Gender Sensitive Formal and Informal Legal Environment Firstly, Government will identify and documerit negative traditional practices, beliefs and values and disseminate information on the effects of these. Secondly, Government will facilitate a review of laws and legislation that impact negatively on women and will ensure their enforcement. This will include supporting legislation on domestic violence and wills and inheritance and promoting economic empowerment programmes for women. 4. Eradicate Gender Based Violence Government will prevent occurrence of gender based violence (GBV) and further establish and strengthen institutional capacity of all relevant stakeholders. This will involve expanding victim support units in police stations (see Pillar 4), expanding community based action groups, formation of victim support shelters, sensitising the public on monitoring and reporting on GBV, and incorporating gender based violence issues into the curriculum of training institutions. Secondly; Government and other stakeholders will provide counselling services for victims and perpetrators of gender based violence and set up a data bank on GBV in all documentation centres. 5. Enhance Women's Participation in Leadership and Decision Making Processes This will involve strengthening linkages, improving women's access to resources and benefits for their participation in leadership positions including training programmes in leadership 90 communication and assertiveness for women and girls, and monitoring and evaluation of placement of women in those positions. 4.5.3 Environment Poverty and the environment are linked in a complex, cyclical relationship. High population growth, high illiteracy and poverty lead to environmental degradation by forcing the poor to rely on natural resources for survival (especially as regards fuel wood energy, agriculture, water, fisheries and wildlife). As a result, Malawi's natural resources are threatened by the demand placed on them by the poor leading to unsustainable levels of usage. It has been estimated that the discounted, economic loss in 1994 associated with the loss in soils, forestry, fisheries and water was US$240 million65 (See Pillar 1). It is estimated that 70-80 % of Malawi's biomass is burned in any one season from the burning of crop residue,.bush and forest fires, use of fire for hunting and clearing grazing pasture, from wanton pyromania and for fuel wood. This burning is leading to catchment damage and erosion and there is now evidence that aquatic chemical changes in Lake Malawi can be attributed to the atmospheric fall out from fires. The high degradation rates of the environment in turn exacerbate poverty, since the poor depend on the environment and natural resources for survival. In particular, soil erosion and degradation, deforestation, depletion and degradation of water resources, threats to fish resources and bio-diversity and the degradation of the human habitat that are caused by poverty themselves reduce the ability of the poor to survive and thrive. There is therefore urgent need to reverse this downward spiral. In recent years, a number of measures have been taken to break this cyclical relationship. The National Environmental Action Plan (NEAP) of 1994 led to the National Environmental Policy of 1996. In order to implement the Policy, the Environment Support Programme was introduced in 1996 to be an umbrella investment framework for the integration of environmental concerns into national planning. This includes the production of bottom-up State of the Environment Reports and inclusion of mitigation actions in Environmental Action Plans at national, district and area levels. As a result of this effort, awareness of environmental issues has increased, and the concept of Community Based Natural Resource Management (CBNRM) has become established. CBNRM empowers communities to have joint control over their own natural resources, discouraging individual overuse and reducing damage from external actors. However, despite all these efforts environmental degradation continues apace. The resulting environment strategy has three basic objectives: 1. Strenathen Legal and Institutional Framework This will involve mainstreaming environmental management into the local government administration, in particular the new assembly councillors. CBNRM will be encouraged 65 Government of Malawi (1994) National EnvironmentalAction Plan, Ministry of Natural Resources and Environmental Affairs 91 through district by-laws, accelerating the devolution of responsibility for environment monitoring and planning to the local level, and ensuring that the new Land Policy is consistent with CBNRM by providing, in return for a licence fee, the private sector and communities time-bound, conditional access rights to resources. The concept shall be to treat environment as economic goods and to see that they are properly valuated. Further strategies dealing with natural resources are described under Pillar 1. 2. Develop Alternative Livelihood Strategies The development of alternative livelihood strategies will ensure that the poor can survive and thrive without damaging the environment. This will be achieved by establishing a supportive technology development and transfer mechanism so that the poor change their behaviour, particularly with regards to use of fuel wood for energy and the wanton burning of biomass. Issues of energy are discussed under Pillar I as part of rural infrastructure. In addition, Govermnent will promote trade and markets in non-consumptive, value-added products from natural resources so that the poor can benefit more by making and selling products from natural resources than by consuming (especially burning) those resources. Similarly, fiscal incentives such as tax breaks or small grants will be made available to communities (and private investors) so that they can practice sustainable resource management and income generation. Finally, under-developed resources such as deep-water fisheries and forest plantations will be commercialised. Strategies in these areas are described under Pillar I as part of natural resources. 3. Create Mass Environmental Awareness This will be achieved through integrating environmental issues into the school curriculum, providing training for communities in environmental management, initiating mass media campaigns based on prioritised environmental concerns (for example, anti-bush fire campaigns) and the dissemination of information to communities and political leaders. This will include the distribution of information on sustainable resource use with the targeted input distribution. 4.5.4 Science and Technology Science and technology (S&T) contributes significantly to socio-economic development. This notwithstanding, Malawi is characterised by low application of science and technology in all sectors of the economy largely arising from poor integration of science and technology in socio-economic development planning. The low content of science and technology in national economic development programmes is a barrier to economic growth leading to the high levels of poverty among Malawians. This situation is exacerbated by weaknesses in the national system for science and technology manifested in a weak framework for planning decision- making indicated by the lack of national guidance with respect to science and technology, inadequate attention to programmes that promote, coordinate and finance science and technology indicated by insufficient funding for S&T programmes and poor science culture, weak research and development institutions indicated by low quantity and quality of S&T human resources and poor institutions' infrastructure, and low quality scientific and technology services indicated by lack of and ineffective S&T information services. 92 Government has taken measures to address these constraints with the development of a new S&T policy as the starting point. The policy attaches great importance to the assurance of political commitment to S&T, integration of S&T into national development planning, maximization of productivity through the application of S&T, promotion of international cooperation, creation of a conducive policy environment for the advancement of science and technology, investment in and retention of S&T human resources, promotion of sustainable socio-economic development; and promotion of S&T culture among civil society. In view of the current situation the objectives of S&T are to improve the capacity and capability of the national system for science and technology; intensify promotion and transfer of technologies to key livelihood systems; increase investment in research and development in Science Engineering and Technology (SET); enhance the role of science and technology in the expansion, diversification and sustainability of national production systems; improve and increase productivity of national production systems; and encourage value addition to raw materials and indigenous knowledge systems. The achievement of these objectives will create the enabling enviromnent for S&T to contribute to poverty reduction in a sustainable manner. The following strategies will be implemented in the context of the National Science and Technology Policy and its mainstreaming. 1. Strengthen National Science and Technology Capacity Government will build the capacity of the national system for science and technology. This will be achieved by improving the framework for planning and decision-making through the adoption of a new National Science and Technology,Policy and the establishment of a National Commission for Science and Technology Act. In addition, Government will, in partnership with the private sector, improve the promotion, coordination and financing of science and technology; and outline a comprehensive human resources development and management programme for science and technology. 2. Intensify the Application of Science and Technologv Key measures to be taken will be to improve sustainable productivity in the major livelihood systems of agriculture and livestock production, enterprises and fisheries by implementing national technology transfer programmes in these livelihood systems. Research in science and technology will be diversified through multidisciplinary research institutions including the Malawi Industrial Research and Technology Development Centre (MIRTDC) which is the only industrial research institute. Intensified application of science and technology will be facilitated by the creation of a science and technology culture in order to encourage appreciation of S&T in Malawian society. 3. Enhance Utilisation of Information and Communication Technologies Enhanced utilization of information and communication technologies (ICTs) will improve mass communication, information retrieval; and facilitate the establishment of national and sectoral databases thereby enhancing access to the technologies whose use will reduce poverty. Government will provide a favourable ICT regulatory and operating environment by developing a national ICT policy and related action plans which will integrate ICT utilization and development into Malawi's social economic and poverty reduction strategies. In particular, the Government will enhance provision of infrastructure for enhanced 93 communication and information exchange, invest in ICT for education, vocational training, health, agriculture, financial management, governance, and development of ICT skills. 94 Chapter 5 - Macroeconomic and Expenditure Framework 5.11ntroduction Macroeconomic stability66 and efficient utilisation of public resources are essential conditions for economic growth and poverty reduction. Macroeconomic stability requires prudence in fiscal management and tight monetary policies. This demands that Govemment spends within its means, and therefore that expenditure requirements are balanced with resources available in a stable macroeconomic environment. This chapter outlines the macroeconomic and expenditure framework within which the MPRS will operate. It is crucial to the implementation of the strategy as it balances the expenditure requirements based on costing of the poverty reducing activities outlined in Chapter 4 with resources available. 5.2Macro-economic Framework 5.2.1 Economic Growth and Poverty Reduction Economic growth is a necessary but not sufficient condition for sustainable poverty reduction, as without growth, there will be no rise in incomes, and no additional resources available for Government to spend on poverty reducing activities. However, for growth to be effective in reducing poverty, it must involve and benefit the poor (pro-poor or "quality" growth). In the past, both the quantity and quality of growth in Malawi have been poor. The quantity of growth has been erratic and low on average. The distribution of growth has been highly skewed towards the wealthy. This is clearly demonstrated by a World Bank study in 1998, which demonstrated that assuming past pattems and distributions of growth, the economy would have to grow at 5.3 percent a year just to maintain constant levels of poverty. This compares unfavourably to the average of 4.5 percent growth in the period 1994-2000. However, the study also shows that changes in the distribution of growth would have a far greater impact on poverty reduction. The challenge for Malawi is therefore to improve both the quantity and quality of growth. 5.2.2 Macroeconomic Stability and Poverty As described in Chapter 3, although there have been periods of relative stability, the economy has generally been characterised by high inflation rates, an unstable nominal exchange rate, and high interest rates. This was caused by poor fiscal and monetary policies, adverse weather conditions and other external factors. For Malawi to attain macroeconomic stability, Government will adopt policies which will improve public expenditure management and reduce government borrowing; control money supply and inflation; maintain a stable and competitive exchange rate; and improve the trade regime and investment environment. 5.2.2.1 Fiscal Imbalances and Poverty High fiscal deficits have necessitated excessive Government borrowing, which in turn has led to high interest rates and the crowding-out of the private sector. In addition, excessive 66 Macroeconomic stability involves low and stable inflation, low interest rates and a stable exchange rate 95 borrowing has resulted into increased interest payments thus reducing the net resource envelope available to fund government activities, of which some are crucial to poverty reduction. Excessive Government borrowing from the Reserve Bank of Malawi (RBM), commercial banks and private individuals has contributed significantly to macroeconomic instability. A number of measures to improve fiscal discipline are outlined under Public Expenditure Management in Pillar 4 of the strategy outlined in Chapter 4. In particular this involves improving the budget implementation by creating hard budget constraints (including parastatals), through strengthening political oversight of the budget, improving financial management and expenditure control mechanisms (including stronger sanctions against those that break financial management regulations), and the strengthening of resource forecasting. When planning and implementing the Budget, deficit levels should be dictated by inflation targets. Also, there is need for stronger monitoring and enforcement procedures against overspending in parastatals. This will be achieved through the Public Enterprise Reform and Monitoring Unit (PERMU) and relevant Parliamentary committees, to be govemed by a single, all encompassing Act covering parastatals. In addition to these fiscal reforms, a number of institutional reform activities will be undertaken. Firstly, efforts will be made to increase the independence of the Reserve Bank of Malawi from government. The current legal framework of the Reserve Bank of Malawi is weak, particularly as regards the institutional framework policy independence. This will be achieved through a review of the Reserve Bank Act, including revising the appointment procedures for the Governor and Deputy Governor, and the current stipulated agreement on borrowing from the RBM. The current legal framework governing public finances is weak in terms of autonomy of the office of the Secretary to the Treasury. Government will, therefore, revise the legal framework governing the roles of the Secretary to the Treasury and the Budget Director to strengthen their control of Budget implementation and their ability to meet deficit and therefore inflation targets. Finally, the powers of the Public Appointments Committee will be strengthened in order to ensure transparency in appointments of senior officials in government and parastatals, including the Reserve Bank of Malawi. 5.2.2.2 Monetary Imbalances and Poverty The ultimate objective of monetary policy is the pursuit of low and non-volatile inflation. This is premised on the fact that high rates of inflation discourage saving and investment, and thereby damage an economy's potential for economic growth. Inflation is also a regressive and arbitrary tax that places a heavy burden on the poor as it erodes their purchasing power. Volatile inflation also introduces uncertainty in the business envirorment and thereby adversely affecting growth prospects and poverty. 96 High interest rates, which largely reflect fiscal imbalances, have an adverse effect on economy, particularly on the poor. Changes in interest rates affect real demand in an economy that in turn affects output and prices. High interest rates act as a disincentive to investment and therefore retard economic growth. High rates also reduce the affordability of credit, especially for the poor. As a result the second objective of monetary policy is to reduce interest rates by improving the efficiency of the financial system. This will be achieved through the review of the regulatory and institutional frameworks and encouragement of new financial institutions and instruments to increase competition. 5.2.2.3 External Sector Imbalances and Poverty An exchange rate can have an adverse effect on the poor. A depreciating exchange rate erodes incomes and purchasing power of the poor through inflationary effects. Thus Government will strive to attain a stable Malawi Kwacha that is competitive with other foreign currencies, and will avoid the excessive appreciation of the Real Effective Exchange Rate (REER)67. The strategic polices which will assist in containing exchange rate pressures include: sound fiscal and monetary polices, low and stable inflation, increased competition in the foreign exchange market and lastly improved market information. These strategies can be achieved through encouraging the development of an interbank foreign exchange market, broadening the participation of the private sector in exchange rate management and a review of the regulatory framework which promotes the growth in non-traditional exports. The country's deteriorating balance of payments position has been the major cause of exchange rate instability. This has emanated from the unfavourable terms of trade and shortfall in donor inflows. The country has in the past heavily relied on traditional exports like tobacco that have not generated the desired level of foreign exchange. There should therefore be a deliberate policy to encourage the diversification of exports. 5.2.3 Resource Envelope and Macroeconomic Projections The gross resource envelope envisaged for the MPRSP during the fiscal year 2002/03 will be K41.3 billion. This is based on several assumptions, as shown in Table 5.1 below. For the 2003/04 and 2004/05 fiscal years, the projected resource envelopes are K44.0 billion and K50.3 billion respectively (see Table 5.2 below). The declining trend in the inflation rate is premised on the envisaged tight fiscal and monetary polices. Table 5. 1: Macroeconomic Assum tions for Resource Envelo e nd ato20 0' _ 31__ '_ __ __ _ GDP growth (%) 2.7 3 4.5 5.2 Inflation (%) 27.6 11.5 5 4.4 Exchange rate 70 71 74 78 % of donor pledges 80 90 90 honoured I I I_ _ 67The Real Effective Exchange Rate is a measure of a country's competitiveness, calculated from the nominal exchange rate adjusted by the inflation differential between the foreign and domestic prices 97 These projected resource envelopes are deliberately based on realistic assumptions. These do not mean that the Malawian economy should not aim for higher levels of growth. Instead, they are realistic estimates based on past experience and technical knowledge. If the MPRSP is fully implemented and there are no negative external shocks, growth and revenues may be higher than projected. In that case, the additional activities that currently fall outside the resource envelope will be implemented. Table 5.2: Gross Resource Envelope Total Revenue and Grants 41,528.44 44,390.80 49,920.92 Domestic Revenue 27,370.60 31,360.60 34,326.80 of which non-tax revenue 2,686.70 3,090.10 3,402.70 of which tax revenue 24,683.90 28,270.50 30,924.10 Grants 14,157.84 13,030.20 15,594.12 of which project 3,010.24 3,099.51 3,656.25 of which BoP 8,423.20 6,200.82 7,312.41 of which HIPC 2,724.40 3,729.87 4,625.46 Overall financing 194.26 - 410.12 356.70 Foreign financing (net) 3,124.38 1,028.18 1,694.75 Borrowing 7,872.88 5,857.38 7,188.75 of which project 5,010.88 3,424.23 3,769.29 of which BoP 2,862.00 2,433.15 3,419.46 Repayment 4,748.50 4,829.20 5,494.00 Domestic financing (net) 3,320.64 - 1,443.30 - 1,346.05 Gross resource envelope 41,332.181 43,975.68 50,269.62 The resource envelope (total resources available) is derived from projections of total domestic taxation and non-tax revenue, in addition to conservative estimates of donor inflows. At present, the latter are based on aggregate donor pledges. In order to make the projections more realistic, Government will undertake a survey to ensure that the resource envelope is comprehensively derived so that it can accurately be compared to the costings. In particular, Government will undertake a survey of existing donor and NGO programmes and projects. As the 2000 PER clearly demonstrated, a large proportion of these programmes and projects do not currently appear in the Budget and are not factored into the projection of the resource envelope. Where ongoing projects involve activities identical or similar to MPRS activities, the financial resources funding the MPRS activities within those projects will be counted as part of the resource envelope. However, projects and parts of projects that do not involve activities contained in the MPRS will be noted and the associated resources excluded from the MPRS resource envelope. Government will continue to welcome the implementation of the project until any review phase or the end of the project life-span. However, any new projects and any mid-term project reviews will be required to take into account the MPRS so that ultimately all programmes and projects involve only MPRS activities. 98 5.3 Costings Framework The costings framework consists of three main elements: statutory, statehood and MPRS activities.- Where possible, this costing has been done on the basis of targets and unit costs, so that planned expenditure reflects a realistic estimate of the resources needed to meet national objectives. These three elements are combined to compare total costings to gross. resource availability. There are also a number of large-scale infrastructure development projects that will not be financed by Government but by private sector and international investors. These are discussed in section 5.4. The activities included in the costings framework are those MPRS activities that are implemented and financed by or through Government. Whilst the overall thrust of the MPRS applies to Malawi as a whole, and strategies to meet its objectives should be implemented by all stakeholders, the costings are limited to Government. 5.3.1 Statutory and Statehood Expenditure In addition to the MPRS activities, two other types of activities must be considered before total costs can be compared to the resource envelope. Firstly, projected expenditures on statutory activities must be allocated a share of the resource envelope. These statutory activities are by definition ones that have to be fumded and cannot be scaled down, and include items such as interest payments and pensions and gratuities. Secondly, statehood activities must be included. These activities do not directly reduce poverty, but are essential in any country as the basic activities that enable the functioning of state by promoting and protecting national integrity, security and leadership. Examples include ensuring external security, supporting the President, conducting national public events and gathering and disseminating information to the nation. As with any other set of activities and resource allocation, the use of these resources must be as efficient and effective as possible, and there must be transparency and accountability. Equally importantly, these activities must have a hard Budget constraint - expenditure must not exceed the resource allocation in the Budget, which will be guided by the costings outlined in this Chapter. Any additional expenditure on these activities translates into reduced allocations to the MPRS activities. The MPRS is in part intended to clearly demonstrate these trade-offs, for example by demonstrating the impact that additional unplanned statehood expenditure has in terms of reduced expenditure on health and education activities. Table 5.3 below presents a summary of statutory and statehood costings. Statutory costs will total around K10 billion in 2002/3, decreasing to K9 billion in 2003/04, and K8.5 billion in 2004/05. This decline is due to falling domestic interest payments as fiscal discipline is improved. The cost of Statehood activities will total K2.4 billion in 2002/03 , reducing to K2.3 billion in 2003/4 and K2.2 billion in 2004/5 These costs are based on the assumption that funding of Statehood activities should be maintained at their actual 2001/2 levels, with administrative and allocative efficiency improving so as to strengthen implementation. The gradual decline is due to the rationalisation of international co-operation and representation activities. 99 Table 5.3 Statutory and Statehood Expenditure K million Total costings 41,332.2 43,975.7 50,269.6 Statutory 9,984.7 9,023.7 8,516.2 Statehood expenditures 2,358.8 2,276.6 2,236.6 As prent-total costing Statutory 24.2% 20.5% 16.9% Statehood 5.7% 5.2% 4.4% 5.3.2 MPRS Costings The MPRS gives a costed and prioritised description of the set of activities that together have been agreed to maximise poverty reduction given the available resources68. These activities were designed in large part through a bottom-up approach - the needs of the poor were defined first and strategies designed by the Thematic Working Groups (TWGs) to help them reduce their poverty. These activities were then costed by the TWGs with assistance from the Technical Committee, where possible on the basis of unit costs applied to relevant targets69. The targets and costs were adjusted to temove duplications and ensure accuracy and realism, especially as regards implementation capacity70. Once all activities were costed, the total cost of the MPRS activities was derived. The next stage was to reduce most administrative and overhead costs to an estimate of their actual 2001/2 levels for all three years. This was intended to free up resources for the delivery of pro-poor services and to stimulate improvements in administrative efficiency in Govermnent. This will partly be achieved by reducing expenditure on certain low-priority expenditure line items across Government, such as internal and external travel. Finally, lower priority activities were rephased or rescaled so that the total costings were in line with the total resources available. A summary of the resulting costings are shown in Tables 5.4 and 5.6, and a more detailed break-down by objective is produced in annex 271. These summaries of costings are not budgetary allocations, but an indication of how much certain groups of activities will cost. The total numbers for each Pillar were derived from costing the constituent activities and then rephasing where possible as a result of capacity and resource constraints, rather than starting with a total allocation and splitting it between activities or ministries. Further, the costings refer to activities rather than to institutions. In the MPRS, the focus is on defining the strategies that will enable Malawi to meet its poverty reduction goals and objectives within resource constraints. The MPRS regards financial resources in aggregate only and does not define how the various activities will be financed - by 68 Thus any changes to activities to be implemented cannot be justified merely by demonstration of an impact on poverty reduction - it must be demonstrated that the new activity is more poverty reducing than the activity removed. 69 For example, in education the total teacher wage bill was derived by multiplying the required number of teachers in a particular year by the cost of paying each teacher in that year. For further details of costing assumptions, please refer to the full matrices and costing models available from the Technical Committee. 70 For example, although it may be desirable to have a pupil: teacher ratio of 50, this is not possible given the capacity of teacher training institutions and the supply of educated potential recruits. 7' The break-down of costings by strategy and activity is contained in the separate Action Plan matrix that is available as a technical document. 100 tax revenue, donor budgetary support, donor project support or debt relief. The MPRS also does not distinguish between the recurrent and development budgets as currently operational in Malawi72. The detailed definition of responsible and funding institutions and financing arrangements is the role of the MTEF/Budget process which will translate the MPRS into a detailed funding plan (see Chapter 6). However, there are important similarities with the Budget that will help to ensure that the MPRS is translated into the Budget. Firstly, the MPRS costing is comprehensive, so that it covers all Government and development partner activities73. Similarly, the resource envelope contains all sources of funding, be they domestic taxation, donor grants, loans or HIPC resources. Secondly, the MPRS matrix outlines the responsible institution(s) for each activity, so that the costing of the activities can be easily translated into institutional allocations for comparison with the Budget. Table 5.4: MPRS Costing Summary by Pillar Total Costings 41,332.2 43,975.7 50,269.6 Total MPRSP 28,988.7 32,675.3 39,516.9 Pillar 1 8,013.6 9,421.1 9,331.9 Pillar 2 13,860.4 15,356.6 17,188.3 Pillar 3 1,209.0 1,824.8 2,308.0 Pillar 4 4,040.1 3,783.7 3,952.8 Cross-Cutting 1,667.4 2,010.6 2,465.8 Implementation, Monitoring and Evaluation 198.2 278.6 270.2 Activities to be identified - 4,000.0 As percent total costings Total MPRSP 70.1% 74.3% 78.6% Pillar 1 19.4% 21.4% 18.6% Pillar 2 33.5% 34.9% 34.2% Pillar 3 2.9% 4.1% 4.6% Pillar 4 9.8% 8.6% 7.9% Cross-Cutting 4.0% 4.6%1 4.9% Implementation, Monitoring and Evaluation 0.5% 0.6% 0.5% Activities to be identified . - 8.0% 72 Although the MPRS costings are divided into recurrent and investment costs, this split does not correspond to the Recurrent/Development Budget distinction, which in reality is a split between programmes and donor funded projects, both of which have elements of recurrent and investment costs. 3 Apart from Statehood, Statutory and some large-scale infrastructure development projects, which are treated explicitly elsewhere in this section. 101 5.4 Large scale Infrastructure Development As mentioned above, a number of large-scale infrastructure development projects have been treated separately, since they will not be funded by Government resources74. Whist these projects are not priorities for poverty reduction, they are important for the development of Malawi. They will not be financed by Govemment, which will concentrate its resources on the MPRS activities. However, Govenmment will actively seek private sector and international investors to finance the projects, where necessary using innovative financing arrangements (such as Build-Operate-Transfer). In certain areas (such as core road construction), certain international development partners with particular expertise will be invited to invest These projects fall under three main categories: telecommunications, electrification and roads. The main telecommunications project covered here is the expansion of rural telecommunications (expected to be largely funded by the private sector). In the electricity sector, the projects include the interconnection of electricity grid systems with Mozambique, the rehabilitation of existing transmission and distribution power systems and the expansion of main grid electricity supply capacity. Finally, in roads, the projects include the reconstruction and expansion of the core road network, including the Karonga-Chitipa road. More details of these can be found in Annex 3. Finally, Table 5.6 presents a more detailed summary of costings within each pillar, at the goal and sub-goal level (reflecting the headings and sub-headings in Chapter 4). The costings reflect the MPRS priorities, with K7.3 billion allocated to basic education, K4.6 billion to essential healthcare, Kl.6 billion to safety nets, and K2.6 billion to supporting agricultural livelihoods in 2002/03. The further details of the costing and resulting expenditure allocations can be found in annex 2 and the separate costing data source, together with a breakdown of costs into recurrent and development expenditures. Table 5.5 Detailed Costings by Goal and Sub-Goal (Millions of Malawi Kwacha) . , , :._ , ~~~~ ~ ~ ~~~~~~ ~ ~~~~~~~~~~~~~I . .*.,, - ., - Pillar I - Sustainable Pro-Poor Growth 8,013.56 9,421.09 9,331.92 Goal 1.1 - Sources of pro-poor growth 3,064.36 3,787.16 3,575.28 Sub goal 1.1.1 - Increasing agricultural incomes 1,771.43 2,393.54 2,264.85 Sub-Goal 1.1.2 - Natural Resources 773.24 837.95 840.55 Sub-Goal 1.1.3 - Develop MSMEs 196.00 248.00 175.00 Sub-Goal 1.1.4 - Manufacturing and Agro-Processing 78.01 81.00 89.00 Sub-Goal 1.1.5 - Tourism 192.50 187.50 172.50 Sub-Goal 1.1.6-Small Scale Mining . 53.18 39.18 33.38 Goal 1.2 - Creating an Enabling Environment for Growth 4,949.20 5,633.92 5,756.64 Sub-Goal 1.2.1 - Macroeconomic Stability Sub-Goal 1.2.2 - Credit and Micro-Finance 25.91 59.50 19.04 Sub-Goal 1.2.3 - Rural Infrastructure 2,428.04 2,793.10 3,019.61 Sub-Goal 1.2.4 - Other Enabling Infrastructure 1,785.57 1,805.57 1,856.07 Sub-Goal 1.2.5 - Domestic and external trade 57.85 264.15 77.20 74 A large number of infrastructure projects remain in the MPRS, notably rural feeder roads and rural electrification 102 Sub-Goal 1.2.6 - Taxation 651.83 711.60 784.72 Pillar 2: Human Capital Development 13,860.36 15,356.57 17,188.26 Goal 2.1 Improving quality and access to education 8,710.19 9,623.25 10,782.64 Sub-goal 2.1.1 - Basic education 6,015.84 6,592.47 7,454.75 Sub-Goal 2.1.2 - Secondary School education 2,144.35 2,480.78 2,777.89 Sub-Goal 2.1.3 - Higher Education 550.00 550.00 550.00 Goal 2.2 Better Technical, Vocational and Entrepreneurial Education and Training 468.25 488.51 567.46 Goal 2.3 Improved Health Status 4,568.55 5,104.74 5,663.16 Sub-Goal 2.3.1 - Preventative Healthcare75 - - Sub-Goal 2.3.2 - Essential Healthcare 4,184.48 4,720.67 5,279.09 Sub-Goal 2.3.3 - Tertiary Healthcare 384.07 384.07 384.07 Goal 2.4 - To prevent and control Protein, Energy, Malnutrition and micronutrient deficiencies 113.36 140.06 175.00 Pillar 3 - Improving the Quality of Life for the Most Vulnerable 1,209.02 1,824.78 2,307.96 Goal 3.1 - Safety Nets 1,127.30 1,734.89 2,209.08 Sub-Goal 3. 1.1 - Productivity Enhancing Interventions 838.71 1,187.97 1,319.03 Sub-Goal 3.1.2 - Welfare Support Interventions 288.59 546.92 890.04 Goal 3.2 - Improving disaster management 81.72 89.89 98.88 Pillar 4 - Governance 4,040.15 3,783.72 3,952.77 Goal 4.1 - Political Will and Mindset - - Goal 4.2 - Improved safety, security and access to justice 2,001.19 2,225.60 2,413.90 Goal 4.3 - Ensuring responsive and effective public institutions 2,038.95 1,558.12 1,538.86 Sub-goal 4.3.1 - Improved Public Expenditure Management 411.77 335.82 302.38 Sub-Goal 4.3.2 - Public Service Reform 140.30 122.42 122.78 Sub-Goal 4.3.3 - Corruption and Fraud 111.21 118.46 126.51 Sub-Goal 4.3.4 - Decentralisation 811.18 420.69 425.49 Sub-Goal 4.3.5 - Democratisation 441.34 441.34 441.34 Sub-Goal 4.3.6 - Human Rights 123.15 119.38 120.36 5 - Cross cutting 1,667.41 2,010.57 2,465.78 Goal 5.1 Ensure national response to the HIV/AIDS pandemic 663.70 676.45 668.08 Goal 5.2 Reduce gender inequalities 68.02 74.32 60.51 Goal 5.3 Ensure environmental sustainability 294.00 334.00 372.00 Goal 5.4 - Create a Science and Technology driven economy 641.70 925.80 1,365.20 Monitoring and Evaluation of MPRS 198.16 278.59 270.20 Goal: Ensure implementation of the MPRS 198.16 278.59 270.20 75 The costs of preventative healthcare are included under Nutrition (Pillar 2), Water and Sanitation (Pillar 3), Education (Pillar 2) and the Essential Healthcare Package. 103 Chapter 6 - MPRS Implementation, Monitoring and Evaluation The implementation of the MPRS will involve all stakeholders. However, the responsibility for overall co-ordination of implementation will rest with Government. Furthermore, many of the specific activities within the strategy will be the responsibility of Government, at both national and local levels. In implementing activities within the MPRS, Government will use existing national mechanisms as well as emerging district level mechanisms. At a national level, Government MPRS activities will be implemented through the line Ministries and the Budget, co-ordinated by central Government Ministries - in particular, the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning, the Office of the President and Cabinet, and the National Economic Council. However, in the context of the on-going decentralisation process, the activities in the MPRS will increasingly be implemented at a district level, through the District Assemblies rather than central Government. Furthermore, a number of MPRS activities will be implemented by Non-Governmental Organisations (NGOs) and communities, where capacities exist. To be implemented, the MPRS must at all levels be translated into the Medium Term Expenditure Framework (MTEF) and the Budget, and that Budget itself must be fully implemented. Thus, the issues of Public Expenditure Management and strengthening the MTEF covered under the fourth pillar of Govemance, Political Will and Mindset are central to implementation. In general, the MPRS will not lead to new and parallel systems for implementation, monitoring and evaluation. Instead, the emphasis will be on building capacity for and strengthening existing systems, including the inclusion of a broader range of stakeholders, including civil society and the media. Crucial to the success of the MPRS is the need to implement only the MPRS. The Poverty Reduction Strategy outlined in this document has been designed to be comprehensive and has been costed so that it is in line with Government's overall resource envelope. It leflects a consensus on Malawi's priorities that has been built through a highly participatory process and reference to ongoing programmes. Hence, the omission of an activity from the MPRS does not mean it has been forgotten - it means that it is not considered a priority at this stage and therefore should not be undertaken in current implementation period until it becomes a priority, if at all. In terms of ongoing donor-funded projects, implementation of the MPRS will involve a transition phase. During this phase, ongoing donor funded projects will continue, with adjustments made where possible to ensure that the projects are in line with MPRS activities. However, all new projects will have to fit into the MPRS by implementing the activities as outlined in Chapter 4 and the matrix of action. Where unforeseen circumstances arise (for example, natural disasters), it may be necessary to implement alternative activities. In such circumstances, Government will be transparent in clearly explaining the need for the altemative activities and more importantly, will explain 105 which MPRS activities will be scaled down or dropped to create space for the alternative activity in terms of financial and human capacity. Where there are changes in priorities or less urgent circumstances, Government will continue implementing the MPRS activities until the next annual review process and subsequent Budget, when changes will be made on the basis of consensus. A number of measures have been taken to ensure that this MPRS is implementation-friendly. Firstly, the MPRS has focussed on prioritisation. In the past, Government has failed to implement its plans and strategies because the activities were not prioritised in line with the limited availability of resources. Government has tried to do too much with too little resources and achieving too little because the resources were spread thinly across activities. Prioritisation involves making hard decisions on which activities to implement, and which to scale down or drop altogether. This is done in the context of comparing Government's available resources with the costs of implementing the priority activities, so that the strategy is realistic. Secondly, the MPRS process focused on designing an action plan for the strategy (annex 2). The action plan and the activities within it will form the basis for the Budget. Implementation has been further assured by the emphasis on ownership and participation. The MPRS preparation process was designed to ensure that consensus on the strategy was built across Malawian society. Government, political parties, civil society, donors and private sector representatives, as stakeholders, were engaged in the process on an equal footing. This was done to achieve broad ownership, generate commitment to the implementation of the MPRS and spark interest in the monitoring of the strategy. In addition to the measures already outlined, there are two critical components of the implementation strategy: a thorough monitoring and evaluation system and high-level coordination supported by technical level committees. 6.1 The MPRS in Context In the past, there has been no coherent institutional and management structure for the planning76 of public expenditure and policy. Rather, there have been a variety of loosely coordinated donor-driven reform initiatives that have been half-implemented by a number of central government bodies and line ministries with little overall management or co-ordination. Initiatives such as the MTEF, SIPs and SWAps and Vision 2020 have been seen as separate, add-on activities rather than part of a coherent whole. The implementation of the MPRS and the success of the other initiatives depend on the definition and coordination of an integrated and coherent planning and budgeting system coordinated by the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning, with the MPRS and the Budget at the core. This system must be clearly understood by all key stakeholders. The structure of the system is explained in Figure 6.1 below. 76 "Planning" does not just refer to development Budget activities as traditionally understood, but equally to the recurrent and development budget. Planning is understood here to mean the prioritisation of scarce resources (both financial and Government capacity) so as to achieve national objectives. 106 As demonstrated in Figure 6. 1, the MPRS has its roots in country's overall vision as defined in Vision 2020. In effect, the MPRS translates the aspirations captured in Vision 2020 into more practically defined and prioritised strategies. These strategies are then further clarified into more detailed sector-specific plans either in the form of Sector Investrnent Programmes (SIPs) or Sector Wide Approaches (SWAps) or cross-sectoral programmes or projects, such as the National Safety Nets Strategy and the Environmental Support Programme (ESP). SIPs exist in education (the PIF) and health (the N-HP). Others are being developed in agriculture (MASIP) and security and justice (MASSAJ). The MPRS, by. giving a national overview of poverty reduction efforts, acts as a starting point for the sedtor-specific plans. It is essential that these plans are consistent with the MPRS - the plans should contain only strategies that are contained in the MPRS. In practice, the relationship between the MPRS and the plans will go both ways - existing and future plans have and will be used in formulating the MPRS and revisions made to the plans incorporated into the MPRS during the annual review where agreed. Figure 6.1: Public Policy and Planning Framework The ne e in te pVis icor c p s to be -tr e io t - ye a stral MMASSAJ Ter E Fm o (MT sectorn an a b b t miisris wit th fis yea of th M F rersetn th annual budet Ate reision madeduringthebudgethearings se iivial MTF a th naioa MTE an Buge as prsete toalaent Thi process of de3igntoa annual budget reflects Government's priorities and the opinions of those cMonitoring and The next stage in the process is fo. the sector specific plans to be translated into three- year sectoral Medium Term Expenditure Frameworks (MTEFs) on an annual basis by the line ministries, with the first year of the MTEF 77 represenfing the annual budget. After revisions made during the budget hearings, these individual MTEFs and budgets are consolidated into the nafional MTEF and Budget as presented to Parliament. This process of defining national and sectoral strategies and translating these strategies into budgets will help to ensure that the annual budget reflects Govermnent's priorities and the opinions of those consulted throughout the process. 77 The MTEF is a way of doing the Budget process, focussing on activities and outputs rather than inputs. 107 In order to-ensure that the MPRS and ultimately the MTEF/Budget continue to reflect the best poverty reduction strategies, the public expenditure policy and planning framework described in figure 6.1 also includes two annual review vehicles - the MPRS review and the Public Expenditure Review. The PER will look in detail at expenditure trends and impacts in certain sectors, and will act as an input into the annual MFRS review, which will review progress with the whole MPRS and will revise the MPRS accordingly. A major challenge to Government is to integrate decentralisation into this framework. Many districts are in the process of developing District Development Plans (DDPs), which are the district equiialent of the MPRSP. As with the Sectoral Plans, these DDPs will have a two-way relationship with the MPRSP - they will use the national strategy as a starting point and will be consistent with it, but subsequent reviews of the MPRSP will use input from the District planning process. The relationship will be further clarified during the first annual review process after consultations between the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning, the Ministry of Local Government and the District Assemblies. 6.2 MPRS and the Budget At the core of the public expenditure planning and management system is the relationship between the MPRS and the Budget. The system is designed to ensure that the Budget is a detailed cost estimate of the implementation of MPRS priorities, rather than just a list of inputs by Govermment institutions. The budget preparation and scrutiny stage of the budget process is central to the success of this system. The Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning will ensure that line Ministries use the MPRS when preparing their Budgets. More importantly, the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning will scrutinise proposed budgets, in line with MPRS-based budget guidelines, during Budget hearings. Budget submissions that include activities outside the MPRS or exclude activities inside the MPRS will be rejected. Equally importantly, the implementation of the MPRS depends on the implementation of the MPRS-based Budget. As the 2000 Public Expenditure Review and the MTEF Review clearly demonstrate, the implementation of the Budget is beset with problems. It is therefore crucial that the measures outlined in the Public Expenditure Management section of the fourth pillar are fully implemented. In particular, Parliamenit will play a crucial role in ensuring the implementation of the Budget by providing on-going scrutiny of Budget implementation through its various committees, especially the Budget and Finance Committee and the Public Accounts Committee. 6.3 Monitoring and Evaluation Monitoring and evaluation of the MPRS implementation is key to the achievement of the goals of the MPRS. Monitoring of the implementation is to assist in the annual review of the MPRS and its comprehensive review after three years. Starting immediately after its launch, MPRS implementation will be monitored using various indicators provided in the action plan for each component of the MPRS. The action plan has outlined a variety of monitoring indicators 108 ranging from input and output to outcome and impact indicators. Brief definitions of these various levels of indicators are presented in Box 6.1 below: Table 6.1: Monitoring Indicators -The various lev,els -ofmonijtoring''i'dicators to be used duningMPRS implemenitation are described beloa with anie-xampIleforieachifromfthe educationsector:. -. ,; ;..'' -In'put -7The use-of resr .' th- resources,can be'financial. s-bGornieta1 ~qJrese .Th. qs_yJ-a 1 i ., - .= . .(expenlditure),.laibour .(peiet)andi) , ital -(e.quipment). ce focusll largely be -on flnancial-monitoring- 6tian1,act1iityfbasis.e g. resoures spent onprimr .; : edu~cation .' .Oa'utputs -The;quant1ty an,dqual ioic es, and;transfers providedby, Goernnient. using the:inputs: Th,lese are.generally directil.-linked to the efficient and effective4use' . ''..'':.of inputs: e g pupil. oerroosu per pupil . -' ; - i: 3.- Outcomes- anqu oityo ec of the seNrices pro'ided torthe i : .recipient-of Governrn-entsL r§i 'cie MeNs` are 'related to input and output performance' but may be affected byZothetrf.tor-1e g'enrolment ratios.- exahuination pass rates; .4. Impact - The efect on,vvelfare indicators,tliKe income,,conssurpnt pon.ovrtverty headcouni etc. These r`avybe aaf,cted byinputs outputs and outcomes;'but itha'. significant,time lag and: are aldo7iffected by miany external;factors .g.-e literac ra'e poverth headcoun - In some cases, agents monitoring process indicators (inputs and outputs) are different from those monitoring outcome and impact indicators. Likewise, in some cases one data collection method is used for more than one set of indicators, while in others, several methods are used to collect data for the monitoring of one type of indicators. The need for coordination, therefore, cannot be overemphasised. Monitoring and evaluation of these various levels of indicators will take place both at national, district and local levels. District level monitoring and evaluation systems are currently being designed and will be reviewed and fully integrated after the first annual review process. For example, Government will introduce, on a trial basis, schemes to enable communities to monitor Government performance on all four levels. The rest of this chapter focuses on the national monitoring and evaluation system. The formal monitoring and evaluation system for the MPRS will be based on existing systems, and strengthened by including a broader range of stakeholders. and refining the mechanisms used. Apart from this formal intemal system, the MPRS will encourage the development of other external systems, for example through civil society institutions. To this end, Government will ensure that monitoring information is widely disseminated, and that Government systems are transparent. In particular, civil society and the media will be used to disseminate information to all stakeholders. 6.3.1 Monitoring Inputs and Outputs The first level of monitoring and evaluation will be the monitoring of Government inputs. This will be based on activities, as detailed in the MPRS action plan and translated into the budget. Expenditure tracking will start at the source of funding (the Ministry of Finance and Economic 109 Planning) and then move all the way to the actual expenditure point. Expenditure tracking:will involve identifying specific pro-poor programmes or line items in the Budget. These will be tagged and expenditure on those will be closely monitored. Controlling officers are'to be responsible for providing data on actual expenditure and output levels, on monthly basis during the request of monthly funding. This will be done through the existing reporting system, which will be adjusted to take into account the demands of MPRS reporting. The Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning will thus be responsible for collecting, aggregating and disseminating this information. The input and output monitoring is to have in-built incentive mechanisms. The Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning will continue to withhold funding for Ministries and Departments that fail to submit satisfactory monthly activity-based reports on input and output indicators. To strengthen monitoring, beneficiary communities, with the help of civil society, are to be involved in the expenditure tracking and output monitoring on the basis of the budget and funded activities. Civil society organisations should, therefore, mount capacity building exercise for communities to get involved in input and output monitoring at the local level. Further, the existing government ministries' monitoring and evaluation systems will be enhanced to allow for consistent and quality tracking of expenditures. Finally, the use of resources (in terms of inputs and outputs) will be monitored and evaluated using the annual Public Expenditure Review (PER). Annual PERs will focus on a different group of sectors each year, analysing expenditure trends, effectiveness and efficiency and making recommendations to be incorporated in the annual MPRS Review and the formulation of the Budget. The PER will be conducted by officials from the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning together with officials from relevant line ministries and appropriate civil society organisations. 6.3.2 Monitoring Poverty Outcomes and Impacts Outcome and impact monitoring is to be assisted by the use of various sources of data. At a national level, a number of indicators are crucial for the monitoring of poverty outcome and impact indicators. The indicators and their sources of data are presented in Table 6.1 below. The monitoring of outcome and impact indicators is to rely on complementary and supplementary sources of data. Administrative records and management information systems are critical sources for facility-based goods and services. These will feed into a district data bank to be managed by a professional statistician. Other more frequent data collection activities are to include Core Welfare Indicator Questionnaire (CWIQ) surveys, crop estimates, and food price surveys. The CWIQ, for example, is an integrated service survey that is to be conducted annually, which allows quick and cost effective measurement of outcomes. A more comprehensive Integrated Household Survey (IHS) is to be conducted once in five years. This is also true for Demographic and Health Surveys (DHS). The Qualitative Impact Monitoring 110 Survey (QUIM) is a participatory beneficiary service and poverty assessments tool. It is to complement the quantitative surveys and is to be implemented once in three years. Table 6.2 Ke Monitoring Indicators Overall Consumption Impact IHS, QUIM GDP per capita Impact National income statistics Nutrition status Outcome DHS, IHS, administrative Morbidity records, QUIM Mortality Life expectancy Composite Welfare Index Outcome, Output and All sources Impact Agriculture Food production Outcome Crop estimates, NSSA, PPI Cash crop production Animal production Health Access to potable water Output DHS, IHS, QUIM Access to sanitation Access to health services Total fertility rate Outcome IHS HIV infection Administrative records Education Literacy rate Impact IHS Net enrolment Outcome Administrative data and IHS Education attainments A critical factor in outcome and impact monitoring is the quality of the administrative and management information systems. The current administrative data collection systems and their higher-level management information systems are plagued by quality problems. One such quality problem is the coverage of the data. In many cases, the forms used leave out important information: Another problem is the lack of capacity and incentives for those filling 'in the administrative records. As a first step, administrative data collection systems are to be assessed for their use in monitoring of the MPRS. Forms are to be redesigned to suit the requirements of MPRS. Secondly, adequate staffing with requisite qualifications and incentives are to be deployed in key sectors like education, health and agriculture. The assessment of these systems and quality control of all other monitoring activities are to be done under the framework of the MPRS monitoring system institutional set-up. 6.4 Coordination of Implementation, Monitoring and Evaluation The Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning will co-ordinate the implementation of the MPRS where public expenditure is involved. In particular, a MPRS Unit will be created in the Ministry to drive the implementation of the MPRS across Government, and ensure that essential complementary reforms to the MTEF and Budget are made. In addition, the Unit will co-ordinate the Annual PER and work with the Secretariat of the MPRS Monitoring System to co-ordinate the annual MPRS Review process. Finally, the Unit will work with the Budget Division to coordinate all activities dealing with monitoring of inputs and output indicators. In particular, the Unit, in co-operation with the Budget Division will draw up guidelines for input and output monitoring by Ministries, District Assemblies and controlling officers. The Unit will also be responsible for workshops and meetings for all units and personnel involved in inputs and output monitoring, including civil society representatives, at most once in three months. The National Statistical Office (NSO) is to be responsible for coordinating all outcome and impact monitoring activities across all sectors. Apart from conducting surveys or assisting in the design of surveys by other agents, NSO is to collect all district level data produced by the statistical units of district assemblies, and all sectoral data collected by the line ministries. These data from the districts and sectors need not be only outcome or impact indicators. NSO is to act as a databank for all indictor data from the district level. NSO is also to conduct preliminary analysis (aggregation, etc) of district-level data. The National Economic Council is to be responsible for producing poverty-related analysis based on data from NSO, the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning's input and output monitoring as well as the financial information system and other ad hoc surveys conducted within and outside the MPRS Monitoring System. Thus NEC is to be a focal point for finished and polished poverty statistics and analysis. NEC is to disseminate poverty statistics and information through media like internet, newsletters and newspaper articles and columns. All MPRS monitoring and evaluation activities will be co-ordinated through a MPRS Monitoring System based on the existing Poverty Monitoring System (PMS). This MPRS Monitoring System will have four levels. Firstly, the Cabinet Committee on the Economy will assume overall control of the system. Beneath this will be a policy-making MPRS Monitoring Committee, consisting of Principal Secretaries from relevant Ministries, including Finance and Economic Planning, National Economic Council, Agriculture and Irrigation, Education, Science and Technology, Health and Population, Transport and Public Works, Local Government, Gender, Youth and Community Services, Natural Resources and Environmental Affairs, the Accountant General, and the National Statistical Office. The MPRS Monitoring Committee will be served by a Technical Working Committee (TWC) that will co-ordinate monitoring and evaluation efforts and provide analysis. The membership of the TWC will include officials from the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning (the MPRS Unit and Budget Division), the National Economic Council (Poverty Analysis Section), National Statistical Office, other key ministries (in line with the membership of the MPRS Monitoring Committee), representatives from District Assemblies (one representative from the Malawi Association of Local Government Authorities - MALGA - and one representative of district assemblies from each region), representatives of relevant parliamentary committees, members of the donor community, researchers (including Centre for Social Research, Centre for Education Research and Training and the Agricultural Policy Research Unit), civil society groups (including CONGOMA, and one group for each Pillar), and a media representative. The Poverty Analysis Unit of the National Economic Council will serve as the Secretariat for this TWC. On the Government side, the TWC will be served by the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning (MPRS Unit and Budget Division), which will provide information on input and output monitoring, the National Statistical Office, which will conduct surveys and maintain a databank drawn from line Ministries and District Assemblies, and the National Economic Council (Poverty Analysis Section), which will provide poverty analysis, particularly on outcome and impact indicators. This institutional framework is summarised in Figure 6.2 below: 112 Apartifrom this framewor, Mall Cabintg Committee wl b Budgetas Gove ' s tGovf, donors, civil society, researchers,o t i l r ensung implemen , m rmedian district representatives, e 5 C cMinistry of Finance National Economic Councilton adoEaluatiO All ditrctasInputs and Outputs Poverty analysis, ournsmespnb for d colctin and qualifed an traied pesonne.To ansuedat qupalitys nfriyfo litit,teMR Monitorig Commitee, thrugh the Secretaria,is omuttann n oinainfrsafo Apart from this framework, all Cabinet Committees will be encouraged to monitor the performance of applicable sectors within the MPRSP. Likewise, various Parliamentary Committees wild have to monitor expea s ndfrom thd performance using any of the MPRS committees or other mechanisms as they see fit. Since'the MPRSP will be translated into the Budget as Government's statement of strategy, these committees will play a crucial role in ensuring implementation, monitoring and evaluation. 6.5 Capacity Needs for Implementafion, Monitoring and Evaluation All district s alsot d re to establish statistics units responsible for data collection and processing, database management as well as report production. These units are to be staffed by qualified and trained personnel. To ensure data quality uniformity from all districts, the MPRS Monitoring Committee, through the Secretariat, is to mount training and orientation for staff of statistics units. Under the same framework, district staff will receive training from NSO on quantitative data collection (including sampling), entry, analysis and reporting, from NEC on qualitative data collection and analysis, and from the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning (including the Accountant General's Department) on input and output monitoring. Of necessity, N-EC is to develop capacity to conduct poverty analysis. The MPRS Monitoring Committee is also to draw on expertise of its members, mainly the research centres. NSO is to designate or recruit specific officers to liaise with district level stattistics units. The officers should be designated particular districts for maximum attention. Trhese officers are to be in a stand alone secfion responsible for collecting district reports, maintaining districts database and producing databank abstracts for dissemination or use by NEC. 113 The Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning will continue to build capacity to monitor monthly allocations and expenditures vis-a-vis the MPRS within the Budget Division. In addition, the MPRS Unit will work closely with the Budget Division and NEC's monitoring and evaluation division. Again, line ministries are to have strong Monitoring and Evaluation sections to be collecting input (including expenditure) and output indicators and producing poverty monitoring reports. These should have formal and working links with the Ministry of Finance and Economic Planning and NEC. Community participation in monitoring and evaluation of the MPRS is crucial for its success. Community Development Committees are to have their capacity built to assist them monitor community level activities. Civil society organisations are to be used in this process. The civil society organisations are to be free to join in the monitoring of the process independently as well as through the MPRS Monitoring System. 6.6 Review process As already indicated, the monitoring and evaluation system will assist in the review of MPRS. The MPRS is meant to be a living document. It is to be revised on a rolling basis to adapt to circumstances and reflect changing priorities. This is to be achieved through a two-tiered review process. Firstly, there is to be an annual review in January/February of each year, following the annual PER process. The first stage of this review is to analyse progress in implementing the MPRS and achieving the targets within it. This is to be done by the MPRS Monitoring Committee on the basis of the results of the input and output monitoring and evaluation. This document, together with a review of emerging issues, will be widely circulated. The second stage of the review is to take the form of stakeholders' workshops. These workshops will have two interlinked roles: Firstly, as a national accountability forum for implementers to be held accountable to all stakeholders. In this way, the workshops will supplement the on-going work of the Technical Working Committee on MPRS monitoring by allowing all stakeholders to participate in the assessment of the implementation of the MPRS. The second role will be to revise the MPRS in line with lessons leamed from implementation, monitoring and evaluation, and to take into account emerging priorities where a consensus emerges during the discussions. The third stage of the review is to involve the dissemination of a report on the review process and the revised MPRS. The annual reviews will be Malawi's central policy review process. As such, other existing or planned national level processes will either be integrated into the MPRSP review process or will be cancelled. For example, sectoral review processes will provide input into the overall review process. The annual reviews will be complemented by a comprehensive review process every three years. This comprehensive review is to be more like the initial MPRS Preparation Process, involving District Workshops, Thematic Working Groups and a complete redesigning of the MPRS. 114 Final DRAFT Malawi Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper Annexes April 2002 ii Contents Annex I - Actio n Plan .................................1 Pillar 1 - Sustainable Pro-Poor Growth .................................1 Pillar 2 - Human Capital Development .............................. 16 Pillar 3 - Improving the Quality of Life of the Most Vulnerable ...................... 27 Pillar 4 - Governance .............................. 29 Cross-Cutting Issues .............................. 35 Macroeconomic Stability .............................. 41 Monitoring and Evaluation of MPRS .............................. 42 Annex 2 - Summary of Costings by Objective ....................................... 45 Annex 3 - Large Scale Infrastructure Development .49 Annex 4 - Selected Monitoring Indicators and Targets .51 Annex 5 - Glossary .............................. 53 Annex 6a - Summary of the MPRS Process .57 Management Framework for the MPRS ....................................... 61 MPRS Preparation Organisational Structure ....................................... 63 Annex 6b - Issues.Highlighted in District Consultations .65 Annex 6c - Participants in the MPRS Process .68 Membership of the Technical Committee ....................................... 68 Membership of the Draffing Team ....................................... 68 Membership of Thematic Working Groups ....................................... 68 Institutions involved in consultations ....................................... 74 Annex 7 - Bibliography .78 iii Iv Annex 1 - Action Plan Pillar 1 - Sustainable Pro-Poor Growth Goal 4.1.1 - Sources of Pro-Poor Growth Sub goal 4.1.1.1 - Increasing agricultural incomes and ensuring food security Expand and Increase access to credit for Increase supply and reduce cost of MOCI strengthen access to farmers', especially the poor sustainable credit - see section on agricultural inputs Microcredit Encourage the formation SACCOs and MOAI village banks based on farmers' co- operatives and associations (see below under extension} Provide financial support to capitalisation cf MRFC SACCOs and Village 8anks Promote the use of organic Train extension workers in use of organic MOAI fertilisers fertilisers, such as manure Link farmers to markets which demand MOAI organic produce Distribute free Inputs to the See Pillar 3 - Targeted Input Programme MSRPAP most vulnerable Improve agricultural Strengthen extenslon delivery Recruit and train new extension workers in MOAI production thrmugh services, including the order to replace those dying and retiring improved research implementation of the new and extension Extension Policy services Retrain existing extension workers in: a)new MOAI - production technologies b)new extension NRC/Bunda policy c)HIV/AIDS prevention and mitigatlon d)gender issues d)business mranagement e)marketing I participatory extension processes g)formation of farmers associations and co-operatives and h) marketing knowledge (e.g. grading, processing) i) soil ferlility and conservation (including use of organic fertiliser - manure) Purchase and run 'yellow vans to MOAJ disseminate information Clearly explain and discuss new Extension MOAI Policy will all stakeholders Improve coordination with other extension MOAI providers (NGOs, private sector) Ensure demand-driven extension through MOAI formnation of fanmers' co-operatives and associatons (see below) InsUtutionalise participatory extenslon MOAI processes. Develop and disseminate producUon guide MOAI NGOs manuals wih new technological messages Decentralise provision of extension services MOAI Decentralisati on Secretariat Facilitate formation and Train extension workers in formaton of MOAI NGOs development of product- farmers clubs and associations specific farmer co-operatives and associations Provide training for clubs and associations MOAI TEVETA; in business and association management NGOs - MEDI, NASFAM Provide clubs and associations with links to MOAi NGOs markets, especially local agro-processing VISNore r - -d MN Encourage associations to go into contract MOAI NGOs farming Mobillse associabions to participate in MOAI NGOs HIV/AIDS prevention and mitigation Enhance production and Revise and carry out crop estimates MOAI dissemination of approprate weather and production statistics Gather and disseminate weather statstics MOTPWorks - MD Investigate potential use of Information and MOAI Communication Technologies to improve information dissemination Conduct demand driven Conduct participatory problem diagnosis with MOAI NGOs research to develop easily extension workers, farmers and other adoptable technologies stakeholders Develop varieibes with desirable qualities MOAI Private sector demanded by the market Ensure participation of extension workers MOAt and farmers' representatives in research planning meetings Conduct research into the control of MOAI Private sector contagious diseases in crops and animals Develop drought and disease resistant MOAI Private sector varieities of crops and livestock Monitoring and evaluating research projects MOAI through improvement of quality of regulatory and technical services Improve access to Develop an effective Create and strengthen central market MOAI MEPC, domestc and marketing information system intelligence unit and intensify market Private sector intemational markets research associations Create dissemination centres in districts and MOAI easily accessed areas (schools, health centres, agricultural offices) Encourage development of commodity MOAI NGOs, private specific information networks sector Investigate potential use of informaton and MOAI Private sector, Communication Technologies to improve NGOs market information dissemination Strengthen regional and intemational MOAI MIPA, MEPC, linkages through trade fairs and other MCCCI buyer/seller meetings Ensure smaliholder Train extension workers to impart marketng MOAI Private sector, production is market-friendly knowledge e.g. grading, storage and gross NGOs margin analysis Ensure extension workers, farmers clubs etc. MOAI Private sector, updated on market trends (market bulletins NGOs etc.) Instill a business culture in Encourage formation of associatons and co- MOAI NGOs smaliholder farmers operatives (see above) Encourage individual farmers and MOAI NGOs associatons to conduct market research Promote development of local Provide support and information to micro, MOCI agro-storage and processing small and medium scale enterprises in rural industry areas - see section on MSMEs below Train local entrepreneurs in agri-business DEMAT development 2 Promote small scale Encourage development of Intensify awareness-campaigns for MOAI NGOs irrigation schemes small scale irrigation ublisation, production and installabon of and drainage schemes based on manual treadle pumps. lifting devices, and river diversions Encourage river diversion irrigation MOAI NGOs Distribute treadle pumps on loan to MOAI smaliholder farmers through revolving funds Support development of Facilitate installation and utiisation of new MOAI NGOs, private Small scale irrigation motorised pump based schemes, sector schemes based on motorised pumps and sprinklers. Support development of Facilitate installation and maintenance of MOAI NGOs, private Small scale sprinkler new sprinkler irrgation schemes sector irirgation schemes Promote the rehabilitation Facilitate the rehabilitation of the selected MOWD MOAI and construction of dams (advisory),NG community small earth dams Os, private sector Enhance Capacity building Review past training programmes and MOAI for Irrigation Development conduct training to be in line with field requirements. Review staff requirements In line with the MOAI unit review. Train more frontline staff on cost effective irrigation methodologies. Conduct irirgation adaptive research in MOAI dambos Assess impact and performance of different MOAI irrigation methodologies. Test new technologies. Encourage production Ensure continued benefits Implement Designated Buyers' System for MOAI Estates, of specific crops from traditional estate crops tobacco Designated Buyers, TCC, TAMA, Auction Floors, TEAM Review marketing and trading arrangements MOAI Estates, for tobacco Designated Buyers. TCC, TAMA, Auction Floors, TEAM Increase competitiveness and poverty MOAI Estates reduction impact of traditional estate crops (tea, sugar, coffee), for example through smaliholder outgrower schemes Encourage establishment of Encourage formation of associations MOAI NGOs viable production units for specifically producing these crops according selected key export crops to comparative advantage (see farmers (cotton, cassava, soya associations and co-operatives above) beans) Conduct crop-specific speclalised training for MOAI - asscolations etc. targeting selected winner NRC/Bunda cash crops linked to MSMEs MOAI Provide start-up material for key crops MOAI NGOs, private (seeds etc.) sector Encourage production Provide training for livestock Facilitate formulation of livestock producing MOAI NGOs, credit of livestock producers in groups farmers' clubs and encourage these groups insttutions to access credit and gperate revolving funds 3 Train specialised extension workers in MOAi - specific animal husbandry practices, disease NRC/Bunda control and production of low cost high quality feeds Provide disease prevention Revive dipping services with increased cost MOAI and control services sharing element Provide veterinary services on cost sharing MOAI basis Encourage the development of and monitor MOAI Private sector - provision of private sector breeding and animal health services Strengthen surveillance of animal diseases MOAI Monitor the import of poultry products MOAI MOCI Reduce land shortage Support implementaiion of Present Land Bill to Parliament MOL MOJ and degradation the draft Land Policy Guarantee security of customary land tenure MOL Address the problem of small Facilitate land redistribution and resettlement MOL landholding sizes and of 14000 hectares of land to 3500 landlessness households on a voluntary basis Promote family planning to reduce pressure MOHP on land (see section on population in Pillar 2) Increase productivity of small landholdings MOAI Private sector, (see extension and farm mechanisation NGOs above) Train extension workers in soil conservation MOAI and fertility techniques Promote low cost soil fertility conservation MOAI and improvement techniques (including use of organic manure) Promote off-farm employment (see section MOCI on MSMEs) Promote and expand Increase access to draught Improve animal health programmes (see MOAI farm mechanisation animals and animal drawn livestock section above) implements Improve access to credit (see above) MOCI Support extension campaigns and MOAI behavioural change communication Train local artisans in production of animal MOAI Private sector, drawn implements NGOs Create microfinanced producion units for MOAI Private sector, animal drawn implements NGOs Create special production units for donkeys MOAI Private sector, for sell on loan NGOs Increase access to tractors Provide tractors for hire to farmers' groups MOAI Private sector, for hire with consolidated land NGOs Investigate reasons for failure of past MOAI schemes and design altematives Reduce weaknesses Rationalise structure and Redefine core functions of the MOAI in line MOAI, MASIP in the institutional and activities of Ministry of with MPRSP priority activities policy framework Agriculture and Irrigation in line with MPRSP priority activities Privatise/contract out non-core functions MOAI Private sector, NGOs Implement cost sharing/recovery where MOAI possible Conduct civic education through extension MOAI - workers on role of MOAI as one of many MASIP service providers 4 Strengthen sector-wide policy Strenghten co-ordinabon with farmers MOAI - Private sector, making and co-ordination groups, NGOs, traders and other MASIP NGOs stakeholders. Continue development of Malawi Agriculture MOAI - Private sector, Sector Investment Programme (MASIP) as MASIP NGOs framewori for co-ordination between stakeholders Prepare for decentralisation Develop agriculture sector decentralisatUon MOAI DC of agriculture sector action plan. Increase gender Undertake Extension Conduct gender and HIV/AIDS awareness MOAI balance, prevent and strategic campaigns for meetings leading to Participatory Rapid mitigate HIV/AIDS In mainstreaming Gender and Appraisals (PRA). the agricultural sector HIV/AIDS for both communiies 2 - day meetings for 230 workplaces.2300 MOAI field workers to conduct 4 one day meetings in their sections. Conduct campaigns and exhibitons to MOAI expose Rural communities to support services on Gender and H IV/AIDS. Procure 8 multi-media mobile vans (yellow MOAI vans for ADDs to support extension campaigns and Behaviour Change Communication Undertake diagnostic surveys Develop a checklist and participatory tools MOAI to bring out deeper for situaton analysis at work place and understanding of needs, community by 36 GAD officers in 3 days issues and links of HIV/AIDS, Gender and Agricultural Development in selected areas (model Villages and samples areas) Conduct staff orientation on diagnostic MOAI surveys at workplaces- by 4 GAD duster teams for 5 days Conduct the diagnostic surveys at MOAI community level Analyse and compile situation Issues for MOAI action planning Develop policy and Engage consultant to facilitate review of MOAI programmes to support the existing national studies and policies and activities of HIV/AIDS and development of Gender HIV/AIDS policy for Gender within the Agricultural the Agriculture sector Sector Develop acton plans to address Gender and MOAI HIV/AIDS issues at different workplace and programme levels. Procure EPA motorcycles and community MOAI bicycles to facilitate mobilization campaigns. Conduct field visits and review meetings to MOAI monitor Implementation of work place and community action plans. Design and provide technical Train for skills development in dealing with MOAI backstopping to Agricultural HIV/AIDS impacts prevention and reducing training institubons, gender disparities in agricultural communiftes and workplace developmentTrain 36 gender and HIV/AIDS on Gender and HIVIAIDs desk officers. intervenbons. On the job training for field staff at ADDs, MOAI RDPs, research Statons and EPAs and Mobile training for community mobilizers on MOAI Gender and HIV/AIDS 5 Engage Consultant to facilitate review MOAI curricula for Agricuttural Training Institutions (Bunda and NRC) to incorporate gender and HIV/AIDS Conduct consultative meetngs with MOAI University and NRC Administrators for curriculum riview Provide support to training insUtutions to MOAI mainstream Gender and HIV/AIDS into their curricula. Develop a gender Procure 27 desk top computers to facilitate MOAI disaggregated data bank for data management at DistrictVRDP levels and programmin and monitoring 1 lap top for the central coordinating unit and evaluation linked to the Implementation units in ADDS and the Central Monitoring and Evaluation Unit for the Agricultural Sector. Engage a consultant to design a databank MOAI and train staff to manage use of a disaggregated databank Establish a gender disaggregated data bank MOAI system Advocacy for strengthened Organise seminar presentations, field activity MOAI linkages, financial and updates through MASIP, District Assembly, technical support within and Parliamentarians, Technical Working Groups outside the Agricultural sector and MOAI's Gender and HIV/AIDS stetting for reinforcing mainstreaming Committees of Gender and HIV/AIDS into agricultural development, Establish an inventory of organisations MOAI dealing with Gender and HIVIAIDS programmes locally. Facilitate linkages for accessing MOAI services on HIV/AIDS Establish and Strengthen networking locally MOAI and intemationally - SARIA, SEAGA, Canadian Agro biodiversity Indigenous knowledge/Gender Project, IDDEAA, TANESA and ISNAR Sub-Goal 1.1.2 - Natural Resources Increase sustainable Strengthen legal and Generate and develop management plan for MONREA - utilisation of flshery Institutional framework fishery resources In Lake Malawi, Lake Fisheries resources Chilwa, Chiuta and Malombe Empower Beach Village Committees (BVCs) MONREA - to manage the resource through district Fisheries assembly by-laws Train fishing community on new legislation MONREA - Fisheries Devolve fisheries department roles to District MONREA - Assemblies I Fisheries Promote altemative livelihood Recnuit and train adequate extension and MONREA - strategies In fisheries technical staff Fisheries Promote off-shore fishery of untapped stocks MONREA - in Lake Malawi to provide cheap fish on the Fisheries market Train communities on other IGAs MONREA - Fisheries 6 Promote fisheries enhancement technologies MONREA - and fish farming in local communities Fisheries Promote establishment of better markets and MONREA - marketing practices for fish Fisheries Create mass awareness of Improve fisheries curriculum at Mpwepwe MONREA - environment and natural College of fisheries and other training Fisheries resource management centres for staff and fisheries Translate 50 years of fisheries research data MONREA - into user friendly informabon materials Fisheries Mass campaign on fish policy, act, best MONREA - management practices through mass media, Fisheries posters and pamphlets Encourage Strengthen the legal and Empower communities on co-management MONREA - sustainable utilisation Institutional framework for of forest reserves Forestry of forestry resources PRS in environmental management Anchore community based forestry MONREA - Districts management in the LGA and DA Forestry Develop forestry co-management plans in MONREA - Districts line with National forestry Forestry Forestry Programme Conduct sensitisation meetings for judiciary, MONREA - NGOs immigration and general public Forestry Mount forest' road blocks in strategic areas MONREA - to regulate illegal flow of forest products Forestry Refine forest licensing system for various MONREA - forest resource users in forest reserves Forestry review and implement strategy for for law MONREA - enforcement and compliance Forestry Review policy on carbon tax on trees MONREA - Forestry Develop and implement policy guidance, MONREA - human resourses development strategies Forestry Undertake forestry management board MONREA - meetings, promotions, recruitment Forestry ParUcipate and implement nationaVregional MONREA - protocols, conventions and programmes Forestry Promote altemative livelihood Privatisation of industrial plantatons to MONREA - Private sector strategies supply the demand for timber Forestry Re-plant softwood plantations MONREA - Private sector Forestry Conduct forest resources inventory MONREA - Private sector Forestry Promote Forest extension Undertake mass tree planting campaign as MONREA - Private sector services an economic benefit Forestry Provide forest extension servises to farmers, MONREA - Private sector VNRMCs, NGOs schools, etc Forestry Develop and implement forest extension MONREA - Private sector, projects Forestry NGOs, Districts Develop a coordinated extension framework MONREA - Private sector, Aith NGOs and other stakeholders Forestry NGOs. Districts Develop and document lessons and MONREA - Private sector, experiences generated under extension Forestry NGOs, services Districts 7 Undertake mass campaign on forest policy, MONREA - Private sector, act and by-laws through media, posters etc. Forestry NGOs, Districts Decentralise provision of forestry extension MONREA - Private sector, services Forestry NGOs, Districts Create mass environmental Improve forestry curriculum at Dedza and MONREA - Private sector, awareness as regards other training centres for staff and VNRMCs MCF&W NGOs, forestry Districts Provide forest technician training MONREA - Private sector, MCF&W NGOs, Districts Provide under and post graduate forestry Mzuzu BCA training University Develop and disseminate environmental MONREA- NGOs forestry education Forestry Expose serving officers to refresher courses MONREA- Districts. in sustainable management of forest Forestry MCF&W, resources and environment FRIM Train forest extension worker MONREA - Districts, Forestry NGOs Sharpen foretry research and Translate 10 years research into user FRIM Research information systems friendly informaton material and manuals partners Convene and review NFRC and forestry FRIM Research research symposium partners Conduct forest researc in seed and tree FRIM Research lmrovement strategy area partners Conduct researc in indigenous woodland FRIM Research management strategy area partners Conduct researc in forest plantation strategy FRIM Research area partners Conduct forest research tree on farm FRIM Research strategy area partners Promote planning and Improve and strengthen forest revenue MONREA - evaluaton forestry activities collection system Forestry Conduct financial / resource intemal audit MONREA - and accounting procedures at forest statons Forestry Develop sector investment plan for the MONREA - Private sector, forestry sector Forestry NGOs, Districts Review strategic plan for the department of MONREA - Forestry Forestry Refine and implement Naftonal Forestry MONREA - Private sector, Programme Forestry NGOs, Districts Monitoring and evaluating implementation of MONREA - Private sector, forest projects, programmes and Forestry NGOs, subprogrammes Districts Encourage Create mass awareness of Improve training on wildlife management at MOTPWildlife sustainable utilisaton environment and natural relevant training institutions for staff and - DNPW of wildlife resources resource management as villagers regards wildlife 8 Translate research data into user-friendly MOTPWildlife information materials and manuals - DNPW MOTPWildlife - DNPW Increase capacity of EE unit of DNPW, MOTPWildlife human resource, material resource, financial - DNPW resources Mass campaign on wildlife policy, act and MOTPWildlife best NRM practices through mass media, - DNPW posters and others Minimise wildlife/human Establish vertebrate pest control fences MOTPWildlife conflicts - DNPW Train hunter and community leaders in crop MOTPWildlife protection and problem animal control - DNPW Conduct national crocodile and hippo MOTPWildlife management plans - DNPW Strengthen legal and Promote co-management of wildlife reserves MOTPWildlife institutional framework with local communities and other - DNPW stakeholders Community-based wildlife co-management MOTPWildlife anchored in the District Assemblies - DNPW Develop wildlife co-management plans in line MOTPWildlife with sustainable NR principles - DNPW Revise policy to tax park users MOTPWildlife - DNPW Promote aftemaUve livelihood Privatise selected wildlife to ensure supply of MOTPWildlife strategies as regards wildlife the demand for game - DNPW Encourage wildlife farming MOTPWildlife - DNPW Promote mass tree planting for conservation MOTPWildlife and economic benefits - DNPW Harvesting sustainable wildlife resources in MOTPWildlife buffer zones of protected areas - DNPW Sub-Goal 1.1.3 - Develop MSMEs Provide support to Provide physical Develop industrial sites for MSMEs with MOCI MIPA, private development of infrastructure common user facilities such as testing, sector MSMEs marketing, waste disposal etc. Introduce special assistance Develop database of MSMEs MOCI programmes - both financial and non-financial services Develop a subcontract exchange system MOCI Identify and develop new markets MOCI Link anchor companies and selected MSMEs MIPA Train MSMES on quality improvement MBS practices Establish raw materials banks MOCI Private sector Pool MSMEs under one umbrella for bulk MOCI Private sector supply of products Establish research and development grants OPC - NRC Establish quality control and testing centres MBS Private sector Introduce technologies to Conducts research OPC - NRC facilitate income generation AdapVDevelop simple technologies MIRTDC Disseminate technologies MIRTDC Focus on specific products Promote Malawi's handicrafts MOTPWildlife where Malawi has a comparative advantage Establish export villages MEPC MIPA, private sector 9 ObJ tS - r Develop bookletsidocumentary MEPC MIPA, private films/webpages sector Organise intemational fairs MEPC MIPA, private sector ____________________ ___________________________ Prepare booklet on export procedures MEPC Improve institutional Improve co-ordination and Introduce a Lead Agency" concept to co- MOCI coordination and support ordinate markets and marketing. incentives. support financial assistance and R&D, training and management of infrastucture Sub-Goal 1.1.4 - Manufacturing and agro-processing Broaden the industrial Identify new sources of Explore linkages between local components MIPA base growth manufacturers and the automobile industry in South Africa Target development of export-oriented, high MCI,MPIA value-added, high technotogy industries Create Industry assistance Determine the qaulifying criteria MCI fund Provide supportive Develop industnal estates MOCI MIPA, MEPC, infrastructure Private sector Implement R&D Programmes MIRTDC Provide training & consultancies DEMAT MIRTDC Develop new cluster Develop and promote new Promote value added chains anchored MIPA based industries cluster of in textiles and around a crop or resource apparel, food products (cassava, soya, fish, livestock, floriculture, fruits and vegetables), resource based industries (wood, gemstones, handicrafts), chemical products (pharmaceuticals, fine chemicals), engineering industries (auto components) and consumer manufactures Attract new investment in the areas where MIPA Malawi has a comparatve advantage Accelerate regional Promote spatial development Strengthen Nacala and Mtwara development MOCI development initiatives conridors Improve product Encourage in-house quality Conduct workshops, training courses for MBS standards and quality control measures firms Strengthen national Strengthen MBS MBS standards capacity Integrate MSMEs into See Sub-Goal 1.1.3 above industrial development Establish a credible Establish a Business Council Create Business Council institutional framework Facilitate flow of information to key actors Strengthen public-private linkages Sub-Goal 1.1.5 -Tourism Promote investment in Establish zones for the Designate tourism growth areas MOTPWildlife MOL, MOLG, diverse tourism development of tourism and Districts, local products develop land use plans and communities key sites for each of the ____ ____ ____ ____ areas _ _ _ _ _ _ In partnership with relevant Provide and maintain telecommunication, MOTPWildlife NRA, authorities, advise and power and road network facilities in MOTPWorks, develop necessary designated tourism areas. (see the section MTL, ESCOM infrastructure that supports on roads) tourism 10 Intensify tourism investment Promote and facilitate tounsm investment. MOTPWildlife MIPA, promotion Formulate commercially investment and MOFEP, concession agreements and incentives MOFA, MTA specific to tourism for potential investors Establish the collection and Collect, process, analyse tourism data for MOTPWildlife NSO. analysis of tourism data informed and quantitative decesion making Immigration, MTA Develop and promote Implement the construction of three cultural MOTPWildIIfe Districts, local community-led, pro-poor villages, build capacity for arts and craft communities tounsm developments makers and provide attractive vending MOGYCS, shelters, train and acrredit tour guides. TEVETA Develop and promote high Implement a strategic and phased plan for MOTPWildlife MIPA, MOL, quality eco tourism product the development of eco-tourism lodges as private sector detailed in the 2001 - 2005 Strategic Tourism Development plan Develop and adopt Increase the number of Implement new marketing strategies. MOTPWildlife MTA, MOFA updated and tourists and revenue to Review the institutional framework for professional approach Malawi tourism promotion to tourism promotion and marketing Promote domestic tourism Undertake local promotion on tourist MOTPWildlife MTA, media, products and encourage special packages NGOs for local malawians Increase awareness on the Undertake public awareness campaigns on MOTPWildlife MTA, media, benefits of tourism among the benefits of tourism traditional local Malawians auth, NGOs Regulate tourism on Establish appropriate Carry out research and draft rugulations and MOTPWildlife MTA, MOJ, the basis of defined guidelines and regulations to laws for the tourism industry MBS standards achieve excellent standards Carry out research on a new authority to and quality of services steer the marketing function and maintainance of standards Maintain quality of standards Classify and licence all tourism enterprises MOTPWildlife MTA, MBS, In the tourism Industry Carry out classification into grades on Hotels and accommodation units Tourism Carry out Inspections on tourism enterprises Board to maintain standards Facilitate tourism training In collaboration with the Training schoool, MOTPWildlife Malawi and awareness programmes carry out tour guide training with Institute of accreditation Tourism Sub-Goal 1.1.6 - Small scale mining Disseminate Establish focal point in Provide information on inventory of minerals, MONREA - Information, especially Department of mines exploration status, mining and mineral-based Mining the information industries required by MSMES Disseminate information on Prepare and update an inventory of minerals Geol. Surv. availability of minerals available and produced in the country Produce a mineral bulletin Geol. Surv. Produce brochures for target minerals Geol. Surv. Disseminate informaton on Prepare bulletins MONREA- mining technologies Mining Provide training MONREA - Mining Provide technical and Provide technical support on District based training programmes MONREA - Districts financial support mineral extraction Mining Provide technical support on District based training programmes MONREA - Districts value-adding Mining Improve processing Rehabulitate+rebuild +re-equip labs MONREA - +laboratory infrastructure Mining Provide financial support Encourage lending institutions to extend MONREA - credit facilities to small-scale miners (see Mining section on credit) Ensure appropriate Improve efficiency and Simplify procedures MONREA- MOJ mining legislation effectiveness of office Mining procedures, especially for grant and renewal of mining leases Promote value- Encourage formation of Provide training on club formation and MONREA - addition, marketing miners' clubs and management Mining and exports assocations Put in place incentives for Organise local fairs and exhibitions MONREA - MEPC exports Mining Visit regional and intematonal trade fairs MONREA - MEPC Mining Organise seminars and exhibitions for MONREA - MEPC potential exporters and Govemment Mining Establish a formal channel through which MONREA - MEPC mineral can be exported Mining Promote value addition Improve cutting and polishing techniques of MONREA - precious stones Mining Establish a gem and jewellery exchange MONREA - Mining Improve dialogue among the stakeholders in MONREA - the industry Mining Create SSI pilot minerals product estates MONREA - Mining Goal 1.2 - Creating an Enabling Environment for Pro-Poor Growth Sub-Goal 1.2.1 - Macroeconomic Stability Reduce inflation, See Chapter 5 matrix interest rates and ensure stable exchange rate Sub-Goal 1.2.2 - Develop Credit and Micro-Finance Reduce the cost of reduce base interest rate See chapter 5 credit (RBM) ._*_. Strengthen the Strengthen MF network to Secretariat start up costs MOCI MFN institutional promote coordination and Framework enhance performance standards develop a code of conduct to promote MOCI MFN performance standards carry out impact assessment MOCI MFN Establish appropriate Establish working committee Review existing 'MOCI MFN framework for regulation and and develop new framework supervision of MFIs Setup selfregulatory body to supervise MFIs MOCI MFN Reduce high default Establish a credit reference carry out feasibility study on the setup of the MOCI MFN rates bureau bureau, source funding and establish bureau Streamline legislation related review existing legislation MOCI MOJ, MFN to financial sector establish specialist debtor courts MOCi MOJ, MFN Computerize the registry of titles MOCI MOL Establish a central computerized stop order MOCI MOJ, MFN system Expand competition Reduce political interference commercialize an privatize all Govemment Privatisation MOCI, and efficiency in the and inefficiency controlled MFIs Commission MOFEP, DSC credit market 12 Increase competition Continue prvatization of commercial banks Privatsation MOCI, Commission MOFEP, DSC Eliminate Interlockirng ownership Privatisation MOCI, Commission MOFEP, DSC Encourage new entrants Prvatisation MOCI, Commission MOFEP, DSC Diversify and expand Expand microfinance Encourage commercial banks to provide MOCI MFN coverage coverage wholesale lending to MFIs Link farmer groups and other associatons to MOCI MFN MFIs Improve quality of the Provide product development trainings for MOCI MFN microfinance supply MFIs Establish pilot fund to promote research into MOCI MFN new rural lending methodology Conduct trainings for MFI staff, management MOCI MFN and boards to improve efficiency Assist MFIs to put automated management MOCI MFN information systems in place Sub-Goal 1.2.3 - Rural Infrastructure Improve rural Promote rural travel and Improve awareness and understanding of MOTPWorks transport transport rural travel and transport issues Infrastructure Rehabilitate and maintain Grading of rural feeder roads NRA rural feeder roads Rehabilitaton of rural feeder roads NRA Construction of other road infrastructure NRA Increase accessibility Construct and rehabilitate Construct boreholes MOWD to good drinking water water facilities and sanitation _ Rehabilitate boreholes MOWD Rehabilitate piped water schemes MOWD Train communities in maintenance of MOWD Communities, boreholes NGOs Pilot groundwater storage gravity supply MOWo schemes Institute monitoring and evaluaton MOWD Build professional capacity in MOWD MOWD Increase capacity to meet Extend and rehabilitate existing infrastructure Water Boards demand from industry and domestic users Implement water loss reduction measures Water Boards Enhance cost recovery measures Water Boards Strengthen the viability of water supplies Water Boards Improve operational autonomy and Water Boards MOFEP, DSC commercial viability of water boards Conservation and Constructon and rehabilitation of small MOWD MOAI management of water community multi-purpose dams resources Community mobilisation and training in MOWD Communities, environmental and water catchment NGOs protection Rehabilitate water catchment areas MOWD Communities, NGOs Strengthen instituUonal capacity to collect MOWD hydrological, hydrogeological and water quality data Develop water resources policy MOWD Stakeholders Reduce incidence of water Introduce VIP latrines MOWD MOHP bome diseases Conduct sanitation awareness campaigns MOWD MOHP 13 Increase access to Embark on a nationwide Expand distributlon network to rural growth MONREA - ESCOM affordable and rural electrification centres, trading centres and potential Energy sustainable ru ral programme irrigation centres energov_ _ __ _ _ _ __ _ _ _ Reduce pressure on wood- Encourage use of charcoal and wood stoves MONREA - NGOs fuel -In different areas Energy Provide credit for the production of stoves MONREA - NGOs Energy Promote the use of biogas plants MONREA - Energy Expand electricity supply Encourage private sector to develop a MONREA- options dedicated financing system for Photo Voltaic Energy (PV) systems (revolving fund) Develop the market for photovoltaic systems MONREA- at household level (supply and demand) Energy Provide incentives for the Rationalise distribution margins to provide MONREA- development of fuel retail incentive to rural distributors Energy outlets in rural areas Review existing fiscal policiues regarding MONREA - fuel outiet development Energy Improve rural Develop and implement rural Encourage private sector provision of MACRA telecommunications telecommunications policy telecomms services (e.g. rural cellular based bureaux) Encourage network companies to expand MACRA coverage Encourage demand for telecommunications MACRA by providing training opportunities, public- access terminals and demonstrations Sub-Goal 1.2.4 - Other Enabling Infrastructure Strengthen transport Rehabilitate and maintain Perlodic maintenance - Pothole patching and NRA networks core road network slurry sealing Rehabilitation of core roads NRA Improve other transport Strengthen rail, air and lake transport Private sector MOTPW networks networks through private sector Increase access, Increase access to affordable Provide incentives (increase distribution MONREA - efficiency and modem energy services margins) for establishment of coal Energy reliability of modem distribution depots energv supply Promote use of low cost electrification MONREA - ESCOM technologies (review regulatons on Energy technology range and standards) Improve technical and Preprare electricity supply industry market MONREA - economic effrciency of reform strategy document Energy modem energy supply industries Change market structure from vertically MONREA - integrated public monoploy to separate Energy generabon, transmission and distribution business units Increase security and Engage in importtexport of electricity through ESCOM MONREA reliability of energy systems SAPP, especially through interconnection with Mozambique Rehabilitate existing transmission and ESCOM distribution power systems Expand generaton by implementation of ESCOM Kapichira Phase 11 Diversify power generation sources to other ESCOM hydropower sources (other than Shire) and coal, biomass and thermal power 14 Expand Expand coverage Increase number of working lines telecommunications coverage ContUnue liberalisation of Open up provision to private sector MACRA sector _ _ _ _ _ _ _ Improve quality of and Improve radio broadcasting Restructure MBC MBC access to broadcasting Provide televised information Migrate TVM from analogue to digital formats TVM to the nation Ensure programming poverty and TVM development-focussed Improve postal Increase number of post Rent existing infrastructure, build more post MPC services offices offices Improve sustainability of Increase charges to cost recovery levels MPC postal services Introduce innovative methods of service MPC delivery (e.g. contract out delivery, mutual agreements or distribution) Sub-Goal 1.2.5 - Domestic and External Trade Promote supportive Create sustainable export MEPC infrastructure credit refinancing Ensure adequate road NRA networks (see infrastructure) Expand domostic Encourage local InsUill sense of loyalty in domesUc market - MOCI market share manufacturers to increase Buy Malawi share of domestic market Give recognition to manufacturing MOCI companies that achieve high standards and -quality Give preferential treatment to Design transparent preferential treatment MPA MOCi local entrepreneurs guidelines, to be ovreseen by MPA Enforce transparent preferential treatment of MPA local entrepreneurs Encourage synergies Encourage bulk purchases, joint advertising MOCI between local companies and promotions, joint ventures and buy-outs Promote formal and Informal networks MOCI between traders Produce and share marketing information MOCI Private sector Protect consumers Enforce competition law MOCI Protect consumers from unethical practices, CAMA misleading advertising etc. Promote growth of consumerism CAMA Promote private sector trade associations MOCI Private sector Expand export market Promote development of Strengthen role of MEPC In export promotion MEPC share exports Establish trade promotion centres abroad, MEPC and rationalise existing trade representations Improve collection and dissemination of MEPC market information Negotiate preferenUai Strengthen position in Negotiate for stronger position in COMESA, MOCI MOFAIC arrangements regional trade organisations SADC Negotiate for stronger position through UR, MOCI MOFAIC AGOA, EBA etc. wtth VvTO,US and EU Sub-Goal 1.2.6 - Taxation Design and enforce MOFEP transparent tax exemption criteria 15 Review corporate tax Restructure corporate Remove double taxation MRA MOFEP taxaton to respond to the needs of the private sector Respond to needs of changing employment MRA MOFEP and investment trends Eliminate distortions caused by provisional MRA MOFEP tax payments Widen the tax base Rationalise tax reliefs and incentives MRA MOFEP Implement extended surtax MRA MOFEP Improve MRA operations MRA MOFEP Pillar 2 - Human Capital Development Goal 2.1 Education Sub-Goal 2.1.1 Basic Education Improve the quality Ensure teachers are Pay teachers' salaries, increasing by 10% MOEST and relevance of incentivised each year primary education Put In place incentives to encourage MOEST teachers to work in rural areas Recruit and train new Recruit and deploy teachers in a systematic MOEST DEOs, District teachers through revised manner by using district based and gender Assemblies MIITEP balanced recruitment and training of teachers Introduce improved MIITEP MOEST Train and incentivise TTC lecturers MOEST Reform teacher education curricula in line MOEST MIE with primary education reforms Enforce minimum physical standards of MOEST TTCs Provide quality inputs to primary teacher MOEST education Introduce cost sharing in TTCs for boarding MOEST and transport expenses Strengthen TTC administraton by making full MOEST cost centres Create Department of Teacher Educaton MOEST Train existing teachers Allow JCE holders to upgrate their academic MOEST and teaching qualifications Put in place a Teacher Education MOEST Development Programme Provide quality INSET for primary teachers MOEST through Teacher Development Centres (TDCs) Train PEAs. senior school staff and "Core MOEST INSET trainers" Develop a relevant curriculum Review and monitor primary curriculum MIE with emphasis on literacy, every 10 years numeracy and life skills Improve efficiency of PSLC examinations MANEB Ensure that all pupils have Provide adequate textbooks MOEST access to an adequate supply of teaching and leaming materials Provide adequate learning materials MOEST Provide adequate teaching materials MOEST Provide adequate supplies unit operating MOEST expenses Decentralise distribution of education MOEST materials to a zone based system 16 Promote a more effective Increase supervisory visits by PEAs MOEST supervisory and inspecion service Ensure clean water and sanitation facilities at MOEST primary schools Improve access and Recnjit and train teachers in Train specialist teachers integrated into MOEST MRPWD equity at the primary special needs teacher educaton programmes level, focusing on special needs education and girls Train primary school teachers in special MOEST educaion needs Support given to special Increase provision for severely Impaired MOEST MRPWD needs education students children by supporting resource and residential centres on boarding expenses Integrate children with mild visual impairment MOEST MRPWD into conventional schools Increase support to residential schools for MOEST MRPWD hearing impaired children Integrate children with mild hearing MOEST MRPWD Impairment Into conventional schools Reduce pupil teacher ratio for visually and MOEST MRPWD hearing impaired Achieve equitable Continue developing gender awareness MOEST MOGYCS parUcipation of girls, orphans teaching materials for equitable participation etc. of both boys and girls Carry out a social moblization campaign MOEST MOGYCS targeting orphans, girls, out of school youths and children with physical and leaming disabilities Increase physical access to Increase usage of school blocks (double MOEST basic education shifting) Increase the number of school blocks MOEST Rehabilitate poor classrooms MOEST Maintain classrooms MOEST Increase and improve Increase access to adult Provide adequate training and leaming MOGYCS adult literacy and literacy classes materials for adult literacy classes and numeracy honoraria for trainers Review adult Iteracy policy MOGYCS Promote equitable Undertake social mobilization campaign MOGYCS partcipaton of men and women In adult literacy classes Deliver effective adult literacy Revise the adult literacy curriculum MOGYCS classes Train teachers in adult literacy MOGYCS Recruit and train additional instructors MOGYCS Recruit and train additional DCAs MOGYCS Strengthen monitoring of adult literacy MOGYCS Print and distribute adequate adult literacy MOGYCS primers Open up more Rural Information Centres MOGYCS (RICs) in existing buildings in communities Provide special Provide an altemative form of Develop multipurpose youth centres MOGYCS education for out of education to school dropouts school youth and those who have not attended school Strengthen out of school youth clubs at TA MOGYCS level Train youth In vocational skills MOGYCS MOLVT, TEVETA 17 Train youth patron leaders MOGYCS Develop and implement a Develop a comprehensive life skills training MOGYCS MOLVT, relevant training package for package TEVETA out of school youth Training of peer educators of district youth MOGYCS MOLVT, technical sub-committees as trainers TEVETA Expand pre-school Identify Early Childhood Carry out an ECD centre identification MOEST Communities, education (Early Development (ECD) centres exercise to find out communities that have DEOs, District Childhood Education, and that do not have ECD centres Assemblies ECD _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ _ __ _ _ _ _ Mobilize support for ECD Moblize support from stakeholders including MOEST centres private sector Promote the health and Provide enriched porridge/food supplements MOEST MOHP nutrition of pre-school at pre-schooUCBCCs children Orient ECD teachers and parents on the MOEST nutrition and health of children Establish new ECDs and pre- Facilitate the establishment of new ECDs MOEST schools and pre-schools Ensure an adequate and well Recruit more ECD teachers MOGYCS MOEST motivated supply of care givers Train existing ECD teachers MOGYCS MOEST Provide pre-service training to new ECD MOGYCS MOEST teachers Pay monthly honorarium to 2,800 teaxchers MOGYCS MOEST Pay T4 salaries to qualified ECD teahers MOGYCS MOEST Equip all CBCC facilities with Acquire and deliver pre-school materials MOGYCS MOEST adequate materials Construct ECD resource centres for the nural MOGYCS MOEST areas Involve communities in making local MOGYCS MOEST materials Ensure quality standards in Develop ECDs and instructional materials MOGYCS MOEST all private and public pre- schooUCBCC institutions Acquire monitoring and data management MOGYCS MOEST tools Managege and evaluate ECD services MOGYCS MOEST Undertake short studies on ECDs MOGYCS MOEST Respond urgentiy to Ensure that pupils/out of Support existing HIV/AIDS Clubs MOEST NAC problems created by school youth have the the HIV/AIDS knowledge and skills to avoid epidemic HIV/AIDS infection and are provided with counselling services Undertake media initiatives - magazine radio MOEST NAC programme, AIDS educ. Soap-Opera Implement recommendations fron the MOEST NAC HIV/AIDS Strategic Plan Decentralise and Reduce dropout and Tackle poor attendance by working directly MOEST Communities, strengthen repetition rates in primary with communities NGOs, administrative and education Districts planning responsibilities Undertake social contract workshops MOEST covering all schools Ensure that strategic plans Establish an Education Management MOEST for basic educabon are based Informaton System (EMIS) on quality data collection and analysis 18 Decentralise administrative Reallocate educational staff and operating MOEST responsibilitestservices for budgets from higher levels to lower levels basic education Establish a dialogue among Provide management training and equipment MOEST NYC and between youth and for NGOs targebng youths service providerrs/policy makers Establish Youth Techincal Sub-Committees NYC in every district Build capacity for the National Youth Council NYC Sub-Goal 2.1.2 - Secondary Education Increase access and Increase access to public To construction of new classrooms and MOEST DEOs, equity to secondary secondary education and double shifting to continue in urban schools Assemblies schools ensure that there is access in every zone (315) Increase the number of girls Review of bursary scheme to target students MOEST gaining access to secondary from low social-economic groups with education particular focus gn girls and orphans (80% of bursaries to go to girls) Automatically readmirt students to school MOEST one year after suspension for pregnancy Increase access to secondary Provide for salaries for teachers engaged in MOEST education for our of school distance education youth Provide distance educaton to primary school MOEST leavers who do not continue with formal schooling via MCDE Provide textbook packs to students MOEST Support students with special Chidren with special education needs will be MOEST MRPWD education needs integrated into conventional schools with supporting resource centres Increase access to private Revive the Private Schools Association of PRISAM MOEST secondary education Malawi (PRISMA) and involve it in textbook provision and in night schooling Improve quality and Review and reform curricula Develop and implement new curriculum MIE MOEST relevance of in line vAth needs for secondary school - incorporartng life skills, education specialist subjects, information and communication technology and nutrition Reduce number of subjects examined at MANEB MOEST MSCE level Consultation of stakeholders on assessment MANEB MOEST method at JCE level - replace JCE exam with continuous assessment Improve management and efricency of MANEB MANEB Ensure that all secondary Rehabilitate those CDSSs which failed to MOEST school insttutions meet meet standards in 1999 physical minimum standards Maintain the stock of existing secondary MOEST schools (CSS, CDSS) Ensure effective supervision Undertake advisory visits to secondary MOEST schools Recruit more SEMAs MOEST Train SEMAs , Headteachers, HoDs and MOEST cluster leaders on school development planning and supervision techniques 19 Hold various SEMA meetings on supervision MOEST techniques Establish new clusters MOEST Ensure that pupils have Supply inital stock of textbooks to all puplic MOEST access to adequate supply of schools so that textbook revolving fund relevant instructional (TRF) scheme can start materials Involve public and private schools in MOEST PRISAM Textbook Revolving Facility (TRF) Supply adequate teaching materials Deploy appropriate resources for specialist MOEST MRPWD subjects Maintain ICT equipment MOEST Equip every school vwth a set of basic to start MOEST MOAI and maintain school gardens Maintain Agriculture tools to retain their MOEST condition Equip every school with a set of basic MOEST cooking equipment to rehabilitate outdoor kitchens Equip every school with a set of seving MOEST machines To recruit and retain an Recruit and train enough teachers to reduce MOEST adequate number of the pupil class ration in public schools secondary school teachers Increase the number of teachers on pre- MOEST service teacher education courses Upgrade existing untrained teachers in the MOEST system Increase access and improve Recruit trained teachers as well as qulified MOEST equity in teacher recruitment primary school teachers as a temporary and training measure Increase intake for teacher traning through MOEST private and non-residentail teacher training Upgrade under-qualified teachers MOEST Encourage the private sector to participate in MOEST the provision of secondary school teachers To increase the number of female Secondary MOEST school teachers Put in place a quality Provide operating expenses for Domasi MOEST secondary school teacher teaching serives education and development programme Provide operating expenses for Chancellor MOEST College teaching serives Provide operating expenses for Mzuz MOEST teaching serives Provide operating expenses for MOEST Polytechnique teaching serives Provide operating expenses for Bunda MOEST teaching serives Upgrade under-qualified Run distance education programme at MOEST - teachers to to diploma level Domasi Domasi Run distance education programme at MOEST Mzuzu TTC Improve Management Decentralise Secondary Improve administration in line with expansion MOEST and Administration of school education of secondary educafton Secondary Education Streamline administrative services MOEST Improve management of division MOEST administration in line with increasing 20 enrolment Enhance secondary school Support development of secondary school MOEST planning administration EMIS Apply and maintain quality control measures MOEST Support the development of Facilitate divisions'and clusters to improve MOEST adequate secondary school their analytical skils in planning management and administration staff An efficient and equitable MOEST financing system for secondary institutions to be put into place To improve efficiency in the Reduce real financing for administration and MOEST use of school admin/utility utilities resources Recruit administration workers for all CCSs MOEST Recruit administration workers for all CDSS MOEST To promote internal and Improve the efficiency of use of teachers in MOEST efficiency gains in the system CDSSs inorder to reduce class size Maximise teaxcher learner contact time - 21 MOEST leaming periods of 40 minutes each out of 45 periods Improve the equity in the distribution of MOEST qualified teachers across CDSSs and CSSs Upgrade TDU to be a Charge Department of Teacher Eduication MOEST department for Teacher Development (DTED) with a responsibility for Education and Development pre-service and in-service teacher education Increase the level of cost Introduce 50% covereage of boarding costs MOEST sharing for boarding by students expenses Sub-Goal 2.1.3 - Higher Education Increase access and Increase of student Intake Universities to increase their intake of full- UOM Mzuzu Uni equity in higher through double shifting, time equivalent public (FTEP) students and education distant education optimise use of physical resources by programmes and involvement introducing double shifing and after hours of the private sector in use of classrooms tertially education Universities to increase intake through UOM Mzuzu Uni distance education programmes Private initiatives to be encouraged by UOM Mzuzu Uni changing the Education Act by 2004 Universites to increase intake into specific UOM Mzuzu Uni poverty related programmes Increase participation of Reserve 30 % intake of girls by 2004 and 50 UOM Mzuzu Uni females in tertiary education % by 2012 Introduce sholarship awards for female UOM Mzuzu Uni students in non-traditional areas Establish a gender studies unit at chancellor UOM Mzuzu Uni college and outreach units in all institutions Introduce bridging programmes for female UOM Mzuzu Uni students Promote gender mainstreaming In all higher UOM Mzuzu Uni education institutions by introducing affirmative action in recruitment of academic staff Increase participation of Introduce scholarship awards for needy UOM Mzuzu Uni students from disadvantaged students groups University buildings to be made 'diasbled' UOM Mzuzu Uni friendly' - by 2004 21 Introduce Social Mobilisaton Campaigns to UOM Muz Unl increase admission of candidates from disadvantaged areas Improve the quality To motivate staff in teaching Raise the average salaries of teaching and UOM Mzuz Uni and relevance of and research in order to * research and support staff higher education strengthen and improve qualty graduate programmes Increase the value of welfare and UOM Mzuzu Uni professional benefits in line with the expansion in enrolments Improve the quality of Annual maintenance of physical UOM Mzuzu Uni teaching and leaming In infrastructure to occur tertary institutions Construct new campus for Mzuzu University UOM Mzuzu Uni at Choma Increase number of science and technology UOM Mzuzu Uni laboratories and equipment Provide adequate training opportunities for UOM Mzuzu Uni professional staff by 2002 Increase financlal alocations for buying UOM Mzuzu Uni teaching and leaming materials Strengthen research & Encourage the establishment of private UOM Mzuzu Uni graduate programmes bookshops. Students to be given vouchers to purchase books Increase the number of post graduate UOM Mzuzu Uni programmes Increase allocation to research and UOM Mzuzu Uni technology disseminaboin programmes by 2004 Re-orientate tertiary Provide scholarship support for students in UOM Mzuzu Uni institutons to make them 'skill demand' areas particuladiy Science and more responsive to the needs Technology of Malawian society. Make computer literacy a compulsory course UOM Mzuzu Uni for all students Match jobs with market needs by 2002 UOM Mzuzu Uni introduce courses addressing cross-cutting UOM Mzuzu Uni issues including HIV/AIDS, gender, iifeskills and globalisation e.t.c by 2002 Reduce reliance of Decentralise the Demand driven strategic plans to be UOM Mzuzu Uni higher education on administrabon of Tertiary developed for entrepreneurship environment subventons Education in every college and department by 2002 install management informabon systems to UOM Mzuzu Uni facilitate planning, monitoring and implementabon Recruit pro-vice chancellor at UNIMA to UOM Mzuzu Uni facilitate implemntation of reform programme and business development Establish a National Commission for Higher UOM Mzuzu Uni Educabon to plan and co-ordinate tertary activities by 2002 Redefine the role of the University Office, UOM Mzuzu Uni the unft cost of admin expenses to fall by 20 (2) improve dialogue and Increase public relations and soCal UOM Mzuzu Uni interface and society marketing activites by 2002 Tertary instituions to College admin staff establishment remain UOM Mzuzu Uni promote cost effective use of constant - student administrator ratios existing human and physical increased resources 22 Colleges will no longer be responsible for UOM Mzuzu Uni boarding Colleges will no longer be responsible for UOM Mzuzu Uni utility bills for boarding and will put into place energy and water saving measures such that utility expenses to fall by 20%, in real terms, by 2002 Efficiency saving measures to be put in place UOM Mzuzu Uni such that unit college administrators expenses fall by 25% by 2007 Separation of education and welfare UOM Mzuzu Uni services- by 2002 students to cover the cost of boarding expenses Bursary system to be abolished and replaced UOM Mzuzu Uni with a targeted scholarship programme Goal 2.2 Better Technical, Entrepreneurial, Vocational Education and Training Promote self Promote self employment Implement on the,job training programs in TEVETA employment through and thereby reduce puverty in specific occupations for the youth In skills development the informal Sector through collaboration with MASAF and other initiatives establishment of skills stakeholders development initiatives in ruraJ areas Expand the skills development Initiative for TEVETA self employment rural areas Conduct demand-driven specialized MEDI technical, entrepreneurial and business development skills training programs Train a pool of trainers of entrepreneurship MOLVT training for the informal sector Ensure access to skills Establish village polytechnics MOLVT development by expanding and increasing outreach and coverage of technical entrepreneurial vocational education and training programmes through village polytechnics in all districts Mount mobile training units MOLVT Run village polytecnics MOLVT Run mobile training units MOLVT Link decentralisation units to designated MOLVT resource colleges in catchment area Increase the quality, Introduce appropriate technology traning in MOLVT MIRTDC, productivity and marketablility training institutions NRC of indiginous skills by developing, esposing and promoting appropriate technologies in all districts Establish research units in training MOLVT MIRTDC, institutions NRC Carry out research on appropriate MOLVT technology and integrate in formal and non- formal training run research units MOLVT 23 Ensure awareness and Conduct career guidance and counselling on TEVETA MOEST, knowledge of provision of TEVET in all levels of education MOLVT productive skills training programmes by promoting and Facilitating Vocational Career guidance and Counselling Conduct informaton, education and TEVETA MOLVT communication about TEVET programs and career opportunities for the public Promote recognition and Training of assessors TEVETA appreciation of indigenous skills and competences by establishing a decentralised competency based assessment and certification system National assessment and certificabon system TEVETA developed and approved National assessment and certificaton unit TEVETA established and running Improve quality and Increase relevance, access, Revise all existing cunricula within Technical, TEVETA relevance of TEVET equityand quality of Entreprenerial, vocational education and Technical, Entrepreneurial, training Vocaional Education and Training by reviewing, developing and implementing competency based curricula Develop new curricula within all occupations TEVETA Train teachers in using new curricula TEVETA Ensure appropriate and Design a concept of natonal flexible MOLVT sufficient human capacity technical Teacher training within vocabonal training by establishing a flexible and cost-effective Technical Teacher System Train Trainers of Trainers MOLVIT Establish a national unit for planning, MOVLT managing and accrediting technical Teacher training Develop curricula for technical teacher MOLVT TEVETA training Develop and print learning and teaching MOLVT TEVETA materials for Technical teacher Training Train Teachers Teaching methodology and MOLVT TEVETA cross cutting issues Train Teachers upgrading technical, MOLVT entrepreneurail and vocatonal skills Run nabonal unit for Technical Teacher MOLVT Training Register and accredit Trainers MOLVT Improve quality, relevance, Establish College Boards as supreme bodies MOLV T impact and cost-effectiveness for Tchnical colleges of Technical, Entrepreneurial, Vocational Education and Training through reform of public technical Colleges Training of College Boards MOLVT TCechnical Colleges Running of College Boards MOLVT Technical Colleges 24 Establish Effective Govemance and MOLVT Technical Management system Colleges Training of Management and staff MOVLT Technical Colleges Grants to train capacity in public colleges MOLVT Technical Colleges Subsidies to traln capacity Private providers MOLVT Technical Colleges Limit the impact of the HIV HIV/aids national TEVET program designed TEVETA pandemic on the future and planned labour force by ensuring Access to HIV/Aids information, counselling and testing services while monitoring its impact on the VET sector HIV/Aids national mobile unit(s) established NAC MOLVT (annual capacity 4000) HIV/aids natinal mobile unit running NAC MOLVT National monitoring and impact-analysis NAC system in operation Rehabilitate existing Increase cost-effectiveness, Take stock of existing equipment and needs MOLvT Technical infrastructure and sustainability and qulity- assessment within public technical colleges Colleges equipment standards by promoting maintence and effective operadon of equipment in public technical colleges and other training Institutons Rehabilitate existing public colleges MOLVT Technical Colleges Train staff from public colleges and private MOLVT Technical provideres in preventive and corrective Colleges maintenance Rehabilitate classrooms public providers MOLVT Technical Colleges Rehabilitate Workshops public providers MOLVT Technical Colleges Facilitate development of Facilitate the formation of sector specific MOLVT quality goods and services by associatons of producers and service promote Access to Business providers Development Services Conduct training in formation of Associations MOLVT Technical and cooperatives Colleges Link small enterpises to business MOLVT Technical development service providers Colleges Facilitate access to demand driven training MOLvT Technical Colleges Facilitate access to credit facilities MOLVT Technical Colleges Facilitate access to markets MOLVT Technical Colleges Facilitate access to quality exposure MOLVT Technical Colleges Establish Technical Information and MOLVT Technical faclitation centres Colleges Run technical information and facilitation MOLVT Technical centres Colleges Strengthen Strengthen effective Funding Strengthten partnership between public and MOLVT Management and and financing of the TEVET private sector Financing of TEVET system 25 Compliance public Sector TEVET Levy MOFEP TEVETA Extend bursaries to needy students MOLVT Technical . ~~~Colleges MOLVT Develop mandate of Directorate of training TEVETA and ensure adequate funding for effective implementation Extend micro-credit to TEVET graduates TEVETA starting small scale business Extend tool-box loans TEVETA apprentices TEVETA Goal 2.3 Improved Health Status Sub-Goal 2.3.1 - Preventative Healthcare Improved nutrition See Goal 2.4 Improved water and See Sub-Goal 1.2.3 sanitation Sub-Goal 2.3.2 - Essential Healthcare Improve quality of Human Resource HR retention via an incentive package MoHP CHAM essential health care development and retention to EHP standards HR development via training additional MoHP KCN, clinical staff MCOHS, College of Medecine Clinical Support Services to Provide Health centres with basic laboratory MoHP EHP standard and medical equiprment Provide basic transport needs to district MoHP health systems Dnug and medical supplies Reform of CMS MoHP availability at EHP standards District Drug Expenditure MoHP Increase per capita drug and medical MoHP supplies expenditure Improving access to Facilites development to Infrastnucture rehabilitation and maintenance MOHP CHAM and equity of EHP EHP standard to levels required in an EHP Infrastructure development to levels required MoHP in an EHP Strengthen Providing administrative Administrative HR development through MOHP CHAM management and Human Resources to an EHP training financing of EHP standard services Administrative HR retention MOHP CHAM Instigating altemative Joint GoM-CHAM user fee initiative MOHP CHAM financing mechanisms Design safety-net mechanisms for the poor MOHP CHAM Undertake user Fee Advocacy campaign MOHP CHAM Prepare options for health insurance scheme MOHP CHAM for approval of cabinet Design and cost business plan for launching MOHP CHAM the chosen health insurance option Govemment Contribution to govemment MOFEP OPC, MOHP, employees insurance coverage DHRMD Design model or pilot service arrangements MOHP CHAM between providers Pro-poor Resource allocation mechanisms MOHP CHAM designed, used and monitored Sector Wide Approach Move towards a Sector Wide Approach MOHP CHAM Decentralization No activities identified MOHP CHAM Provide effect administrabon Provide district and central level support MOHP CHAM for an EHP 26 in0JtQEiStR_______________ lni -!o ir0O RR 1t-a nuor d aotri ! r_V-F_q Sub-Goal 2.3.3 Tertiary healthcare Strengthen referal MOHP system Hospital autonomy Complementary support to Hospital Autonomy MoHP EHP and referral pathways Provide tertiary healthcare (Central Referal MOHP Hospitals) Goal 2.4: Promotion of Good Nutrition Improve infant and Promote exclusive Increase number of baby friendly hospitals MOHP young children breastfeeding and feeding appropriate complementary feeding Conduct breast feeding week MOHP Diversification and Promote community based Provide support for a minimum nutriton MOAI modification of diets nutrition interventions package Strengthening Food and Conduct relevant research on food and MOAI Nutrition programs Nutrition Conduct monitoring of fortified foods MOAI Establish nutrition sentinel surveillance of MOAI data collection sites Strenghthen Advocate for the prevenUon Produce I EC materials on prevention and MOAI institutional capacity and control of malnutrition at control of malnutrition all levels Conduct disseminaton workshops for MOAI stakeholders Conduct Community awareness campaign MOAI Review the food security and nutriton policy MOAI Conduct campaigns on HIV/AIDS and MOHP nutrition Increase and strengthen Conduct short courses on prevention and MOAI human capacity for the control of malnutrition for Extension workers prevention an control of in all districts malnutrition at all levels Advocate for the review of curricula of health MOEST extension agents, Pfimary and Secondary School teachers to incorporate nutrition issues Train middle and upper level food and MOHP nutrition personnel Establish a food and Nutrifion Stakeholders meeting to come up with a MOAI Council national task force Conduct task force meeting to develop a MOAI frame work Lobbying workshops for parliamentarians MOAI and policy makers Presentation of food and nutrition framework MOAI to policy makers and Parliamentarians Pillar 3 - Improving the Quality of Life of the Most Vulnerable Goal 3.1 - Safety Nets Sub-Goal 3.1.1 - Productivity Enhancing Interventions Improve agricultural Provide free inputs 1. Undertake public information campaigns MSPAP productivity of the resource poor farmers . 27 tAeIOL OH .I n *0 2. Undertake beneficiary selection and MSPAP processing 3. logistics, coordinabon and management MSPAP DDPRR 4. benefits transferng MSPAP Retailers, NGOs 5. monitoring and evaluation NEC Provide employment implement public works 1. public informabon campaign MSPAP opportunites for the programmes in poor areas labour abundant land- constrained poor 2. beneficiary selection and processing MSPAP DDPRR 3. logistcs, coordination and management MSPAP 4. benefits transfering MSPAP Retailers, NGOs 5. monitoring and evaluation NEC Sub-Goal 3.1.2 - Welfare Support Interventions Reduce malnutrion of provide food supplements 1. public information campaign MSPAP the malnourished and therapeutic feeding under-five children, lactating and pregnant mothers 2. beneficiary selection and processing MSPAP 3. logistics, coordinabon and management MSPAP DDPRR 4. benefits transfering MSPAP Retailers, NGOs 5. monitorng and evaluation NEC Provide income implement direct welfare 1. public information campaign MSPAP support to the core transfers poor 2. beneficiary selection and processing MSPAP 3. logistics, coordination and management MSPAP DDPRR 4. benefits transfering MSPAP Retailers, NGOs, district assemblies, support groups Strengthen capacity of Implement capacity building 1. Training of foster care parents In orphan MOGYCS NGOs, families and programs care Community communities to support effectively support the groups most vulnerable 2. Training of volunteer cousellors MOGYCS NGOs. Community support groups 3.establish homebased care committees and MOGYCS NGOs, train individuals to manage them Community support groups 4.Establishment of care centers, training MOGYCS NGOs, Community support groups Goal 3.2 - Improving Disaster Management Improving disaster Provide food and non-food 1. Beneficiary selection and processing Disbrict DDPRR management items as basic necessities to Assemblies disaster victims 28 2. Purchase of food and non-food items Donors, DDPRR private donations, NGOs 3. Logistics, distribution, coordination, and Donors, DDPRR, management private District donations, Assemblies NGOs Undertake rehabilitabon and 1. Beneficiary selection Donors, DDPRR, reconstruction private District donations, Assemblies NGOs 2. Logistics, coordination,and management Donors, DDPRR, private District donations, Assemblies, NGOs NGOs Design disaster 1. VAM, identify mitigation programs DDPRR preparedness and mitigation programmes 2.Public information and awareness DDPRR 3. Support Implementation DDPRR Districts. NGOs Monitoring and Evaluabon NEC DPRR, District Assemblies Pillar 4 - Governance Goal 4.1 - Political Will and Mindset I __ I Goal 4.2 - Improved safety, security and access to justice Reduce crime Increase crime control Increase police presence, particularly in rural Police capacity and border areas Improve police response to calls for Police assistance (local transport and communication) Establish anti-cattie theft units Police Control the proliferation and transfer of Police firearms Strengthen anti-motor vehicle theft units Police Co-ordinate with army for extra capacity Police Army when necessary Crime prevention Enhance community involvement in policing Police Civic education on crime prevention Police MOHA Develop counselilng methods at all levels Police Prisons Criminal surveillance Police Improve co-ordinaton with Establish legal framework Police private security firms Establish database of firms and employees Police Establish private security board to oversee Police legal framework, funded by private sector contributions (registration fees etc.) Improve quality of Develop technical support for evidence Police investigation gathering (forensic, fingerprinting etc.) Improve organisational Improve financial management Police performance of the Police Force